changeset 1330:450721ad5436

It's now possible to build SDL without any C runtime at all on Windows, using Visual C++ 2005
author Sam Lantinga <slouken@libsdl.org>
date Mon, 06 Feb 2006 08:28:51 +0000
parents bc67bbf87818
children 1cbaeee565b1
files VisualC.zip configure.in include/Makefile.am include/SDL_audio.h include/SDL_config.h include/SDL_ctype.h include/SDL_endian.h include/SDL_events.h include/SDL_getenv.h include/SDL_mouse.h include/SDL_rwops.h include/SDL_stdarg.h include/SDL_stdlib.h include/SDL_string.h include/SDL_syswm.h include/SDL_thread.h include/SDL_types.h include/SDL_video.h include/SDL_windows.h src/Makefile.am src/SDL.c src/SDL_error.c src/SDL_fatal.c src/SDL_getenv.c src/audio/SDL_audio.c src/audio/SDL_audiocvt.c src/audio/SDL_audiomem.c src/audio/SDL_mixer.c src/audio/SDL_mixer_MMX_VC.c src/audio/SDL_mixer_MMX_VC.h src/audio/SDL_wave.c src/audio/windib/SDL_dibaudio.c src/audio/windx5/SDL_dx5audio.c src/audio/windx5/directx.h src/cdrom/SDL_cdrom.c src/cdrom/win32/SDL_syscdrom.c src/events/SDL_active.c src/events/SDL_events.c src/events/SDL_keyboard.c src/events/SDL_mouse.c src/events/SDL_quit.c src/file/SDL_rwops.c src/joystick/SDL_joystick.c src/joystick/win32/SDL_mmjoystick.c src/loadso/windows/SDL_loadso.c src/stdlib/.cvsignore src/stdlib/Makefile.am src/stdlib/SDL_getenv.c src/stdlib/SDL_malloc.c src/stdlib/SDL_qsort.c src/stdlib/SDL_stdlib.c src/stdlib/SDL_string.c src/thread/SDL_systhread.h src/thread/SDL_thread.c src/thread/generic/SDL_syscond.c src/thread/generic/SDL_sysmutex.c src/thread/generic/SDL_syssem.c src/thread/os2/SDL_systhread.c src/thread/win32/SDL_sysmutex.c src/thread/win32/SDL_syssem.c src/thread/win32/SDL_systhread.c src/thread/win32/SDL_systhread_c.h src/thread/win32/win_ce_semaphore.c src/timer/SDL_timer.c src/timer/win32/SDL_systimer.c src/timer/wince/SDL_systimer.c src/video/Makefile.am src/video/SDL_RLEaccel.c src/video/SDL_blit.c src/video/SDL_blit_0.c src/video/SDL_blit_1.c src/video/SDL_blit_A.c src/video/SDL_blit_N.c src/video/SDL_bmp.c src/video/SDL_cursor.c src/video/SDL_gamma.c src/video/SDL_memops.h src/video/SDL_pixels.c src/video/SDL_surface.c src/video/SDL_sysvideo.h src/video/SDL_video.c src/video/SDL_yuv.c src/video/SDL_yuv_sw.c src/video/e_log.h src/video/e_pow.h src/video/e_sqrt.h src/video/fbcon/SDL_fbelo.h src/video/math_private.h src/video/mmx.h src/video/qtopia/SDL_QWin.h src/video/wincommon/SDL_lowvideo.h src/video/wincommon/SDL_sysevents.c src/video/wincommon/SDL_sysmouse.c src/video/wincommon/SDL_syswm.c src/video/wincommon/SDL_wingl.c src/video/windib/SDL_dibevents.c src/video/windib/SDL_dibvideo.c src/video/windib/SDL_dibvideo.h src/video/windx5/SDL_dx5events.c src/video/windx5/SDL_dx5video.c src/video/windx5/SDL_dx5yuv.c src/video/windx5/directx.h
diffstat 102 files changed, 9123 insertions(+), 842 deletions(-) [+]
line wrap: on
line diff
Binary file VisualC.zip has changed
--- a/configure.in	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/configure.in	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -3008,6 +3008,7 @@
 src/main/macos/Makefile
 src/main/macosx/Makefile
 src/main/macosx/Info.plist
+src/stdlib/Makefile
 src/audio/Makefile
 src/audio/alsa/Makefile
 src/audio/arts/Makefile
--- a/include/Makefile.am	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/Makefile.am	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -10,8 +10,10 @@
 	SDL_audio.h		\
 	SDL_byteorder.h		\
 	SDL_cdrom.h		\
+	SDL_config.h		\
 	SDL_copying.h		\
 	SDL_cpuinfo.h		\
+	SDL_ctype.h		\
 	SDL_endian.h		\
 	SDL_error.h		\
 	SDL_events.h		\
@@ -27,11 +29,15 @@
 	SDL_opengl.h		\
 	SDL_quit.h		\
 	SDL_rwops.h		\
+	SDL_stdarg.h		\
+	SDL_stdlib.h		\
+	SDL_string.h		\
 	SDL_syswm.h		\
 	SDL_thread.h		\
 	SDL_timer.h		\
 	SDL_types.h		\
 	SDL_version.h		\
 	SDL_video.h		\
+	SDL_windows.h		\
 	begin_code.h		\
 	close_code.h
--- a/include/SDL_audio.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_audio.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -25,8 +25,6 @@
 #ifndef _SDL_audio_h
 #define _SDL_audio_h
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-
 #include "SDL_main.h"
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_config.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,87 @@
+/*
+    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
+    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
+
+    Sam Lantinga
+    slouken@libsdl.org
+*/
+
+#ifndef _SDL_config_h
+#define _SDL_config_h
+
+/* This is a set of defines to configure the SDL features */
+
+#define HAVE_STDARG_H
+
+/* Comment this if you want to build without any libc requirements */
+#define HAVE_LIBC
+#ifdef HAVE_LIBC
+
+/* Various C library headers */
+#define HAVE_CTYPE_H
+#define HAVE_STDIO_H
+#define HAVE_STDLIB_H
+#define HAVE_MALLOC_H
+#define HAVE_STRING_H
+#if !defined(_WIN32_WCE)
+#define HAVE_SIGNAL_H
+#endif
+
+/* Features provided by SDL_stdlib.h */
+#if !defined(_WIN32) /* Don't use C runtime versions of these on Windows */
+#define HAVE_GETENV
+#define HAVE_PUTENV
+#endif
+#define HAVE_MALLOC
+#define HAVE_REALLOC
+#define HAVE_FREE
+#define HAVE_ALLOCA
+/*#define HAVE_QSORT*/
+
+/* Features provided by SDL_string.h */
+#define HAVE_MEMSET
+#define HAVE_MEMCPY
+#define HAVE_MEMMOVE
+#define HAVE_MEMCMP
+#define HAVE_STRLEN
+#define HAVE_STRCPY
+#define HAVE_STRNCPY
+/*#define HAVE__STRREV*/
+/*#define HAVE__STRUPR*/
+/*#define HAVE__STRLWR*/
+#define HAVE_STRCHR
+#define HAVE_STRRCHR
+#define HAVE_STRSTR
+/*#define HAVE_ITOA*/
+/*#define HAVE__LTOA*/
+/*#define HAVE__UITOA*/
+/*#define HAVE__ULTOA*/
+/*#define HAVE_STRTOL*/
+/*#define HAVE__I64TOA*/
+/*#define HAVE__UI64TOA*/
+/*#define HAVE_STRTOLL*/
+#define HAVE_STRCMP
+#define HAVE_STRNCMP
+/*#define HAVE_STRICMP*/
+/*#define HAVE_STRCASECMP*/
+#define HAVE_SSCANF
+/*#define HAVE_SNPRINTF*/
+#define HAVE_VSNPRINTF
+
+#endif /* HAVE_LIBC */
+
+#endif /* _SDL_config_h */
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_ctype.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
+/*
+    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
+    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
+
+    Sam Lantinga
+    slouken@libsdl.org
+*/
+
+/* This file contains portable character manipulation functions for SDL */
+
+#ifndef _SDL_CTYPE_H_
+#define _SDL_CTYPE_H_
+
+#include "SDL_config.h"
+
+#ifdef HAVE_CTYPE_H
+#include <ctype.h>
+#else
+#define isdigit(X)  (((X) >= '0') && ((X) <= '9'))
+#define isspace(X)  (((X) == ' ') || ((X) == '\t') || ((X) == '\r') || ((X) == '\n'))
+#define toupper(X)  (((X) >= 'a') && ((X) <= 'z') ? ('A'+((X)-'a')) : (X))
+#define tolower(X)  (((X) >= 'A') && ((X) <= 'Z') ? ('a'+((X)-'A')) : (X))
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _SDL_CTYPE_H_ */
--- a/include/SDL_endian.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_endian.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -37,8 +37,6 @@
          and other data sources.
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 #include "SDL_rwops.h"
 #include "SDL_byteorder.h"
--- a/include/SDL_events.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_events.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -38,6 +38,10 @@
 extern "C" {
 #endif
 
+/* General keyboard/mouse state definitions */
+#define SDL_RELEASED	0
+#define SDL_PRESSED	1
+
 /* Event enumerations */
 typedef enum {
        SDL_NOEVENT = 0,			/* Unused (do not remove) */
--- a/include/SDL_getenv.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_getenv.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -23,29 +23,31 @@
 #ifndef _SDL_getenv_h
 #define _SDL_getenv_h
 
+#include "SDL_config.h"
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#endif
+
 #include "begin_code.h"
 /* Set up for C function definitions, even when using C++ */
 #ifdef __cplusplus
 extern "C" {
 #endif
 
-/* Not all environments have a working getenv()/putenv() */
-
-#if defined(macintosh) || defined(WIN32) || defined(_WIN32_WCE)
-#define NEED_SDL_GETENV
+#ifdef HAVE_GETENV
+#define SDL_getenv	getenv
+#else
+#define getenv		SDL_getenv
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_getenv(const char *name);
 #endif
 
-#ifdef NEED_SDL_GETENV
-
-/* Put a variable of the form "name=value" into the environment */
+#ifdef HAVE_PUTENV
+#define SDL_putenv	putenv
+#else
+#define putenv		SDL_putenv
 extern DECLSPEC int SDLCALL SDL_putenv(const char *variable);
-#define putenv(X)   SDL_putenv(X)
-
-/* Retrieve a variable named "name" from the environment */
-extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_getenv(const char *name);
-#define getenv(X)     SDL_getenv(X)
-
-#endif /* NEED_GETENV */
+#endif
 
 /* Ends C function definitions when using C++ */
 #ifdef __cplusplus
--- a/include/SDL_mouse.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_mouse.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -115,7 +115,7 @@
    Button 4:	Mouse wheel up	 (may also be a real button)
    Button 5:	Mouse wheel down (may also be a real button)
  */
-#define SDL_BUTTON(X)		(SDL_PRESSED << ((X)-1))
+#define SDL_BUTTON(X)		(1 << ((X)-1))
 #define SDL_BUTTON_LEFT		1
 #define SDL_BUTTON_MIDDLE	2
 #define SDL_BUTTON_RIGHT	3
--- a/include/SDL_rwops.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_rwops.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -27,7 +27,11 @@
 #ifndef _SDL_RWops_h
 #define _SDL_RWops_h
 
+#include "SDL_config.h"
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDIO_H
 #include <stdio.h>
+#endif
 
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 
@@ -63,10 +67,12 @@
 
 	Uint32 type;
 	union {
+#ifdef HAVE_STDIO_H
 	    struct {
 		int autoclose;
 	 	FILE *fp;
 	    } stdio;
+#endif
 	    struct {
 		Uint8 *base;
 	 	Uint8 *here;
@@ -84,7 +90,9 @@
 
 extern DECLSPEC SDL_RWops * SDLCALL SDL_RWFromFile(const char *file, const char *mode);
 
+#ifdef HAVE_STDIO_H
 extern DECLSPEC SDL_RWops * SDLCALL SDL_RWFromFP(FILE *fp, int autoclose);
+#endif
 
 extern DECLSPEC SDL_RWops * SDLCALL SDL_RWFromMem(void *mem, int size);
 extern DECLSPEC SDL_RWops * SDLCALL SDL_RWFromConstMem(const void *mem, int size);
@@ -92,9 +100,13 @@
 extern DECLSPEC SDL_RWops * SDLCALL SDL_AllocRW(void);
 extern DECLSPEC void SDLCALL SDL_FreeRW(SDL_RWops *area);
 
+#define RW_SEEK_SET	0	/* Seek from the beginning of data */
+#define RW_SEEK_CUR	1	/* Seek relative to current read point */
+#define RW_SEEK_END	2	/* Seek relative to the end of data */
+
 /* Macros to easily read and write from an SDL_RWops structure */
 #define SDL_RWseek(ctx, offset, whence)	(ctx)->seek(ctx, offset, whence)
-#define SDL_RWtell(ctx)			(ctx)->seek(ctx, 0, SEEK_CUR)
+#define SDL_RWtell(ctx)			(ctx)->seek(ctx, 0, RW_SEEK_CUR)
 #define SDL_RWread(ctx, ptr, size, n)	(ctx)->read(ctx, ptr, size, n)
 #define SDL_RWwrite(ctx, ptr, size, n)	(ctx)->write(ctx, ptr, size, n)
 #define SDL_RWclose(ctx)		(ctx)->close(ctx)
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_stdarg.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+/*
+    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
+    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
+
+    Sam Lantinga
+    slouken@libsdl.org
+*/
+
+#ifndef _SDL_stdarg_h
+#define _SDL_stdarg_h
+
+#include "SDL_config.h"
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDARG_H
+#include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+#error Need stdarg.h equivalent for this platform
+#endif
+
+#endif /* _SDL_stdarg_h */
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_stdlib.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,105 @@
+/*
+    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
+    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
+
+    Sam Lantinga
+    slouken@libsdl.org
+*/
+
+#ifndef _SDL_stdlib_h
+#define _SDL_stdlib_h
+
+#include "SDL_config.h"
+
+/* AIX requires this to be the first thing in the file.  */
+#ifndef __GNUC__
+# if HAVE_ALLOCA_H
+#  include <alloca.h>
+# else
+#  ifdef _AIX
+ #pragma alloca
+#  else
+#   ifndef alloca /* predefined by HP cc +Olibcalls */
+char *alloca ();
+#   endif
+#  endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_MALLOC_H
+#include <malloc.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "SDL_types.h"
+#include "SDL_stdarg.h"
+#include "SDL_getenv.h"
+
+
+#include "begin_code.h"
+/* Set up for C function definitions, even when using C++ */
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_MALLOC
+#define SDL_malloc	malloc
+#else
+#define malloc		SDL_malloc
+extern DECLSPEC void * SDLCALL SDL_malloc(size_t size);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_REALLOC
+#define SDL_realloc	realloc
+#else
+#define realloc		SDL_realloc
+extern DECLSPEC void * SDLCALL SDL_realloc(void *mem, size_t size);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_FREE
+#define SDL_free	free
+#else
+#define free		SDL_free
+extern DECLSPEC void SDLCALL SDL_free(void *mem);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA
+#define SDL_stack_alloc(type, count)    (type*)alloca(sizeof(type)*count)
+#define SDL_stack_free(data)
+#else
+#define SDL_stack_alloc(type, count)    SDL_malloc(sizeof(type)*count)
+#define SDL_stack_free(data)            SDL_free(data)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_QSORT
+#define SDL_qsort	qsort
+#else
+#define qsort		SDL_qsort
+extern DECLSPEC void SDLCALL SDL_qsort(void *base, size_t nmemb, size_t size,
+           int (*compare)(const void *, const void *));
+#endif
+
+/* Ends C function definitions when using C++ */
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+#include "close_code.h"
+
+#endif /* _SDL_stdlib_h */
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_string.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,359 @@
+/*
+    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
+    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
+
+    Sam Lantinga
+    slouken@libsdl.org
+*/
+
+/* This file contains portable string manipulation functions for SDL */
+
+#ifndef _SDL_string_h
+#define _SDL_string_h
+
+#include "SDL_config.h"
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDIO_H
+#include <stdio.h>	/* For snprintf() and friends */
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRING_H
+#include <string.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "SDL_types.h"
+#include "SDL_stdarg.h"
+
+#include "begin_code.h"
+/* Set up for C function definitions, even when using C++ */
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_MEMSET
+#define memset          SDL_memset
+#endif
+#ifndef SDL_memset
+extern DECLSPEC void * SDLCALL SDL_memset(void *dst, int c, size_t len);
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__GNUC__) && defined(i386)
+#define SDL_memset4(dst, val, len)				\
+do {								\
+	int u0, u1, u2;						\
+	__asm__ __volatile__ (					\
+		"cld\n\t"					\
+		"rep ; stosl\n\t"				\
+		: "=&D" (u0), "=&a" (u1), "=&c" (u2)		\
+		: "0" (dst), "1" (val), "2" ((Uint32)(len))	\
+		: "memory" );					\
+} while(0)
+#endif
+#ifndef SDL_memset4
+#define SDL_memset4(dst, val, len)		\
+do {						\
+	unsigned _count = (len);		\
+	unsigned _n = (_count + 3) / 4;		\
+	Uint32 *_p = (Uint32 *)(dst);		\
+	Uint32 _val = (val);			\
+        switch (_count % 4) {			\
+        case 0: do {    *_p++ = _val;		\
+        case 3:         *_p++ = _val;		\
+        case 2:         *_p++ = _val;		\
+        case 1:         *_p++ = _val;		\
+		} while ( --_n );		\
+	}					\
+} while(0)
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__GNUC__) && defined(i386)
+#define SDL_memcpy(dst, src, len)					  \
+do {									  \
+	int u0, u1, u2;						  	  \
+	__asm__ __volatile__ (						  \
+		"cld\n\t"						  \
+		"rep ; movsl\n\t"					  \
+		"testb $2,%b4\n\t"					  \
+		"je 1f\n\t"						  \
+		"movsw\n"						  \
+		"1:\ttestb $1,%b4\n\t"					  \
+		"je 2f\n\t"						  \
+		"movsb\n"						  \
+		"2:"							  \
+		: "=&c" (u0), "=&D" (u1), "=&S" (u2)			  \
+		: "0" ((unsigned)(len)/4), "q" (len), "1" (dst),"2" (src) \
+		: "memory" );						  \
+} while(0)
+#define SDL_memcpy4(dst, src, len)				\
+do {								\
+	int ecx, edi, esi;					\
+	__asm__ __volatile__ (					\
+		"cld\n\t"					\
+		"rep ; movsl"					\
+		: "=&c" (ecx), "=&D" (edi), "=&S" (esi)		\
+		: "0" ((unsigned)(len)), "1" (dst), "2" (src)	\
+		: "memory" );					\
+} while(0)
+#endif
+#ifndef HAVE_MEMCPY
+#define memcpy          SDL_memcpy
+#endif
+#ifndef SDL_memcpy
+extern DECLSPEC void * SDLCALL SDL_memcpy(void *dst, const void *src, size_t len);
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__GNUC__) && defined(i386)
+#define SDL_memcpy4(dst, src, len)				\
+do {								\
+	int ecx, edi, esi;					\
+	__asm__ __volatile__ (					\
+		"cld\n\t"					\
+		"rep ; movsl"					\
+		: "=&c" (ecx), "=&D" (edi), "=&S" (esi)		\
+		: "0" ((unsigned)(len)), "1" (dst), "2" (src)	\
+		: "memory" );					\
+} while(0)
+#endif
+#ifndef SDL_memcpy4
+#define SDL_memcpy4(dst, src, len)	SDL_memcpy(dst, src, (len) << 2)
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__GNUC__) && defined(i386)
+#define SDL_revcpy(dst, src, len)			\
+do {							\
+	int u0, u1, u2;					\
+	char *dstp = (char *)(dst);			\
+	char *srcp = (char *)(src);			\
+	int n = (len);					\
+	if ( n >= 4 ) {					\
+	__asm__ __volatile__ (				\
+		"std\n\t"				\
+		"rep ; movsl\n\t"			\
+		: "=&c" (u0), "=&D" (u1), "=&S" (u2)	\
+		: "0" (n >> 2),				\
+		  "1" (dstp+(n-4)), "2" (srcp+(n-4))	\
+		: "memory" );				\
+	}						\
+	switch (n & 3) {				\
+		case 3: dstp[2] = srcp[2];		\
+		case 2: dstp[1] = srcp[1];		\
+		case 1: dstp[0] = srcp[0];		\
+			break;				\
+		default:				\
+			break;				\
+	}						\
+} while(0)
+#endif
+#ifndef SDL_revcpy
+extern DECLSPEC void * SDLCALL SDL_revcpy(void *dst, const void *src, size_t len);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_MEMMOVE
+#define memmove         SDL_memmove
+#endif
+#define SDL_memmove(dst, src, len)			\
+do {							\
+	if ( dst < src ) {				\
+		SDL_memcpy(dst, src, len);		\
+	} else {					\
+		SDL_revcpy(dst, src, len);		\
+	}						\
+} while(0)
+
+#ifndef HAVE_MEMCMP
+#define memcmp          SDL_memcmp
+#endif
+#ifndef SDL_memcmp
+extern DECLSPEC int SDLCALL SDL_memcmp(const void *s1, const void *s2, size_t len);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRLEN
+#define SDL_strlen      strlen
+#else
+#define strlen          SDL_strlen
+extern DECLSPEC size_t SDLCALL SDL_strlen(const char *string);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRCPY
+#define SDL_strcpy     strcpy
+#else
+#define strcpy         SDL_strcpy
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_strcpy(char *dst, const char *src);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRNCPY
+#define SDL_strncpy     strncpy
+#else
+#define strncpy         SDL_strncpy
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_strncpy(char *dst, const char *src, size_t maxlen);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE__STRREV
+#define SDL_strrev      _strrev
+#else
+#define _strrev	        SDL_strrev
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_strrev(char *string);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE__STRUPR
+#define SDL_strupr      _strupr
+#else
+#define _strupr         SDL_strupr
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_strupr(char *string);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE__STRLWR
+#define SDL_strlwr      _strlwr
+#else
+#define _strlwr         SDL_strlwr
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_strlwr(char *string);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRCHR
+#define SDL_strchr      strchr
+#else
+#define strchr          SDL_strchr
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_strchr(const char *string, int c);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRRCHR
+#define SDL_strrchr     strrchr
+#else
+#define strrchr         SDL_strrchr
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_strrchr(const char *string, int c);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRSTR
+#define SDL_strstr      strstr
+#else
+#define strstr          SDL_strstr
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_strstr(const char *haystack, const char *needle);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_ITOA
+#define SDL_itoa        itoa
+#else
+#define itoa            SDL_itoa
+#define SDL_itoa(value, string, radix)	SDL_ltoa((long)value, string, radix)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE__LTOA
+#define SDL_ltoa        _ltoa
+#else
+#define _ltoa        SDL_ltoa
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_ltoa(long value, char *string, int radix);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE__UITOA
+#define SDL_uitoa       _uitoa
+#else
+#define _uitoa          SDL_uitoa
+#define SDL_uitoa(value, string, radix)	SDL_ultoa((long)value, string, radix)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE__ULTOA
+#define SDL_ultoa       _ultoa
+#else
+#define _ultoa          SDL_ultoa
+extern DECLSPEC char * SDLCALL SDL_ultoa(unsigned long value, char *string, int radix);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRTOL
+#define SDL_strtol      strtol
+#else
+#define strtol          SDL_strtol
+extern DECLSPEC long SDLCALL SDL_strtol(const char *string, char **endp, int base);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE
+
+#ifdef HAVE__I64TOA
+#define SDL_lltoa       _i64toa
+#else
+#define _i64toa         SDL_lltoa
+extern DECLSPEC char* SDLCALL SDL_lltoa(Sint64 value, char *string, int radix);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE__UI64TOA
+#define SDL_ulltoa      _ui64toa
+#else
+#define _ui64toa        SDL_ulltoa
+extern DECLSPEC char* SDLCALL SDL_ulltoa(Uint64 value, char *string, int radix);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRTOLL
+#define SDL_strtoll     strtoll
+#else
+#define strtoll         SDL_strtoll
+extern DECLSPEC Sint64 SDLCALL SDL_strtoll(const char *string, char **endp, int base);
+#endif
+
+#endif /* SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRCMP
+#define SDL_strcmp      strcmp
+#else
+#define strcmp          SDL_strcmp
+extern DECLSPEC int SDLCALL SDL_strcmp(const char *str1, const char *str2);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STRNCMP
+#define SDL_strncmp     strncmp
+#else
+#define strncmp         SDL_strncmp
+extern DECLSPEC int SDLCALL SDL_strncmp(const char *str1, const char *str2, size_t maxlen);
+#endif
+
+#if defined(HAVE_STRICMP) && !defined(HAVE_STRCASECMP)
+#define strcasecmp      stricmp
+#define HAVE_STRCASECMP
+#endif
+#ifdef HAVE_STRCASECMP
+#define SDL_strcasecmp  strcasecmp
+#else
+#define strcasecmp      SDL_strcasecmp
+extern DECLSPEC int SDLCALL SDL_strcasecmp(const char *str1, const char *str2);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_SSCANF
+#define SDL_sscanf      sscanf
+#else
+#define sscanf          SDL_sscanf
+extern DECLSPEC int SDLCALL SDL_sscanf(const char *text, const char *fmt, ...);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_SNPRINTF
+#define SDL_snprintf    snprintf
+#else
+#define snprintf        SDL_snprintf
+extern DECLSPEC int SDLCALL SDL_snprintf(char *text, size_t maxlen, const char *fmt, ...);
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_VSNPRINTF
+#define SDL_vsnprintf   vsnprintf
+#else
+#define vsnprintf       SDL_vsnprintf
+extern DECLSPEC int SDLCALL SDL_vsnprintf(char *text, size_t maxlen, const char *fmt, va_list ap);
+#endif
+
+/* Ends C function definitions when using C++ */
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+#include "close_code.h"
+
+#endif /* _SDL_string_h */
--- a/include/SDL_syswm.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_syswm.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -119,8 +119,7 @@
 } SDL_SysWMinfo;
 
 #elif defined(WIN32)
-#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 /* The windows custom event structure */
 struct SDL_SysWMmsg {
--- a/include/SDL_thread.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_thread.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -45,7 +45,7 @@
 typedef struct SDL_Thread SDL_Thread;
 
 /* Create a thread */
-#ifdef __OS2__
+#if defined(_WIN32) || defined(__OS2__)
 /*
    We compile SDL into a DLL on OS/2. This means, that it's the DLL which
    creates a new thread for the calling process with the SDL_CreateThread()
@@ -53,39 +53,39 @@
    be initialized for those threads, and not the RTL of the calling application!
    To solve this, we make a little hack here.
    We'll always use the caller's _beginthread() and _endthread() APIs to
-   start a new thread. This way, it it's the SDL.DLL which uses this API,
+   start a new thread. This way, if it's the SDL.DLL which uses this API,
    then the RTL of SDL.DLL will be used to create the new thread, and if it's
    the application, then the RTL of the application will be used.
    So, in short:
    Always use the _beginthread() and _endthread() of the calling runtime library!
 */
-
-#ifdef __WATCOMC__
 #include <process.h> // This has _beginthread() and _endthread() defined!
-#endif
 #ifdef __EMX__
 #include <stdlib.h> // This has _beginthread() and _endthread() defined, if -Zmt flag is used!
 #endif
 
-typedef Uint32 SDLCALL (*pfnSDL_CurrentBeginThread)(void (*pfnThreadFn)(void *), Uint32 uiStackSize, void *pParam);
-typedef void   SDLCALL (*pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread)(void);
-
-extern DECLSPEC SDL_Thread * SDLCALL SDL_CreateThread_Core(int (*fn)(void *), void *data, pfnSDL_CurrentBeginThread pfnBeginThread, pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread pfnEndThread);
+#ifdef __OS2__
+typedef int (__cdecl *pfnSDL_CurrentBeginThread)(void (*func)(void *), void *, unsigned, void *arg); 
+typedef void (__cdecl *pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread)(void);
+#else
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+#include <stdint.h>
+#endif
+typedef uintptr_t (__cdecl *pfnSDL_CurrentBeginThread) (void *, unsigned,
+        unsigned (__stdcall *func)(void *), void *arg, 
+        unsigned, unsigned *threadID);
+typedef void (__cdecl *pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread)(unsigned code);
+#endif
 
-// Disable warnings about unreferenced symbol!
-#pragma disable_message (202)
-static Uint32 SDLCALL SDL_CurrentBeginThread(void (*pfnThreadFn)(void *), Uint32 uiStackSize, void *pParam)
-{
-  return _beginthread(pfnThreadFn, NULL, uiStackSize, pParam);
-}
+extern DECLSPEC SDL_Thread * SDLCALL SDL_CreateThread(int (*fn)(void *), void *data, pfnSDL_CurrentBeginThread pfnBeginThread, pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread pfnEndThread);
 
-static void   SDLCALL SDL_CurrentEndThread(void)
-{
-  _endthread();
-}
-
-#define SDL_CreateThread(fn, data) SDL_CreateThread_Core(fn, data, SDL_CurrentBeginThread, SDL_CurrentEndThread)
-
+#ifdef __OS2__
+#define SDL_CreateThread(fn, data) SDL_CreateThread(fn, data, _beginthread, _endthread)
+#elif defined(_WIN32_WCE)
+#define SDL_CreateThread(fn, data) SDL_CreateThread(fn, data, NULL, NULL)
+#else
+#define SDL_CreateThread(fn, data) SDL_CreateThread(fn, data, _beginthreadex, _endthreadex)
+#endif
 #else
 extern DECLSPEC SDL_Thread * SDLCALL SDL_CreateThread(int (SDLCALL *fn)(void *), void *data);
 #endif
--- a/include/SDL_types.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_types.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -25,11 +25,17 @@
 #ifndef _SDL_types_h
 #define _SDL_types_h
 
-/* The number of elements in a table */
-#define SDL_TABLESIZE(table)	(sizeof(table)/sizeof(table[0]))
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#ifdef _MSC_VER
+#include <crtdefs.h>	/* For size_t */
+#endif
+
+/* The number of elements in an array */
+#define SDL_arraysize(array)	(sizeof(array)/sizeof(array[0]))
+#define SDL_TABLESIZE(table)	SDL_arraysize(table)
 
 /* Basic data types */
-typedef enum {
+typedef enum SDL_bool {
 	SDL_FALSE = 0,
 	SDL_TRUE  = 1
 } SDL_bool;
@@ -107,9 +113,4 @@
 
 SDL_COMPILE_TIME_ASSERT(enum, sizeof(SDL_DUMMY_ENUM) == sizeof(int));
 
-#undef SDL_COMPILE_TIME_ASSERT
-
-/* General keyboard/mouse state definitions */
-enum { SDL_PRESSED = 0x01, SDL_RELEASED = 0x00 };
-
 #endif
--- a/include/SDL_video.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_video.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -25,8 +25,6 @@
 #ifndef _SDL_video_h
 #define _SDL_video_h
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 #include "SDL_mutex.h"
 #include "SDL_rwops.h"
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/include/SDL_windows.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
+/*
+    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
+    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
+
+    Sam Lantinga
+    slouken@libsdl.org
+*/
+
+#ifndef _SDL_windows_h
+#define _SDL_windows_h
+
+#include "SDL_config.h"
+
+/* This includes only the windows headers needed by SDL, with no C runtime */
+#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
+#ifndef HAVE_LIBC
+#ifdef _MSC_VER
+#ifndef __FLTUSED__
+#define __FLTUSED__
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+   extern "C"
+#endif
+	   __declspec(selectany) int _fltused=1;
+#endif
+#endif /* _MSC_VER */
+#define _INC_STDLIB
+#define _INC_STRING
+#define __STRALIGN_H_
+#endif/* !HAVE_LIBC */
+#include <windows.h>
+
+#endif /* _SDL_windows_h */
--- a/src/Makefile.am	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/Makefile.am	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@
 
 # These are the subdirectories that are always built
 CORE_SUBDIRS =			\
-	main
+	main stdlib
 
 # These are the subdirectories which may be built
 EXTRA_SUBDIRS =			\
@@ -25,10 +25,12 @@
 	-version-info $(LT_CURRENT):$(LT_REVISION):$(LT_AGE)
 libSDL_la_LIBADD =		\
 	main/libarch.la		\
+	stdlib/libstdlib.la	\
 	@SDL_EXTRALIBS@		\
 	@SYSTEM_LIBS@
 libSDL_la_DEPENDENCIES =	\
 	main/libarch.la		\
+	stdlib/libstdlib.la	\
 	@SDL_EXTRALIBS@
 
 # The SDL library sources
@@ -38,6 +40,5 @@
 	SDL_error_c.h		\
 	SDL_fatal.c		\
 	SDL_fatal.h		\
-	SDL_getenv.c		\
 	SDL_loadso.c
 
--- a/src/SDL.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/SDL.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,7 +22,6 @@
 
 /* Initialization code for SDL */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>		/* For getenv() */
 #ifdef ENABLE_PTH
 #include <pth.h>
 #endif
@@ -30,6 +29,7 @@
 #include "SDL.h"
 #include "SDL_endian.h"
 #include "SDL_fatal.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
 #ifndef DISABLE_VIDEO
 #include "SDL_leaks.h"
 #endif
@@ -253,26 +253,7 @@
 	return(&version);
 }
 
-#ifndef __OS2__
-#if defined(_WIN32_WCE) || (defined(__WATCOMC__) && defined(BUILD_DLL))
-/* Need to include DllMain() on Windows CE and Watcom C for some reason.. */
-#include <windows.h>
-
-BOOL APIENTRY DllMain( HANDLE hModule, 
-                       DWORD  ul_reason_for_call, 
-                       LPVOID lpReserved )
-{
-	switch (ul_reason_for_call) {
-		case DLL_PROCESS_ATTACH:
-		case DLL_THREAD_ATTACH:
-		case DLL_THREAD_DETACH:
-		case DLL_PROCESS_DETACH:
-			break;
-	}
-	return TRUE;
-}
-#endif /* _WIN32_WCE and building DLL with Watcom C */
-#else
+#if defined(__OS2__)
 // Building for OS/2
 #ifdef __WATCOMC__
 
@@ -341,6 +322,27 @@
     return 1;
   }
 }
+#endif /* __WATCOMC__ */
 
-#endif
-#endif
+#elif defined(_WIN32)
+
+#if !defined(HAVE_LIBC) || defined(_WIN32_WCE) || (defined(__WATCOMC__) && defined(BUILD_DLL))
+/* Need to include DllMain() on Windows CE and Watcom C for some reason.. */
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
+
+BOOL APIENTRY _DllMainCRTStartup( HANDLE hModule, 
+                       DWORD  ul_reason_for_call, 
+                       LPVOID lpReserved )
+{
+	switch (ul_reason_for_call) {
+		case DLL_PROCESS_ATTACH:
+		case DLL_THREAD_ATTACH:
+		case DLL_THREAD_DETACH:
+		case DLL_PROCESS_DETACH:
+			break;
+	}
+	return TRUE;
+}
+#endif /* _WIN32_WCE and building DLL with Watcom C */
+
+#endif /* OS/2 elif _WIN32 */
--- a/src/SDL_error.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/SDL_error.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,13 +22,9 @@
 
 /* Simple error handling in SDL */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <stdarg.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_types.h"
-#include "SDL_getenv.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_error_c.h"
 #ifndef DISABLE_THREADS
@@ -42,10 +38,6 @@
 #define SDL_GetErrBuf()	(&SDL_global_error)
 #endif /* DISABLE_THREADS */
 
-#ifdef __CYGWIN__
-#define DISABLE_STDIO
-#endif
-
 #define SDL_ERRBUFIZE	1024
 
 /* Private functions */
@@ -121,16 +113,10 @@
 	}
 	va_end(ap);
 
-#ifndef DISABLE_STDIO
 	/* If we are in debug mode, print out an error message */
 #ifdef DEBUG_ERROR
 	fprintf(stderr, "SDL_SetError: %s\n", SDL_GetError());
-#else
-	if ( getenv("SDL_DEBUG") ) {
-		fprintf(stderr, "SDL_SetError: %s\n", SDL_GetError());
-	}
 #endif
-#endif /* !DISABLE_STDIO */
 }
 
 /* Print out an integer value to a UNICODE buffer */
@@ -139,7 +125,7 @@
 	char tmp[128];
 	int len, i;
 
-	sprintf(tmp, "%d", value);
+	snprintf(tmp, SDL_arraysize(tmp), "%d", value);
 	len = 0;
 	if ( strlen(tmp) < maxlen ) {
 		for ( i=0; tmp[i]; ++i ) {
@@ -155,7 +141,7 @@
 	char tmp[128];
 	int len, i;
 
-	sprintf(tmp, "%f", value);
+	snprintf(tmp, SDL_arraysize(tmp), "%f", value);
 	len = 0;
 	if ( strlen(tmp) < maxlen ) {
 		for ( i=0; tmp[i]; ++i ) {
@@ -171,7 +157,7 @@
 	char tmp[128];
 	int len, i;
 
-	sprintf(tmp, "%p", value);
+	snprintf(tmp, SDL_arraysize(tmp), "%p", value);
 	len = 0;
 	if ( strlen(tmp) < maxlen ) {
 		for ( i=0; tmp[i]; ++i ) {
--- a/src/SDL_fatal.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/SDL_fatal.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,91 +20,27 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#ifdef _WIN32_WCE
-#define NO_SIGNAL_H
-#endif
- 
 /* General fatal signal handling code for SDL */
 
-#ifdef NO_SIGNAL_H
-
-/* No signals on this platform, nothing to do.. */
-
-void SDL_InstallParachute(void)
-{
-	return;
-}
+#include "SDL_config.h"
 
-void SDL_UninstallParachute(void)
-{
-	return;
-}
+#ifdef HAVE_SIGNAL_H
 
-#else
-
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <stdio.h>
 #include <signal.h>
-#include <string.h>
 
 #include "SDL.h"
 #include "SDL_fatal.h"
 
-#ifdef __CYGWIN__
-#define DISABLE_STDIO
-#endif
-
 /* This installs some signal handlers for the more common fatal signals,
    so that if the programmer is lazy, the app doesn't die so horribly if
    the program crashes.
 */
 
-static void print_msg(const char *text)
-{
-#ifndef DISABLE_STDIO
-	fprintf(stderr, "%s", text);
-#endif
-}
-
 static void SDL_Parachute(int sig)
 {
 	signal(sig, SIG_DFL);
-	print_msg("Fatal signal: ");
-	switch (sig) {
-		case SIGSEGV:
-			print_msg("Segmentation Fault");
-			break;
-#ifdef SIGBUS
-#if SIGBUS != SIGSEGV
-		case SIGBUS:
-			print_msg("Bus Error");
-			break;
-#endif
-#endif /* SIGBUS */
-#ifdef SIGFPE
-		case SIGFPE:
-			print_msg("Floating Point Exception");
-			break;
-#endif /* SIGFPE */
-#ifdef SIGQUIT
-		case SIGQUIT:
-			print_msg("Keyboard Quit");
-			break;
-#endif /* SIGQUIT */
-#ifdef SIGPIPE
-		case SIGPIPE:
-			print_msg("Broken Pipe");
-			break;
-#endif /* SIGPIPE */
-		default:
-#ifndef DISABLE_STDIO
-			fprintf(stderr, "# %d", sig);
-#endif
-			break;
-	}
-	print_msg(" (SDL Parachute Deployed)\n");
 	SDL_Quit();
-	exit(-sig);
+	raise(sig);
 }
 
 static int SDL_fatal_signals[] = {
@@ -182,4 +118,18 @@
 #endif /* HAVE_SIGACTION */
 }
 
-#endif /* NO_SIGNAL_H */
+#else
+
+/* No signals on this platform, nothing to do.. */
+
+void SDL_InstallParachute(void)
+{
+	return;
+}
+
+void SDL_UninstallParachute(void)
+{
+	return;
+}
+
+#endif /* HAVE_SIGNAL_H */
--- a/src/SDL_getenv.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
@@ -1,258 +0,0 @@
-/*
-    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
-    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
-
-    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
-    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
-    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
-    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
-
-    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
-    Lesser General Public License for more details.
-
-    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
-    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
-    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
-
-    Sam Lantinga
-    slouken@libsdl.org
-*/
-
-/* Not all environments have a working getenv()/putenv() */
-
-#ifdef TEST_MAIN
-#define NEED_SDL_GETENV
-#endif
-
-#include "SDL_getenv.h"
-
-#ifdef NEED_SDL_GETENV
-
-#if defined(WIN32) && !defined(_WIN32_WCE)
-
-#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
-#include <windows.h>
-#include <malloc.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
-/* Note this isn't thread-safe! */
-
-static char *SDL_envmem = NULL;	/* Ugh, memory leak */
-static DWORD SDL_envmemlen = 0;
-
-/* Put a variable of the form "name=value" into the environment */
-int SDL_putenv(const char *variable)
-{
-	DWORD bufferlen;
-	char *value;
-	const char *sep;
-
-	sep = strchr(variable, '=');
-	if ( sep == NULL ) {
-		return -1;
-	}
-	bufferlen = strlen(variable)+1;
-	if ( bufferlen > SDL_envmemlen ) {
-		char *newmem = (char *)realloc(SDL_envmem, bufferlen);
-		if ( newmem == NULL ) {
-			return -1;
-		}
-		SDL_envmem = newmem;
-		SDL_envmemlen = bufferlen;
-	}
-	strcpy(SDL_envmem, variable);
-	value = SDL_envmem + (sep - variable);
-	*value++ = '\0';
-	if ( !SetEnvironmentVariable(SDL_envmem, *value ? value : NULL) ) {
-		return -1;
-	}
-	return 0;
-}
-
-/* Retrieve a variable named "name" from the environment */
-char *SDL_getenv(const char *name)
-{
-	DWORD bufferlen;
-
-	bufferlen = GetEnvironmentVariable(name, SDL_envmem, SDL_envmemlen);
-	if ( bufferlen == 0 ) {
-		return NULL;
-	}
-	if ( bufferlen > SDL_envmemlen ) {
-		char *newmem = (char *)realloc(SDL_envmem, bufferlen);
-		if ( newmem == NULL ) {
-			return NULL;
-		}
-		SDL_envmem = newmem;
-		SDL_envmemlen = bufferlen;
-		GetEnvironmentVariable(name, SDL_envmem, SDL_envmemlen);
-	}
-	return SDL_envmem;
-}
-
-#else /* roll our own */
-
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
-static char **SDL_env = (char **)0;
-
-/* Put a variable of the form "name=value" into the environment */
-int SDL_putenv(const char *variable)
-{
-	const char *name, *value;
-	int added;
-	int len, i;
-	char **new_env;
-	char *new_variable;
-
-	/* A little error checking */
-	if ( ! variable ) {
-		return(-1);
-	}
-	name = variable;
-	for ( value=variable; *value && (*value != '='); ++value ) {
-		/* Keep looking for '=' */ ;
-	}
-	if ( *value ) {
-		++value;
-	} else {
-		return(-1);
-	}
-
-	/* Allocate memory for the variable */
-	new_variable = (char *)malloc(strlen(variable)+1);
-	if ( ! new_variable ) {
-		return(-1);
-	}
-	strcpy(new_variable, variable);
-
-	/* Actually put it into the environment */
-	added = 0;
-	i = 0;
-	if ( SDL_env ) {
-		/* Check to see if it's already there... */
-		len = (value - name);
-		for ( ; SDL_env[i]; ++i ) {
-			if ( strncmp(SDL_env[i], name, len) == 0 ) {
-				break;
-			}
-		}
-		/* If we found it, just replace the entry */
-		if ( SDL_env[i] ) {
-			free(SDL_env[i]);
-			SDL_env[i] = new_variable;
-			added = 1;
-		}
-	}
-
-	/* Didn't find it in the environment, expand and add */
-	if ( ! added ) {
-		new_env = realloc(SDL_env, (i+2)*sizeof(char *));
-		if ( new_env ) {
-			SDL_env = new_env;
-			SDL_env[i++] = new_variable;
-			SDL_env[i++] = (char *)0;
-			added = 1;
-		} else {
-			free(new_variable);
-		}
-	}
-	return (added ? 0 : -1);
-}
-
-/* Retrieve a variable named "name" from the environment */
-char *SDL_getenv(const char *name)
-{
-	int len, i;
-	char *value;
-
-	value = (char *)0;
-	if ( SDL_env ) {
-		len = strlen(name);
-		for ( i=0; SDL_env[i] && !value; ++i ) {
-			if ( (strncmp(SDL_env[i], name, len) == 0) &&
-			     (SDL_env[i][len] == '=') ) {
-				value = &SDL_env[i][len+1];
-			}
-		}
-	}
-	return value;
-}
-
-#endif /* WIN32 */
-
-#endif /* NEED_GETENV */
-
-#ifdef TEST_MAIN
-#include <stdio.h>
-
-int main(int argc, char *argv[])
-{
-	char *value;
-
-	printf("Checking for non-existent variable... ");
-	fflush(stdout);
-	if ( ! getenv("EXISTS") ) {
-		printf("okay\n");
-	} else {
-		printf("failed\n");
-	}
-	printf("Setting FIRST=VALUE1 in the environment... ");
-	fflush(stdout);
-	if ( putenv("FIRST=VALUE1") == 0 ) {
-		printf("okay\n");
-	} else {
-		printf("failed\n");
-	}
-	printf("Getting FIRST from the environment... ");
-	fflush(stdout);
-	value = getenv("FIRST");
-	if ( value && (strcmp(value, "VALUE1") == 0) ) {
-		printf("okay\n");
-	} else {
-		printf("failed\n");
-	}
-	printf("Setting SECOND=VALUE2 in the environment... ");
-	fflush(stdout);
-	if ( putenv("SECOND=VALUE2") == 0 ) {
-		printf("okay\n");
-	} else {
-		printf("failed\n");
-	}
-	printf("Getting SECOND from the environment... ");
-	fflush(stdout);
-	value = getenv("SECOND");
-	if ( value && (strcmp(value, "VALUE2") == 0) ) {
-		printf("okay\n");
-	} else {
-		printf("failed\n");
-	}
-	printf("Setting FIRST=NOVALUE in the environment... ");
-	fflush(stdout);
-	if ( putenv("FIRST=NOVALUE") == 0 ) {
-		printf("okay\n");
-	} else {
-		printf("failed\n");
-	}
-	printf("Getting FIRST from the environment... ");
-	fflush(stdout);
-	value = getenv("FIRST");
-	if ( value && (strcmp(value, "NOVALUE") == 0) ) {
-		printf("okay\n");
-	} else {
-		printf("failed\n");
-	}
-	printf("Checking for non-existent variable... ");
-	fflush(stdout);
-	if ( ! getenv("EXISTS") ) {
-		printf("okay\n");
-	} else {
-		printf("failed\n");
-	}
-	return(0);
-}
-#endif /* TEST_MAIN */
-
--- a/src/audio/SDL_audio.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/audio/SDL_audio.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -21,14 +21,12 @@
 */
 
 /* Allow access to a raw mixing buffer */
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <string.h>
 
 #include "SDL.h"
 #include "SDL_audio.h"
 #include "SDL_timer.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_audio_c.h"
 #include "SDL_audiomem.h"
 #include "SDL_sysaudio.h"
@@ -456,7 +454,12 @@
 	D(bug("Locking semaphore..."));
 	SDL_mutexP(audio->mixer_lock);
 
+#if (defined(_WIN32) && !defined(_WIN32_WCE)) && !defined(HAVE_LIBC)
+#undef SDL_CreateThread
+	audio->thread = SDL_CreateThread(SDL_RunAudio, audio, NULL, NULL);
+#else
 	audio->thread = SDL_CreateThread(SDL_RunAudio, audio);
+#endif
 	D(bug("Created thread...\n"));
 
 	if ( audio->thread == NULL ) {
@@ -516,7 +519,12 @@
 	switch (audio->opened) {
 		case  1:
 			/* Start the audio thread */
+#if (defined(_WIN32) && !defined(_WIN32_WCE)) && !defined(HAVE_LIBC)
+#undef SDL_CreateThread
+			audio->thread = SDL_CreateThread(SDL_RunAudio, audio, NULL, NULL);
+#else
 			audio->thread = SDL_CreateThread(SDL_RunAudio, audio);
+#endif
 			if ( audio->thread == NULL ) {
 				SDL_CloseAudio();
 				SDL_SetError("Couldn't create audio thread");
--- a/src/audio/SDL_audiocvt.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/audio/SDL_audiocvt.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,8 +22,6 @@
 
 /* Functions for audio drivers to perform runtime conversion of audio format */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_audio.h"
 
--- a/src/audio/SDL_audiomem.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/audio/SDL_audiomem.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -24,7 +24,6 @@
 	(necessary because SDL audio emulates threads with fork()
  */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
 #ifdef FORK_HACK
 #include <sys/types.h>
 #include <sys/ipc.h>
@@ -33,6 +32,7 @@
 #endif
 
 #include "SDL_audiomem.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
 
 /* Allocate memory that will be shared between threads (freed on exit) */
 void *SDL_AllocAudioMem(int size)
--- a/src/audio/SDL_mixer.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/audio/SDL_mixer.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,10 +22,6 @@
 
 /* This provides the default mixing callback for the SDL audio routines */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_audio.h"
 #include "SDL_mutex.h"
 #include "SDL_timer.h"
--- a/src/audio/SDL_mixer_MMX_VC.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/audio/SDL_mixer_MMX_VC.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -1,3 +1,6 @@
+
+#include "SDL_mixer_MMX_VC.h"
+
 #if defined(USE_ASM_MIXER_VC)
 // MMX assembler version of SDL_MixAudio for signed little endian 16 bit samples and signed 8 bit samples
 // Copyright 2002 Stephane Marchesin (stephane.marchesin@wanadoo.fr)
@@ -12,11 +15,6 @@
 // Mixing for 16 bit signed buffers
 ////////////////////////////////////////////////
 
-#ifndef __WATCOMC__
-#include <windows.h>
-#include <stdio.h>
-#endif
-
 void SDL_MixAudio_MMX_S16_VC(char* dst,char* src,unsigned int nSize,int volume)
 {
 	__asm
--- a/src/audio/SDL_mixer_MMX_VC.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/audio/SDL_mixer_MMX_VC.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -1,3 +1,6 @@
+#ifdef _MSC_VER
+#define USE_ASM_MIXER_VC
+#endif
 #if defined(USE_ASM_MIXER_VC)
 // headers for MMX assembler version of SDL_MixAudio
 // Copyright 2002 Stephane Marchesin (stephane.marchesin@wanadoo.fr)
--- a/src/audio/SDL_wave.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/audio/SDL_wave.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -24,17 +24,13 @@
 
 /* Microsoft WAVE file loading routines */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_audio.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_wave.h"
 #include "SDL_endian.h"
 
-#ifndef NELEMS
-#define NELEMS(array)	((sizeof array)/(sizeof array[0]))
-#endif
 
 static int ReadChunk(SDL_RWops *src, Chunk *chunk);
 
@@ -342,9 +338,9 @@
 
 	/* Check to make sure we have enough variables in the state array */
 	channels = IMA_ADPCM_state.wavefmt.channels;
-	if ( channels > NELEMS(IMA_ADPCM_state.state) ) {
+	if ( channels > SDL_arraysize(IMA_ADPCM_state.state) ) {
 		SDL_SetError("IMA ADPCM decoder can only handle %d channels",
-						NELEMS(IMA_ADPCM_state.state));
+					SDL_arraysize(IMA_ADPCM_state.state));
 		return(-1);
 	}
 	state = IMA_ADPCM_state.state;
@@ -564,7 +560,7 @@
 	}
 	else {
 		// seek to the end of the file (given by the RIFF chunk)
-		SDL_RWseek(src, wavelen - chunk.length - headerDiff, SEEK_CUR);
+		SDL_RWseek(src, wavelen - chunk.length - headerDiff, RW_SEEK_CUR);
 	}
 	if ( was_error ) {
 		spec = NULL;
--- a/src/audio/windib/SDL_dibaudio.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/audio/windib/SDL_dibaudio.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,14 +22,14 @@
 
 /* Allow access to a raw mixing buffer */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 #include <mmsystem.h>
 
 #include "SDL_audio.h"
 #include "SDL_mutex.h"
 #include "SDL_timer.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_audio_c.h"
 #include "SDL_dibaudio.h"
 #if defined(_WIN32_WCE) && (_WIN32_WCE < 300)
@@ -125,7 +125,7 @@
 	wchar_t werrbuf[MAXERRORLENGTH];
 #endif
 
-	sprintf(errbuf, "%s: ", function);
+	snprintf(errbuf, SDL_arraysize(errbuf), "%s: ", function);
 	len = strlen(errbuf);
 
 #ifdef _WIN32_WCE
--- a/src/audio/windx5/SDL_dx5audio.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/audio/windx5/SDL_dx5audio.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,12 +22,12 @@
 
 /* Allow access to a raw mixing buffer */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_timer.h"
 #include "SDL_audio.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_audio_c.h"
 #include "SDL_dx5audio.h"
 
@@ -223,12 +223,13 @@
 			error = "Function not supported";
 			break;
 		default:
-			sprintf(errbuf, "%s: Unknown DirectSound error: 0x%x",
+			snprintf(errbuf, SDL_arraysize(errbuf),
+			         "%s: Unknown DirectSound error: 0x%x",
 								function, code);
 			break;
 	}
 	if ( ! errbuf[0] ) {
-		sprintf(errbuf, "%s: %s", function, error);
+		snprintf(errbuf, SDL_arraysize(errbuf), "%s: %s", function, error);
 	}
 	SDL_SetError("%s", errbuf);
 	return;
--- a/src/audio/windx5/directx.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/audio/windx5/directx.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -4,7 +4,7 @@
 
 /* Include all of the DirectX 5.0 headers and adds any necessary tweaks */
 
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 #include <mmsystem.h>
 #ifndef WIN32
 #define WIN32
--- a/src/cdrom/SDL_cdrom.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/cdrom/SDL_cdrom.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,12 +22,10 @@
 
 /* This is the CD-audio control API for Simple DirectMedia Layer */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_cdrom.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_syscdrom.h"
 
 #if !defined(macintosh)
--- a/src/cdrom/win32/SDL_syscdrom.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/cdrom/win32/SDL_syscdrom.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,13 +22,13 @@
 
 /* Functions for system-level CD-ROM audio control */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 #include <mmsystem.h>
 
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_cdrom.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_syscdrom.h"
 
 /* This really broken?? */
@@ -99,7 +99,7 @@
 
 	/* Scan the system for CD-ROM drives */
 	for ( i='A'; i<='Z'; ++i ) {
-		sprintf(drive, "%c:\\", i);
+		snprintf(drive, SDL_arraysize(drive), "%c:\\", i);
 		if ( GetDriveType(drive) == DRIVE_CDROM ) {
 			AddDrive(drive);
 		}
--- a/src/events/SDL_active.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/events/SDL_active.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,10 +22,8 @@
 
 /* Application focus/iconification handling code for SDL */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_events.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 
 
--- a/src/events/SDL_events.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/events/SDL_events.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,13 +22,11 @@
 
 /* General event handling code for SDL */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL.h"
 #include "SDL_thread.h"
 #include "SDL_mutex.h"
 #include "SDL_events.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 #include "SDL_timer_c.h"
 #ifndef DISABLE_JOYSTICK
@@ -177,7 +175,12 @@
 
 		/* The event thread will handle timers too */
 		SDL_SetTimerThreaded(2);
+#if (defined(_WIN32) && !defined(_WIN32_WCE)) && !defined(HAVE_LIBC)
+#undef SDL_CreateThread
+		SDL_EventThread = SDL_CreateThread(SDL_GobbleEvents, NULL, NULL, NULL);
+#else
 		SDL_EventThread = SDL_CreateThread(SDL_GobbleEvents, NULL);
+#endif
 		if ( SDL_EventThread == NULL ) {
 			return(-1);
 		}
--- a/src/events/SDL_keyboard.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/events/SDL_keyboard.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,14 +22,10 @@
 
 /* General keyboard handling code for SDL */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_events.h"
 #include "SDL_timer.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 #include "SDL_sysevents.h"
 
@@ -58,17 +54,14 @@
 {
 	SDL_VideoDevice *video = current_video;
 	SDL_VideoDevice *this  = current_video;
-	Uint16 i;
 
 	/* Set default mode of UNICODE translation */
 	SDL_EnableUNICODE(DEFAULT_UNICODE_TRANSLATION);
 
 	/* Initialize the tables */
 	SDL_ModState = KMOD_NONE;
-	for ( i=0; i<SDL_TABLESIZE(keynames); ++i )
-		keynames[i] = NULL;
-	for ( i=0; i<SDL_TABLESIZE(SDL_KeyState); ++i )
-		SDL_KeyState[i] = SDL_RELEASED;
+	memset(keynames, 0, sizeof(keynames));
+	memset(SDL_KeyState, 0, sizeof(SDL_KeyState));
 	video->InitOSKeymap(this);
 
 	SDL_EnableKeyRepeat(0, 0);
--- a/src/events/SDL_mouse.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/events/SDL_mouse.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,11 +22,8 @@
 
 /* General mouse handling code for SDL */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_events.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 #include "SDL_cursor_c.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
--- a/src/events/SDL_quit.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/events/SDL_quit.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,12 +22,9 @@
 
 /* General quit handling code for SDL */
 
-#if defined (_WIN32_WCE)
-#define NO_SIGNAL_H
-#endif
+#include "SDL_config.h"
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#ifndef NO_SIGNAL_H
+#ifdef HAVE_SIGNAL_H
 #include <signal.h>
 #endif
 
@@ -35,7 +32,7 @@
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 
 
-#ifndef NO_SIGNAL_H
+#ifdef HAVE_SIGNAL_H
 static void SDL_HandleSIG(int sig)
 {
 	/* Reset the signal handler */
@@ -44,12 +41,12 @@
 	/* Signal a quit interrupt */
 	SDL_PrivateQuit();
 }
-#endif /* NO_SIGNAL_H */
+#endif /* HAVE_SIGNAL_H */
 
 /* Public functions */
 int SDL_QuitInit(void)
 {
-#ifndef NO_SIGNAL_H
+#ifdef HAVE_SIGNAL_H
 	void (*ohandler)(int);
 
 	/* Both SIGINT and SIGTERM are translated into quit interrupts */
@@ -59,14 +56,14 @@
 	ohandler = signal(SIGTERM, SDL_HandleSIG);
 	if ( ohandler != SIG_DFL )
 		signal(SIGTERM, ohandler);
-#endif /* NO_SIGNAL_H */
+#endif /* HAVE_SIGNAL_H */
 
 	/* That's it! */
 	return(0);
 }
 void SDL_QuitQuit(void)
 {
-#ifndef NO_SIGNAL_H
+#ifdef HAVE_SIGNAL_H
 	void (*ohandler)(int);
 
 	ohandler = signal(SIGINT, SIG_DFL);
@@ -75,7 +72,7 @@
 	ohandler = signal(SIGTERM, SIG_DFL);
 	if ( ohandler != SDL_HandleSIG )
 		signal(SIGTERM, ohandler);
-#endif /* NO_SIGNAL_H */
+#endif /* HAVE_SIGNAL_H */
 }
 
 /* This function returns 1 if it's okay to close the application window */
--- a/src/file/SDL_rwops.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/file/SDL_rwops.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -24,12 +24,12 @@
    data sources.  It can easily be extended to files, memory, etc.
 */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_rwops.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
+
+#ifdef HAVE_STDIO_H
 
 /* Functions to read/write stdio file pointers */
 
@@ -74,6 +74,8 @@
 	return(0);
 }
 
+#endif /* HAVE_STDIO_H */
+
 /* Functions to read/write memory pointers */
 
 static int mem_seek(SDL_RWops *context, int offset, int whence)
@@ -81,13 +83,13 @@
 	Uint8 *newpos;
 
 	switch (whence) {
-		case SEEK_SET:
+		case RW_SEEK_SET:
 			newpos = context->hidden.mem.base+offset;
 			break;
-		case SEEK_CUR:
+		case RW_SEEK_CUR:
 			newpos = context->hidden.mem.here+offset;
 			break;
-		case SEEK_END:
+		case RW_SEEK_END:
 			newpos = context->hidden.mem.stop+offset;
 			break;
 		default:
@@ -199,10 +201,9 @@
 
 SDL_RWops *SDL_RWFromFile(const char *file, const char *mode)
 {
+	SDL_RWops *rwops = NULL;
+#ifdef HAVE_STDIO_H
 	FILE *fp;
-	SDL_RWops *rwops;
-
-	rwops = NULL;
 
 #ifdef macintosh
 	{
@@ -224,12 +225,14 @@
 		rwops = SDL_RWFromFP(fp, 1);
 #endif
 	}
+#endif /* HAVE_STDIO_H */
 	return(rwops);
 }
 
+#ifdef HAVE_STDIO_H
 SDL_RWops *SDL_RWFromFP(FILE *fp, int autoclose)
 {
-	SDL_RWops *rwops;
+	SDL_RWops *rwops = NULL;
 
 #ifdef WIN32
 	if ( ! in_sdl ) {
@@ -249,6 +252,7 @@
 	}
 	return(rwops);
 }
+#endif /* HAVE_STDIO_H */
 
 SDL_RWops *SDL_RWFromMem(void *mem, int size)
 {
--- a/src/joystick/SDL_joystick.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/joystick/SDL_joystick.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,12 +22,10 @@
 
 /* This is the joystick API for Simple DirectMedia Layer */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_events.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #ifndef DISABLE_EVENTS
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 #endif
--- a/src/joystick/win32/SDL_mmjoystick.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/joystick/win32/SDL_mmjoystick.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,15 +22,15 @@
 
 /* Win32 MultiMedia Joystick driver, contributed by Andrei de A. Formiga */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <stdio.h>		/* For the definition of NULL */
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
+#include "SDL_events.h"
 #include "SDL_joystick.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysjoystick.h"
 #include "SDL_joystick_c.h"
 
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 #include <mmsystem.h>
 #include <regstr.h>
 
@@ -82,7 +82,7 @@
 	unsigned char regvalue[256];
 	unsigned char regname[256];
 
-	sprintf((char *) regkey, "%s\\%s\\%s",
+	snprintf((char *) regkey, SDL_arraysize(regkey), "%s\\%s\\%s",
 		REGSTR_PATH_JOYCONFIG,
 		szRegKey,
 		REGSTR_KEY_JOYCURR);
@@ -95,7 +95,7 @@
 			joystick's properties
 		*/
 		regsize = sizeof(regname);
-		sprintf((char *) regvalue,
+		snprintf((char *) regvalue, SDL_arraysize(regvalue),
 			"Joystick%d%s", index+1,
 			REGSTR_VAL_JOYOEMNAME);
 		regresult = RegQueryValueExA(hKey,
@@ -105,7 +105,7 @@
 		if (regresult == ERROR_SUCCESS)
 		{
 			/* open that registry key */
-			sprintf((char *) regkey, "%s\\%s",
+			snprintf((char *) regkey, SDL_arraysize(regkey), "%s\\%s",
 				REGSTR_PATH_JOYOEM, regname);
 			regresult = RegOpenKeyExA(HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE,
 				(char *) regkey, 0, KEY_READ, &hKey);
@@ -379,7 +379,7 @@
 void SetMMerror(char *function, int code)
 {
 	static char *error;
-	static char  errbuf[BUFSIZ];
+	static char  errbuf[1024];
 
 	errbuf[0] = 0;
 	switch (code) 
@@ -406,13 +406,14 @@
 		break;
 
 		default:
-			sprintf(errbuf, "%s: Unknown Multimedia system error: 0x%x",
+			snprintf(errbuf, SDL_arraysize(errbuf),
+			         "%s: Unknown Multimedia system error: 0x%x",
 								function, code);
 		break;
 	}
 
 	if ( ! errbuf[0] ) {
-		sprintf(errbuf, "%s: %s", function, error);
+		snprintf(errbuf, SDL_arraysize(errbuf), "%s: %s", function, error);
 	}
 	SDL_SetError("%s", errbuf);
 }
--- a/src/loadso/windows/SDL_loadso.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/loadso/windows/SDL_loadso.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -31,8 +31,7 @@
 #error Compiling for the wrong platform?
 #endif
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/stdlib/.cvsignore	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+Makefile.in
+Makefile
+.libs
+*.o
+*.lo
+*.la
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/stdlib/Makefile.am	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,15 @@
+
+## Makefile.am for the SDL file library
+
+noinst_LTLIBRARIES = libstdlib.la
+
+# Include the architecture-independent sources
+COMMON_SRCS =			\
+	SDL_getenv.c		\
+	SDL_malloc.c		\
+	SDL_qsort.c		\
+	SDL_stdlib.c		\
+	SDL_string.c
+
+libstdlib_la_SOURCES = $(COMMON_SRCS)
+
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/stdlib/SDL_getenv.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,245 @@
+/*
+    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
+    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
+
+    Sam Lantinga
+    slouken@libsdl.org
+*/
+
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
+
+
+#if defined(WIN32) && !defined(_WIN32_WCE)
+
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
+
+/* Note this isn't thread-safe! */
+
+static char *SDL_envmem = NULL;	/* Ugh, memory leak */
+static DWORD SDL_envmemlen = 0;
+
+/* Put a variable of the form "name=value" into the environment */
+int SDL_putenv(const char *variable)
+{
+	DWORD bufferlen;
+	char *value;
+	const char *sep;
+
+	sep = strchr(variable, '=');
+	if ( sep == NULL ) {
+		return -1;
+	}
+	bufferlen = strlen(variable)+1;
+	if ( bufferlen > SDL_envmemlen ) {
+		char *newmem = (char *)realloc(SDL_envmem, bufferlen);
+		if ( newmem == NULL ) {
+			return -1;
+		}
+		SDL_envmem = newmem;
+		SDL_envmemlen = bufferlen;
+	}
+	strcpy(SDL_envmem, variable);
+	value = SDL_envmem + (sep - variable);
+	*value++ = '\0';
+	if ( !SetEnvironmentVariable(SDL_envmem, *value ? value : NULL) ) {
+		return -1;
+	}
+	return 0;
+}
+
+/* Retrieve a variable named "name" from the environment */
+char *SDL_getenv(const char *name)
+{
+	DWORD bufferlen;
+
+	bufferlen = GetEnvironmentVariable(name, SDL_envmem, SDL_envmemlen);
+	if ( bufferlen == 0 ) {
+		return NULL;
+	}
+	if ( bufferlen > SDL_envmemlen ) {
+		char *newmem = (char *)realloc(SDL_envmem, bufferlen);
+		if ( newmem == NULL ) {
+			return NULL;
+		}
+		SDL_envmem = newmem;
+		SDL_envmemlen = bufferlen;
+		GetEnvironmentVariable(name, SDL_envmem, SDL_envmemlen);
+	}
+	return SDL_envmem;
+}
+
+#else /* roll our own */
+
+static char **SDL_env = (char **)0;
+
+/* Put a variable of the form "name=value" into the environment */
+int SDL_putenv(const char *variable)
+{
+	const char *name, *value;
+	int added;
+	int len, i;
+	char **new_env;
+	char *new_variable;
+
+	/* A little error checking */
+	if ( ! variable ) {
+		return(-1);
+	}
+	name = variable;
+	for ( value=variable; *value && (*value != '='); ++value ) {
+		/* Keep looking for '=' */ ;
+	}
+	if ( *value ) {
+		++value;
+	} else {
+		return(-1);
+	}
+
+	/* Allocate memory for the variable */
+	new_variable = (char *)malloc(strlen(variable)+1);
+	if ( ! new_variable ) {
+		return(-1);
+	}
+	strcpy(new_variable, variable);
+
+	/* Actually put it into the environment */
+	added = 0;
+	i = 0;
+	if ( SDL_env ) {
+		/* Check to see if it's already there... */
+		len = (value - name);
+		for ( ; SDL_env[i]; ++i ) {
+			if ( strncmp(SDL_env[i], name, len) == 0 ) {
+				break;
+			}
+		}
+		/* If we found it, just replace the entry */
+		if ( SDL_env[i] ) {
+			free(SDL_env[i]);
+			SDL_env[i] = new_variable;
+			added = 1;
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* Didn't find it in the environment, expand and add */
+	if ( ! added ) {
+		new_env = realloc(SDL_env, (i+2)*sizeof(char *));
+		if ( new_env ) {
+			SDL_env = new_env;
+			SDL_env[i++] = new_variable;
+			SDL_env[i++] = (char *)0;
+			added = 1;
+		} else {
+			free(new_variable);
+		}
+	}
+	return (added ? 0 : -1);
+}
+
+/* Retrieve a variable named "name" from the environment */
+char *SDL_getenv(const char *name)
+{
+	int len, i;
+	char *value;
+
+	value = (char *)0;
+	if ( SDL_env ) {
+		len = strlen(name);
+		for ( i=0; SDL_env[i] && !value; ++i ) {
+			if ( (strncmp(SDL_env[i], name, len) == 0) &&
+			     (SDL_env[i][len] == '=') ) {
+				value = &SDL_env[i][len+1];
+			}
+		}
+	}
+	return value;
+}
+
+#endif /* WIN32 */
+
+#ifdef TEST_MAIN
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+int main(int argc, char *argv[])
+{
+	char *value;
+
+	printf("Checking for non-existent variable... ");
+	fflush(stdout);
+	if ( ! getenv("EXISTS") ) {
+		printf("okay\n");
+	} else {
+		printf("failed\n");
+	}
+	printf("Setting FIRST=VALUE1 in the environment... ");
+	fflush(stdout);
+	if ( putenv("FIRST=VALUE1") == 0 ) {
+		printf("okay\n");
+	} else {
+		printf("failed\n");
+	}
+	printf("Getting FIRST from the environment... ");
+	fflush(stdout);
+	value = getenv("FIRST");
+	if ( value && (strcmp(value, "VALUE1") == 0) ) {
+		printf("okay\n");
+	} else {
+		printf("failed\n");
+	}
+	printf("Setting SECOND=VALUE2 in the environment... ");
+	fflush(stdout);
+	if ( putenv("SECOND=VALUE2") == 0 ) {
+		printf("okay\n");
+	} else {
+		printf("failed\n");
+	}
+	printf("Getting SECOND from the environment... ");
+	fflush(stdout);
+	value = getenv("SECOND");
+	if ( value && (strcmp(value, "VALUE2") == 0) ) {
+		printf("okay\n");
+	} else {
+		printf("failed\n");
+	}
+	printf("Setting FIRST=NOVALUE in the environment... ");
+	fflush(stdout);
+	if ( putenv("FIRST=NOVALUE") == 0 ) {
+		printf("okay\n");
+	} else {
+		printf("failed\n");
+	}
+	printf("Getting FIRST from the environment... ");
+	fflush(stdout);
+	value = getenv("FIRST");
+	if ( value && (strcmp(value, "NOVALUE") == 0) ) {
+		printf("okay\n");
+	} else {
+		printf("failed\n");
+	}
+	printf("Checking for non-existent variable... ");
+	fflush(stdout);
+	if ( ! getenv("EXISTS") ) {
+		printf("okay\n");
+	} else {
+		printf("failed\n");
+	}
+	return(0);
+}
+#endif /* TEST_MAIN */
+
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/stdlib/SDL_malloc.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,5108 @@
+/*
+    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
+    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
+
+    Sam Lantinga
+    slouken@libsdl.org
+*/
+
+
+/* This file contains portable memory management functions for SDL */
+
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
+
+#ifndef HAVE_MALLOC
+
+#define LACKS_STDIO_H
+#define LACKS_UNISTD_H
+#define LACKS_FCNTL_H
+#define LACKS_SYS_PARAM_H
+#define LACKS_SYS_MMAN_H
+#define LACKS_STRINGS_H
+#define LACKS_STRING_H
+#define LACKS_SYS_TYPES_H
+#define LACKS_ERRNO_H
+#define LACKS_STDLIB_H
+#define ABORT
+
+/*
+  This is a version (aka dlmalloc) of malloc/free/realloc written by
+  Doug Lea and released to the public domain, as explained at
+  http://creativecommons.org/licenses/publicdomain.  Send questions,
+  comments, complaints, performance data, etc to dl@cs.oswego.edu
+
+* Version 2.8.3 Thu Sep 22 11:16:15 2005  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+
+   Note: There may be an updated version of this malloc obtainable at
+           ftp://gee.cs.oswego.edu/pub/misc/malloc.c
+         Check before installing!
+
+* Quickstart
+
+  This library is all in one file to simplify the most common usage:
+  ftp it, compile it (-O3), and link it into another program. All of
+  the compile-time options default to reasonable values for use on
+  most platforms.  You might later want to step through various
+  compile-time and dynamic tuning options.
+
+  For convenience, an include file for code using this malloc is at:
+     ftp://gee.cs.oswego.edu/pub/misc/malloc-2.8.3.h
+  You don't really need this .h file unless you call functions not
+  defined in your system include files.  The .h file contains only the
+  excerpts from this file needed for using this malloc on ANSI C/C++
+  systems, so long as you haven't changed compile-time options about
+  naming and tuning parameters.  If you do, then you can create your
+  own malloc.h that does include all settings by cutting at the point
+  indicated below. Note that you may already by default be using a C
+  library containing a malloc that is based on some version of this
+  malloc (for example in linux). You might still want to use the one
+  in this file to customize settings or to avoid overheads associated
+  with library versions.
+
+* Vital statistics:
+
+  Supported pointer/size_t representation:       4 or 8 bytes
+       size_t MUST be an unsigned type of the same width as
+       pointers. (If you are using an ancient system that declares
+       size_t as a signed type, or need it to be a different width
+       than pointers, you can use a previous release of this malloc
+       (e.g. 2.7.2) supporting these.)
+
+  Alignment:                                     8 bytes (default)
+       This suffices for nearly all current machines and C compilers.
+       However, you can define MALLOC_ALIGNMENT to be wider than this
+       if necessary (up to 128bytes), at the expense of using more space.
+
+  Minimum overhead per allocated chunk:   4 or  8 bytes (if 4byte sizes)
+                                          8 or 16 bytes (if 8byte sizes)
+       Each malloced chunk has a hidden word of overhead holding size
+       and status information, and additional cross-check word
+       if FOOTERS is defined.
+
+  Minimum allocated size: 4-byte ptrs:  16 bytes    (including overhead)
+                          8-byte ptrs:  32 bytes    (including overhead)
+
+       Even a request for zero bytes (i.e., malloc(0)) returns a
+       pointer to something of the minimum allocatable size.
+       The maximum overhead wastage (i.e., number of extra bytes
+       allocated than were requested in malloc) is less than or equal
+       to the minimum size, except for requests >= mmap_threshold that
+       are serviced via mmap(), where the worst case wastage is about
+       32 bytes plus the remainder from a system page (the minimal
+       mmap unit); typically 4096 or 8192 bytes.
+
+  Security: static-safe; optionally more or less
+       The "security" of malloc refers to the ability of malicious
+       code to accentuate the effects of errors (for example, freeing
+       space that is not currently malloc'ed or overwriting past the
+       ends of chunks) in code that calls malloc.  This malloc
+       guarantees not to modify any memory locations below the base of
+       heap, i.e., static variables, even in the presence of usage
+       errors.  The routines additionally detect most improper frees
+       and reallocs.  All this holds as long as the static bookkeeping
+       for malloc itself is not corrupted by some other means.  This
+       is only one aspect of security -- these checks do not, and
+       cannot, detect all possible programming errors.
+
+       If FOOTERS is defined nonzero, then each allocated chunk
+       carries an additional check word to verify that it was malloced
+       from its space.  These check words are the same within each
+       execution of a program using malloc, but differ across
+       executions, so externally crafted fake chunks cannot be
+       freed. This improves security by rejecting frees/reallocs that
+       could corrupt heap memory, in addition to the checks preventing
+       writes to statics that are always on.  This may further improve
+       security at the expense of time and space overhead.  (Note that
+       FOOTERS may also be worth using with MSPACES.)
+
+       By default detected errors cause the program to abort (calling
+       "abort()"). You can override this to instead proceed past
+       errors by defining PROCEED_ON_ERROR.  In this case, a bad free
+       has no effect, and a malloc that encounters a bad address
+       caused by user overwrites will ignore the bad address by
+       dropping pointers and indices to all known memory. This may
+       be appropriate for programs that should continue if at all
+       possible in the face of programming errors, although they may
+       run out of memory because dropped memory is never reclaimed.
+
+       If you don't like either of these options, you can define
+       CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION and USAGE_ERROR_ACTION to do anything
+       else. And if if you are sure that your program using malloc has
+       no errors or vulnerabilities, you can define INSECURE to 1,
+       which might (or might not) provide a small performance improvement.
+
+  Thread-safety: NOT thread-safe unless USE_LOCKS defined
+       When USE_LOCKS is defined, each public call to malloc, free,
+       etc is surrounded with either a pthread mutex or a win32
+       spinlock (depending on WIN32). This is not especially fast, and
+       can be a major bottleneck.  It is designed only to provide
+       minimal protection in concurrent environments, and to provide a
+       basis for extensions.  If you are using malloc in a concurrent
+       program, consider instead using ptmalloc, which is derived from
+       a version of this malloc. (See http://www.malloc.de).
+
+  System requirements: Any combination of MORECORE and/or MMAP/MUNMAP
+       This malloc can use unix sbrk or any emulation (invoked using
+       the CALL_MORECORE macro) and/or mmap/munmap or any emulation
+       (invoked using CALL_MMAP/CALL_MUNMAP) to get and release system
+       memory.  On most unix systems, it tends to work best if both
+       MORECORE and MMAP are enabled.  On Win32, it uses emulations
+       based on VirtualAlloc. It also uses common C library functions
+       like memset.
+
+  Compliance: I believe it is compliant with the Single Unix Specification
+       (See http://www.unix.org). Also SVID/XPG, ANSI C, and probably
+       others as well.
+
+* Overview of algorithms
+
+  This is not the fastest, most space-conserving, most portable, or
+  most tunable malloc ever written. However it is among the fastest
+  while also being among the most space-conserving, portable and
+  tunable.  Consistent balance across these factors results in a good
+  general-purpose allocator for malloc-intensive programs.
+
+  In most ways, this malloc is a best-fit allocator. Generally, it
+  chooses the best-fitting existing chunk for a request, with ties
+  broken in approximately least-recently-used order. (This strategy
+  normally maintains low fragmentation.) However, for requests less
+  than 256bytes, it deviates from best-fit when there is not an
+  exactly fitting available chunk by preferring to use space adjacent
+  to that used for the previous small request, as well as by breaking
+  ties in approximately most-recently-used order. (These enhance
+  locality of series of small allocations.)  And for very large requests
+  (>= 256Kb by default), it relies on system memory mapping
+  facilities, if supported.  (This helps avoid carrying around and
+  possibly fragmenting memory used only for large chunks.)
+
+  All operations (except malloc_stats and mallinfo) have execution
+  times that are bounded by a constant factor of the number of bits in
+  a size_t, not counting any clearing in calloc or copying in realloc,
+  or actions surrounding MORECORE and MMAP that have times
+  proportional to the number of non-contiguous regions returned by
+  system allocation routines, which is often just 1.
+
+  The implementation is not very modular and seriously overuses
+  macros. Perhaps someday all C compilers will do as good a job
+  inlining modular code as can now be done by brute-force expansion,
+  but now, enough of them seem not to.
+
+  Some compilers issue a lot of warnings about code that is
+  dead/unreachable only on some platforms, and also about intentional
+  uses of negation on unsigned types. All known cases of each can be
+  ignored.
+
+  For a longer but out of date high-level description, see
+     http://gee.cs.oswego.edu/dl/html/malloc.html
+
+* MSPACES
+  If MSPACES is defined, then in addition to malloc, free, etc.,
+  this file also defines mspace_malloc, mspace_free, etc. These
+  are versions of malloc routines that take an "mspace" argument
+  obtained using create_mspace, to control all internal bookkeeping.
+  If ONLY_MSPACES is defined, only these versions are compiled.
+  So if you would like to use this allocator for only some allocations,
+  and your system malloc for others, you can compile with
+  ONLY_MSPACES and then do something like...
+    static mspace mymspace = create_mspace(0,0); // for example
+    #define mymalloc(bytes)  mspace_malloc(mymspace, bytes)
+
+  (Note: If you only need one instance of an mspace, you can instead
+  use "USE_DL_PREFIX" to relabel the global malloc.)
+
+  You can similarly create thread-local allocators by storing
+  mspaces as thread-locals. For example:
+    static __thread mspace tlms = 0;
+    void*  tlmalloc(size_t bytes) {
+      if (tlms == 0) tlms = create_mspace(0, 0);
+      return mspace_malloc(tlms, bytes);
+    }
+    void  tlfree(void* mem) { mspace_free(tlms, mem); }
+
+  Unless FOOTERS is defined, each mspace is completely independent.
+  You cannot allocate from one and free to another (although
+  conformance is only weakly checked, so usage errors are not always
+  caught). If FOOTERS is defined, then each chunk carries around a tag
+  indicating its originating mspace, and frees are directed to their
+  originating spaces.
+
+ -------------------------  Compile-time options ---------------------------
+
+Be careful in setting #define values for numerical constants of type
+size_t. On some systems, literal values are not automatically extended
+to size_t precision unless they are explicitly casted.
+
+WIN32                    default: defined if _WIN32 defined
+  Defining WIN32 sets up defaults for MS environment and compilers.
+  Otherwise defaults are for unix.
+
+MALLOC_ALIGNMENT         default: (size_t)8
+  Controls the minimum alignment for malloc'ed chunks.  It must be a
+  power of two and at least 8, even on machines for which smaller
+  alignments would suffice. It may be defined as larger than this
+  though. Note however that code and data structures are optimized for
+  the case of 8-byte alignment.
+
+MSPACES                  default: 0 (false)
+  If true, compile in support for independent allocation spaces.
+  This is only supported if HAVE_MMAP is true.
+
+ONLY_MSPACES             default: 0 (false)
+  If true, only compile in mspace versions, not regular versions.
+
+USE_LOCKS                default: 0 (false)
+  Causes each call to each public routine to be surrounded with
+  pthread or WIN32 mutex lock/unlock. (If set true, this can be
+  overridden on a per-mspace basis for mspace versions.)
+
+FOOTERS                  default: 0
+  If true, provide extra checking and dispatching by placing
+  information in the footers of allocated chunks. This adds
+  space and time overhead.
+
+INSECURE                 default: 0
+  If true, omit checks for usage errors and heap space overwrites.
+
+USE_DL_PREFIX            default: NOT defined
+  Causes compiler to prefix all public routines with the string 'dl'.
+  This can be useful when you only want to use this malloc in one part
+  of a program, using your regular system malloc elsewhere.
+
+ABORT                    default: defined as abort()
+  Defines how to abort on failed checks.  On most systems, a failed
+  check cannot die with an "assert" or even print an informative
+  message, because the underlying print routines in turn call malloc,
+  which will fail again.  Generally, the best policy is to simply call
+  abort(). It's not very useful to do more than this because many
+  errors due to overwriting will show up as address faults (null, odd
+  addresses etc) rather than malloc-triggered checks, so will also
+  abort.  Also, most compilers know that abort() does not return, so
+  can better optimize code conditionally calling it.
+
+PROCEED_ON_ERROR           default: defined as 0 (false)
+  Controls whether detected bad addresses cause them to bypassed
+  rather than aborting. If set, detected bad arguments to free and
+  realloc are ignored. And all bookkeeping information is zeroed out
+  upon a detected overwrite of freed heap space, thus losing the
+  ability to ever return it from malloc again, but enabling the
+  application to proceed. If PROCEED_ON_ERROR is defined, the
+  static variable malloc_corruption_error_count is compiled in
+  and can be examined to see if errors have occurred. This option
+  generates slower code than the default abort policy.
+
+DEBUG                    default: NOT defined
+  The DEBUG setting is mainly intended for people trying to modify
+  this code or diagnose problems when porting to new platforms.
+  However, it may also be able to better isolate user errors than just
+  using runtime checks.  The assertions in the check routines spell
+  out in more detail the assumptions and invariants underlying the
+  algorithms.  The checking is fairly extensive, and will slow down
+  execution noticeably. Calling malloc_stats or mallinfo with DEBUG
+  set will attempt to check every non-mmapped allocated and free chunk
+  in the course of computing the summaries.
+
+ABORT_ON_ASSERT_FAILURE   default: defined as 1 (true)
+  Debugging assertion failures can be nearly impossible if your
+  version of the assert macro causes malloc to be called, which will
+  lead to a cascade of further failures, blowing the runtime stack.
+  ABORT_ON_ASSERT_FAILURE cause assertions failures to call abort(),
+  which will usually make debugging easier.
+
+MALLOC_FAILURE_ACTION     default: sets errno to ENOMEM, or no-op on win32
+  The action to take before "return 0" when malloc fails to be able to
+  return memory because there is none available.
+
+HAVE_MORECORE             default: 1 (true) unless win32 or ONLY_MSPACES
+  True if this system supports sbrk or an emulation of it.
+
+MORECORE                  default: sbrk
+  The name of the sbrk-style system routine to call to obtain more
+  memory.  See below for guidance on writing custom MORECORE
+  functions. The type of the argument to sbrk/MORECORE varies across
+  systems.  It cannot be size_t, because it supports negative
+  arguments, so it is normally the signed type of the same width as
+  size_t (sometimes declared as "intptr_t").  It doesn't much matter
+  though. Internally, we only call it with arguments less than half
+  the max value of a size_t, which should work across all reasonable
+  possibilities, although sometimes generating compiler warnings.  See
+  near the end of this file for guidelines for creating a custom
+  version of MORECORE.
+
+MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS       default: 1 (true)
+  If true, take advantage of fact that consecutive calls to MORECORE
+  with positive arguments always return contiguous increasing
+  addresses.  This is true of unix sbrk. It does not hurt too much to
+  set it true anyway, since malloc copes with non-contiguities.
+  Setting it false when definitely non-contiguous saves time
+  and possibly wasted space it would take to discover this though.
+
+MORECORE_CANNOT_TRIM      default: NOT defined
+  True if MORECORE cannot release space back to the system when given
+  negative arguments. This is generally necessary only if you are
+  using a hand-crafted MORECORE function that cannot handle negative
+  arguments.
+
+HAVE_MMAP                 default: 1 (true)
+  True if this system supports mmap or an emulation of it.  If so, and
+  HAVE_MORECORE is not true, MMAP is used for all system
+  allocation. If set and HAVE_MORECORE is true as well, MMAP is
+  primarily used to directly allocate very large blocks. It is also
+  used as a backup strategy in cases where MORECORE fails to provide
+  space from system. Note: A single call to MUNMAP is assumed to be
+  able to unmap memory that may have be allocated using multiple calls
+  to MMAP, so long as they are adjacent.
+
+HAVE_MREMAP               default: 1 on linux, else 0
+  If true realloc() uses mremap() to re-allocate large blocks and
+  extend or shrink allocation spaces.
+
+MMAP_CLEARS               default: 1 on unix
+  True if mmap clears memory so calloc doesn't need to. This is true
+  for standard unix mmap using /dev/zero.
+
+USE_BUILTIN_FFS            default: 0 (i.e., not used)
+  Causes malloc to use the builtin ffs() function to compute indices.
+  Some compilers may recognize and intrinsify ffs to be faster than the
+  supplied C version. Also, the case of x86 using gcc is special-cased
+  to an asm instruction, so is already as fast as it can be, and so
+  this setting has no effect. (On most x86s, the asm version is only
+  slightly faster than the C version.)
+
+malloc_getpagesize         default: derive from system includes, or 4096.
+  The system page size. To the extent possible, this malloc manages
+  memory from the system in page-size units.  This may be (and
+  usually is) a function rather than a constant. This is ignored
+  if WIN32, where page size is determined using getSystemInfo during
+  initialization.
+
+USE_DEV_RANDOM             default: 0 (i.e., not used)
+  Causes malloc to use /dev/random to initialize secure magic seed for
+  stamping footers. Otherwise, the current time is used.
+
+NO_MALLINFO                default: 0
+  If defined, don't compile "mallinfo". This can be a simple way
+  of dealing with mismatches between system declarations and
+  those in this file.
+
+MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE        default: size_t
+  The type of the fields in the mallinfo struct. This was originally
+  defined as "int" in SVID etc, but is more usefully defined as
+  size_t. The value is used only if  HAVE_USR_INCLUDE_MALLOC_H is not set
+
+REALLOC_ZERO_BYTES_FREES    default: not defined
+  This should be set if a call to realloc with zero bytes should 
+  be the same as a call to free. Some people think it should. Otherwise, 
+  since this malloc returns a unique pointer for malloc(0), so does 
+  realloc(p, 0).
+
+LACKS_UNISTD_H, LACKS_FCNTL_H, LACKS_SYS_PARAM_H, LACKS_SYS_MMAN_H
+LACKS_STRINGS_H, LACKS_STRING_H, LACKS_SYS_TYPES_H,  LACKS_ERRNO_H
+LACKS_STDLIB_H                default: NOT defined unless on WIN32
+  Define these if your system does not have these header files.
+  You might need to manually insert some of the declarations they provide.
+
+DEFAULT_GRANULARITY        default: page size if MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS,
+                                system_info.dwAllocationGranularity in WIN32,
+                                otherwise 64K.
+      Also settable using mallopt(M_GRANULARITY, x)
+  The unit for allocating and deallocating memory from the system.  On
+  most systems with contiguous MORECORE, there is no reason to
+  make this more than a page. However, systems with MMAP tend to
+  either require or encourage larger granularities.  You can increase
+  this value to prevent system allocation functions to be called so
+  often, especially if they are slow.  The value must be at least one
+  page and must be a power of two.  Setting to 0 causes initialization
+  to either page size or win32 region size.  (Note: In previous
+  versions of malloc, the equivalent of this option was called
+  "TOP_PAD")
+
+DEFAULT_TRIM_THRESHOLD    default: 2MB
+      Also settable using mallopt(M_TRIM_THRESHOLD, x)
+  The maximum amount of unused top-most memory to keep before
+  releasing via malloc_trim in free().  Automatic trimming is mainly
+  useful in long-lived programs using contiguous MORECORE.  Because
+  trimming via sbrk can be slow on some systems, and can sometimes be
+  wasteful (in cases where programs immediately afterward allocate
+  more large chunks) the value should be high enough so that your
+  overall system performance would improve by releasing this much
+  memory.  As a rough guide, you might set to a value close to the
+  average size of a process (program) running on your system.
+  Releasing this much memory would allow such a process to run in
+  memory.  Generally, it is worth tuning trim thresholds when a
+  program undergoes phases where several large chunks are allocated
+  and released in ways that can reuse each other's storage, perhaps
+  mixed with phases where there are no such chunks at all. The trim
+  value must be greater than page size to have any useful effect.  To
+  disable trimming completely, you can set to MAX_SIZE_T. Note that the trick
+  some people use of mallocing a huge space and then freeing it at
+  program startup, in an attempt to reserve system memory, doesn't
+  have the intended effect under automatic trimming, since that memory
+  will immediately be returned to the system.
+
+DEFAULT_MMAP_THRESHOLD       default: 256K
+      Also settable using mallopt(M_MMAP_THRESHOLD, x)
+  The request size threshold for using MMAP to directly service a
+  request. Requests of at least this size that cannot be allocated
+  using already-existing space will be serviced via mmap.  (If enough
+  normal freed space already exists it is used instead.)  Using mmap
+  segregates relatively large chunks of memory so that they can be
+  individually obtained and released from the host system. A request
+  serviced through mmap is never reused by any other request (at least
+  not directly; the system may just so happen to remap successive
+  requests to the same locations).  Segregating space in this way has
+  the benefits that: Mmapped space can always be individually released
+  back to the system, which helps keep the system level memory demands
+  of a long-lived program low.  Also, mapped memory doesn't become
+  `locked' between other chunks, as can happen with normally allocated
+  chunks, which means that even trimming via malloc_trim would not
+  release them.  However, it has the disadvantage that the space
+  cannot be reclaimed, consolidated, and then used to service later
+  requests, as happens with normal chunks.  The advantages of mmap
+  nearly always outweigh disadvantages for "large" chunks, but the
+  value of "large" may vary across systems.  The default is an
+  empirically derived value that works well in most systems. You can
+  disable mmap by setting to MAX_SIZE_T.
+
+*/
+
+#ifndef WIN32
+#ifdef _WIN32
+#define WIN32 1
+#endif  /* _WIN32 */
+#endif  /* WIN32 */
+#ifdef WIN32
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
+#define HAVE_MMAP 1
+#define HAVE_MORECORE 0
+#define LACKS_UNISTD_H
+#define LACKS_SYS_PARAM_H
+#define LACKS_SYS_MMAN_H
+#define LACKS_STRING_H
+#define LACKS_STRINGS_H
+#define LACKS_SYS_TYPES_H
+#define LACKS_ERRNO_H
+#define MALLOC_FAILURE_ACTION
+#define MMAP_CLEARS 0 /* WINCE and some others apparently don't clear */
+#endif  /* WIN32 */
+
+#if defined(DARWIN) || defined(_DARWIN)
+/* Mac OSX docs advise not to use sbrk; it seems better to use mmap */
+#ifndef HAVE_MORECORE
+#define HAVE_MORECORE 0
+#define HAVE_MMAP 1
+#endif  /* HAVE_MORECORE */
+#endif  /* DARWIN */
+
+#ifndef LACKS_SYS_TYPES_H
+#include <sys/types.h>  /* For size_t */
+#endif  /* LACKS_SYS_TYPES_H */
+
+/* The maximum possible size_t value has all bits set */
+#define MAX_SIZE_T           (~(size_t)0)
+
+#ifndef ONLY_MSPACES
+#define ONLY_MSPACES 0
+#endif  /* ONLY_MSPACES */
+#ifndef MSPACES
+#if ONLY_MSPACES
+#define MSPACES 1
+#else   /* ONLY_MSPACES */
+#define MSPACES 0
+#endif  /* ONLY_MSPACES */
+#endif  /* MSPACES */
+#ifndef MALLOC_ALIGNMENT
+#define MALLOC_ALIGNMENT ((size_t)8U)
+#endif  /* MALLOC_ALIGNMENT */
+#ifndef FOOTERS
+#define FOOTERS 0
+#endif  /* FOOTERS */
+#ifndef ABORT
+#define ABORT  abort()
+#endif  /* ABORT */
+#ifndef ABORT_ON_ASSERT_FAILURE
+#define ABORT_ON_ASSERT_FAILURE 1
+#endif  /* ABORT_ON_ASSERT_FAILURE */
+#ifndef PROCEED_ON_ERROR
+#define PROCEED_ON_ERROR 0
+#endif  /* PROCEED_ON_ERROR */
+#ifndef USE_LOCKS
+#define USE_LOCKS 0
+#endif  /* USE_LOCKS */
+#ifndef INSECURE
+#define INSECURE 0
+#endif  /* INSECURE */
+#ifndef HAVE_MMAP
+#define HAVE_MMAP 1
+#endif  /* HAVE_MMAP */
+#ifndef MMAP_CLEARS
+#define MMAP_CLEARS 1
+#endif  /* MMAP_CLEARS */
+#ifndef HAVE_MREMAP
+#ifdef linux
+#define HAVE_MREMAP 1
+#else   /* linux */
+#define HAVE_MREMAP 0
+#endif  /* linux */
+#endif  /* HAVE_MREMAP */
+#ifndef MALLOC_FAILURE_ACTION
+#define MALLOC_FAILURE_ACTION  errno = ENOMEM;
+#endif  /* MALLOC_FAILURE_ACTION */
+#ifndef HAVE_MORECORE
+#if ONLY_MSPACES
+#define HAVE_MORECORE 0
+#else   /* ONLY_MSPACES */
+#define HAVE_MORECORE 1
+#endif  /* ONLY_MSPACES */
+#endif  /* HAVE_MORECORE */
+#if !HAVE_MORECORE
+#define MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS 0
+#else   /* !HAVE_MORECORE */
+#ifndef MORECORE
+#define MORECORE sbrk
+#endif  /* MORECORE */
+#ifndef MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS
+#define MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS 1
+#endif  /* MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS */
+#endif  /* HAVE_MORECORE */
+#ifndef DEFAULT_GRANULARITY
+#if MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS
+#define DEFAULT_GRANULARITY (0)  /* 0 means to compute in init_mparams */
+#else   /* MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS */
+#define DEFAULT_GRANULARITY ((size_t)64U * (size_t)1024U)
+#endif  /* MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS */
+#endif  /* DEFAULT_GRANULARITY */
+#ifndef DEFAULT_TRIM_THRESHOLD
+#ifndef MORECORE_CANNOT_TRIM
+#define DEFAULT_TRIM_THRESHOLD ((size_t)2U * (size_t)1024U * (size_t)1024U)
+#else   /* MORECORE_CANNOT_TRIM */
+#define DEFAULT_TRIM_THRESHOLD MAX_SIZE_T
+#endif  /* MORECORE_CANNOT_TRIM */
+#endif  /* DEFAULT_TRIM_THRESHOLD */
+#ifndef DEFAULT_MMAP_THRESHOLD
+#if HAVE_MMAP
+#define DEFAULT_MMAP_THRESHOLD ((size_t)256U * (size_t)1024U)
+#else   /* HAVE_MMAP */
+#define DEFAULT_MMAP_THRESHOLD MAX_SIZE_T
+#endif  /* HAVE_MMAP */
+#endif  /* DEFAULT_MMAP_THRESHOLD */
+#ifndef USE_BUILTIN_FFS
+#define USE_BUILTIN_FFS 0
+#endif  /* USE_BUILTIN_FFS */
+#ifndef USE_DEV_RANDOM
+#define USE_DEV_RANDOM 0
+#endif  /* USE_DEV_RANDOM */
+#ifndef NO_MALLINFO
+#define NO_MALLINFO 0
+#endif  /* NO_MALLINFO */
+#ifndef MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE
+#define MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE size_t
+#endif  /* MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE */
+
+/*
+  mallopt tuning options.  SVID/XPG defines four standard parameter
+  numbers for mallopt, normally defined in malloc.h.  None of these
+  are used in this malloc, so setting them has no effect. But this
+  malloc does support the following options.
+*/
+
+#define M_TRIM_THRESHOLD     (-1)
+#define M_GRANULARITY        (-2)
+#define M_MMAP_THRESHOLD     (-3)
+
+/* ------------------------ Mallinfo declarations ------------------------ */
+
+#if !NO_MALLINFO
+/*
+  This version of malloc supports the standard SVID/XPG mallinfo
+  routine that returns a struct containing usage properties and
+  statistics. It should work on any system that has a
+  /usr/include/malloc.h defining struct mallinfo.  The main
+  declaration needed is the mallinfo struct that is returned (by-copy)
+  by mallinfo().  The malloinfo struct contains a bunch of fields that
+  are not even meaningful in this version of malloc.  These fields are
+  are instead filled by mallinfo() with other numbers that might be of
+  interest.
+
+  HAVE_USR_INCLUDE_MALLOC_H should be set if you have a
+  /usr/include/malloc.h file that includes a declaration of struct
+  mallinfo.  If so, it is included; else a compliant version is
+  declared below.  These must be precisely the same for mallinfo() to
+  work.  The original SVID version of this struct, defined on most
+  systems with mallinfo, declares all fields as ints. But some others
+  define as unsigned long. If your system defines the fields using a
+  type of different width than listed here, you MUST #include your
+  system version and #define HAVE_USR_INCLUDE_MALLOC_H.
+*/
+
+/* #define HAVE_USR_INCLUDE_MALLOC_H */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_USR_INCLUDE_MALLOC_H
+#include "/usr/include/malloc.h"
+#else /* HAVE_USR_INCLUDE_MALLOC_H */
+
+struct mallinfo {
+  MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE arena;    /* non-mmapped space allocated from system */
+  MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE ordblks;  /* number of free chunks */
+  MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE smblks;   /* always 0 */
+  MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE hblks;    /* always 0 */
+  MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE hblkhd;   /* space in mmapped regions */
+  MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE usmblks;  /* maximum total allocated space */
+  MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE fsmblks;  /* always 0 */
+  MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE uordblks; /* total allocated space */
+  MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE fordblks; /* total free space */
+  MALLINFO_FIELD_TYPE keepcost; /* releasable (via malloc_trim) space */
+};
+
+#endif /* HAVE_USR_INCLUDE_MALLOC_H */
+#endif /* NO_MALLINFO */
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern "C" {
+#endif /* __cplusplus */
+
+#if !ONLY_MSPACES
+
+/* ------------------- Declarations of public routines ------------------- */
+
+#ifndef USE_DL_PREFIX
+#define dlcalloc               calloc
+#define dlfree                 free
+#define dlmalloc               malloc
+#define dlmemalign             memalign
+#define dlrealloc              realloc
+#define dlvalloc               valloc
+#define dlpvalloc              pvalloc
+#define dlmallinfo             mallinfo
+#define dlmallopt              mallopt
+#define dlmalloc_trim          malloc_trim
+#define dlmalloc_stats         malloc_stats
+#define dlmalloc_usable_size   malloc_usable_size
+#define dlmalloc_footprint     malloc_footprint
+#define dlmalloc_max_footprint malloc_max_footprint
+#define dlindependent_calloc   independent_calloc
+#define dlindependent_comalloc independent_comalloc
+#endif /* USE_DL_PREFIX */
+
+
+/*
+  malloc(size_t n)
+  Returns a pointer to a newly allocated chunk of at least n bytes, or
+  null if no space is available, in which case errno is set to ENOMEM
+  on ANSI C systems.
+
+  If n is zero, malloc returns a minimum-sized chunk. (The minimum
+  size is 16 bytes on most 32bit systems, and 32 bytes on 64bit
+  systems.)  Note that size_t is an unsigned type, so calls with
+  arguments that would be negative if signed are interpreted as
+  requests for huge amounts of space, which will often fail. The
+  maximum supported value of n differs across systems, but is in all
+  cases less than the maximum representable value of a size_t.
+*/
+void* dlmalloc(size_t);
+
+/*
+  free(void* p)
+  Releases the chunk of memory pointed to by p, that had been previously
+  allocated using malloc or a related routine such as realloc.
+  It has no effect if p is null. If p was not malloced or already
+  freed, free(p) will by default cause the current program to abort.
+*/
+void  dlfree(void*);
+
+/*
+  calloc(size_t n_elements, size_t element_size);
+  Returns a pointer to n_elements * element_size bytes, with all locations
+  set to zero.
+*/
+void* dlcalloc(size_t, size_t);
+
+/*
+  realloc(void* p, size_t n)
+  Returns a pointer to a chunk of size n that contains the same data
+  as does chunk p up to the minimum of (n, p's size) bytes, or null
+  if no space is available.
+
+  The returned pointer may or may not be the same as p. The algorithm
+  prefers extending p in most cases when possible, otherwise it
+  employs the equivalent of a malloc-copy-free sequence.
+
+  If p is null, realloc is equivalent to malloc.
+
+  If space is not available, realloc returns null, errno is set (if on
+  ANSI) and p is NOT freed.
+
+  if n is for fewer bytes than already held by p, the newly unused
+  space is lopped off and freed if possible.  realloc with a size
+  argument of zero (re)allocates a minimum-sized chunk.
+
+  The old unix realloc convention of allowing the last-free'd chunk
+  to be used as an argument to realloc is not supported.
+*/
+
+void* dlrealloc(void*, size_t);
+
+/*
+  memalign(size_t alignment, size_t n);
+  Returns a pointer to a newly allocated chunk of n bytes, aligned
+  in accord with the alignment argument.
+
+  The alignment argument should be a power of two. If the argument is
+  not a power of two, the nearest greater power is used.
+  8-byte alignment is guaranteed by normal malloc calls, so don't
+  bother calling memalign with an argument of 8 or less.
+
+  Overreliance on memalign is a sure way to fragment space.
+*/
+void* dlmemalign(size_t, size_t);
+
+/*
+  valloc(size_t n);
+  Equivalent to memalign(pagesize, n), where pagesize is the page
+  size of the system. If the pagesize is unknown, 4096 is used.
+*/
+void* dlvalloc(size_t);
+
+/*
+  mallopt(int parameter_number, int parameter_value)
+  Sets tunable parameters The format is to provide a
+  (parameter-number, parameter-value) pair.  mallopt then sets the
+  corresponding parameter to the argument value if it can (i.e., so
+  long as the value is meaningful), and returns 1 if successful else
+  0.  SVID/XPG/ANSI defines four standard param numbers for mallopt,
+  normally defined in malloc.h.  None of these are use in this malloc,
+  so setting them has no effect. But this malloc also supports other
+  options in mallopt. See below for details.  Briefly, supported
+  parameters are as follows (listed defaults are for "typical"
+  configurations).
+
+  Symbol            param #  default    allowed param values
+  M_TRIM_THRESHOLD     -1   2*1024*1024   any   (MAX_SIZE_T disables)
+  M_GRANULARITY        -2     page size   any power of 2 >= page size
+  M_MMAP_THRESHOLD     -3      256*1024   any   (or 0 if no MMAP support)
+*/
+int dlmallopt(int, int);
+
+/*
+  malloc_footprint();
+  Returns the number of bytes obtained from the system.  The total
+  number of bytes allocated by malloc, realloc etc., is less than this
+  value. Unlike mallinfo, this function returns only a precomputed
+  result, so can be called frequently to monitor memory consumption.
+  Even if locks are otherwise defined, this function does not use them,
+  so results might not be up to date.
+*/
+size_t dlmalloc_footprint(void);
+
+/*
+  malloc_max_footprint();
+  Returns the maximum number of bytes obtained from the system. This
+  value will be greater than current footprint if deallocated space
+  has been reclaimed by the system. The peak number of bytes allocated
+  by malloc, realloc etc., is less than this value. Unlike mallinfo,
+  this function returns only a precomputed result, so can be called
+  frequently to monitor memory consumption.  Even if locks are
+  otherwise defined, this function does not use them, so results might
+  not be up to date.
+*/
+size_t dlmalloc_max_footprint(void);
+
+#if !NO_MALLINFO
+/*
+  mallinfo()
+  Returns (by copy) a struct containing various summary statistics:
+
+  arena:     current total non-mmapped bytes allocated from system
+  ordblks:   the number of free chunks
+  smblks:    always zero.
+  hblks:     current number of mmapped regions
+  hblkhd:    total bytes held in mmapped regions
+  usmblks:   the maximum total allocated space. This will be greater
+                than current total if trimming has occurred.
+  fsmblks:   always zero
+  uordblks:  current total allocated space (normal or mmapped)
+  fordblks:  total free space
+  keepcost:  the maximum number of bytes that could ideally be released
+               back to system via malloc_trim. ("ideally" means that
+               it ignores page restrictions etc.)
+
+  Because these fields are ints, but internal bookkeeping may
+  be kept as longs, the reported values may wrap around zero and
+  thus be inaccurate.
+*/
+struct mallinfo dlmallinfo(void);
+#endif /* NO_MALLINFO */
+
+/*
+  independent_calloc(size_t n_elements, size_t element_size, void* chunks[]);
+
+  independent_calloc is similar to calloc, but instead of returning a
+  single cleared space, it returns an array of pointers to n_elements
+  independent elements that can hold contents of size elem_size, each
+  of which starts out cleared, and can be independently freed,
+  realloc'ed etc. The elements are guaranteed to be adjacently
+  allocated (this is not guaranteed to occur with multiple callocs or
+  mallocs), which may also improve cache locality in some
+  applications.
+
+  The "chunks" argument is optional (i.e., may be null, which is
+  probably the most typical usage). If it is null, the returned array
+  is itself dynamically allocated and should also be freed when it is
+  no longer needed. Otherwise, the chunks array must be of at least
+  n_elements in length. It is filled in with the pointers to the
+  chunks.
+
+  In either case, independent_calloc returns this pointer array, or
+  null if the allocation failed.  If n_elements is zero and "chunks"
+  is null, it returns a chunk representing an array with zero elements
+  (which should be freed if not wanted).
+
+  Each element must be individually freed when it is no longer
+  needed. If you'd like to instead be able to free all at once, you
+  should instead use regular calloc and assign pointers into this
+  space to represent elements.  (In this case though, you cannot
+  independently free elements.)
+
+  independent_calloc simplifies and speeds up implementations of many
+  kinds of pools.  It may also be useful when constructing large data
+  structures that initially have a fixed number of fixed-sized nodes,
+  but the number is not known at compile time, and some of the nodes
+  may later need to be freed. For example:
+
+  struct Node { int item; struct Node* next; };
+
+  struct Node* build_list() {
+    struct Node** pool;
+    int n = read_number_of_nodes_needed();
+    if (n <= 0) return 0;
+    pool = (struct Node**)(independent_calloc(n, sizeof(struct Node), 0);
+    if (pool == 0) die();
+    // organize into a linked list...
+    struct Node* first = pool[0];
+    for (i = 0; i < n-1; ++i)
+      pool[i]->next = pool[i+1];
+    free(pool);     // Can now free the array (or not, if it is needed later)
+    return first;
+  }
+*/
+void** dlindependent_calloc(size_t, size_t, void**);
+
+/*
+  independent_comalloc(size_t n_elements, size_t sizes[], void* chunks[]);
+
+  independent_comalloc allocates, all at once, a set of n_elements
+  chunks with sizes indicated in the "sizes" array.    It returns
+  an array of pointers to these elements, each of which can be
+  independently freed, realloc'ed etc. The elements are guaranteed to
+  be adjacently allocated (this is not guaranteed to occur with
+  multiple callocs or mallocs), which may also improve cache locality
+  in some applications.
+
+  The "chunks" argument is optional (i.e., may be null). If it is null
+  the returned array is itself dynamically allocated and should also
+  be freed when it is no longer needed. Otherwise, the chunks array
+  must be of at least n_elements in length. It is filled in with the
+  pointers to the chunks.
+
+  In either case, independent_comalloc returns this pointer array, or
+  null if the allocation failed.  If n_elements is zero and chunks is
+  null, it returns a chunk representing an array with zero elements
+  (which should be freed if not wanted).
+
+  Each element must be individually freed when it is no longer
+  needed. If you'd like to instead be able to free all at once, you
+  should instead use a single regular malloc, and assign pointers at
+  particular offsets in the aggregate space. (In this case though, you
+  cannot independently free elements.)
+
+  independent_comallac differs from independent_calloc in that each
+  element may have a different size, and also that it does not
+  automatically clear elements.
+
+  independent_comalloc can be used to speed up allocation in cases
+  where several structs or objects must always be allocated at the
+  same time.  For example:
+
+  struct Head { ... }
+  struct Foot { ... }
+
+  void send_message(char* msg) {
+    int msglen = strlen(msg);
+    size_t sizes[3] = { sizeof(struct Head), msglen, sizeof(struct Foot) };
+    void* chunks[3];
+    if (independent_comalloc(3, sizes, chunks) == 0)
+      die();
+    struct Head* head = (struct Head*)(chunks[0]);
+    char*        body = (char*)(chunks[1]);
+    struct Foot* foot = (struct Foot*)(chunks[2]);
+    // ...
+  }
+
+  In general though, independent_comalloc is worth using only for
+  larger values of n_elements. For small values, you probably won't
+  detect enough difference from series of malloc calls to bother.
+
+  Overuse of independent_comalloc can increase overall memory usage,
+  since it cannot reuse existing noncontiguous small chunks that
+  might be available for some of the elements.
+*/
+void** dlindependent_comalloc(size_t, size_t*, void**);
+
+
+/*
+  pvalloc(size_t n);
+  Equivalent to valloc(minimum-page-that-holds(n)), that is,
+  round up n to nearest pagesize.
+ */
+void*  dlpvalloc(size_t);
+
+/*
+  malloc_trim(size_t pad);
+
+  If possible, gives memory back to the system (via negative arguments
+  to sbrk) if there is unused memory at the `high' end of the malloc
+  pool or in unused MMAP segments. You can call this after freeing
+  large blocks of memory to potentially reduce the system-level memory
+  requirements of a program. However, it cannot guarantee to reduce
+  memory. Under some allocation patterns, some large free blocks of
+  memory will be locked between two used chunks, so they cannot be
+  given back to the system.
+
+  The `pad' argument to malloc_trim represents the amount of free
+  trailing space to leave untrimmed. If this argument is zero, only
+  the minimum amount of memory to maintain internal data structures
+  will be left. Non-zero arguments can be supplied to maintain enough
+  trailing space to service future expected allocations without having
+  to re-obtain memory from the system.
+
+  Malloc_trim returns 1 if it actually released any memory, else 0.
+*/
+int  dlmalloc_trim(size_t);
+
+/*
+  malloc_usable_size(void* p);
+
+  Returns the number of bytes you can actually use in
+  an allocated chunk, which may be more than you requested (although
+  often not) due to alignment and minimum size constraints.
+  You can use this many bytes without worrying about
+  overwriting other allocated objects. This is not a particularly great
+  programming practice. malloc_usable_size can be more useful in
+  debugging and assertions, for example:
+
+  p = malloc(n);
+  assert(malloc_usable_size(p) >= 256);
+*/
+size_t dlmalloc_usable_size(void*);
+
+/*
+  malloc_stats();
+  Prints on stderr the amount of space obtained from the system (both
+  via sbrk and mmap), the maximum amount (which may be more than
+  current if malloc_trim and/or munmap got called), and the current
+  number of bytes allocated via malloc (or realloc, etc) but not yet
+  freed. Note that this is the number of bytes allocated, not the
+  number requested. It will be larger than the number requested
+  because of alignment and bookkeeping overhead. Because it includes
+  alignment wastage as being in use, this figure may be greater than
+  zero even when no user-level chunks are allocated.
+
+  The reported current and maximum system memory can be inaccurate if
+  a program makes other calls to system memory allocation functions
+  (normally sbrk) outside of malloc.
+
+  malloc_stats prints only the most commonly interesting statistics.
+  More information can be obtained by calling mallinfo.
+*/
+void  dlmalloc_stats(void);
+
+#endif /* ONLY_MSPACES */
+
+#if MSPACES
+
+/*
+  mspace is an opaque type representing an independent
+  region of space that supports mspace_malloc, etc.
+*/
+typedef void* mspace;
+
+/*
+  create_mspace creates and returns a new independent space with the
+  given initial capacity, or, if 0, the default granularity size.  It
+  returns null if there is no system memory available to create the
+  space.  If argument locked is non-zero, the space uses a separate
+  lock to control access. The capacity of the space will grow
+  dynamically as needed to service mspace_malloc requests.  You can
+  control the sizes of incremental increases of this space by
+  compiling with a different DEFAULT_GRANULARITY or dynamically
+  setting with mallopt(M_GRANULARITY, value).
+*/
+mspace create_mspace(size_t capacity, int locked);
+
+/*
+  destroy_mspace destroys the given space, and attempts to return all
+  of its memory back to the system, returning the total number of
+  bytes freed. After destruction, the results of access to all memory
+  used by the space become undefined.
+*/
+size_t destroy_mspace(mspace msp);
+
+/*
+  create_mspace_with_base uses the memory supplied as the initial base
+  of a new mspace. Part (less than 128*sizeof(size_t) bytes) of this
+  space is used for bookkeeping, so the capacity must be at least this
+  large. (Otherwise 0 is returned.) When this initial space is
+  exhausted, additional memory will be obtained from the system.
+  Destroying this space will deallocate all additionally allocated
+  space (if possible) but not the initial base.
+*/
+mspace create_mspace_with_base(void* base, size_t capacity, int locked);
+
+/*
+  mspace_malloc behaves as malloc, but operates within
+  the given space.
+*/
+void* mspace_malloc(mspace msp, size_t bytes);
+
+/*
+  mspace_free behaves as free, but operates within
+  the given space.
+
+  If compiled with FOOTERS==1, mspace_free is not actually needed.
+  free may be called instead of mspace_free because freed chunks from
+  any space are handled by their originating spaces.
+*/
+void mspace_free(mspace msp, void* mem);
+
+/*
+  mspace_realloc behaves as realloc, but operates within
+  the given space.
+
+  If compiled with FOOTERS==1, mspace_realloc is not actually
+  needed.  realloc may be called instead of mspace_realloc because
+  realloced chunks from any space are handled by their originating
+  spaces.
+*/
+void* mspace_realloc(mspace msp, void* mem, size_t newsize);
+
+/*
+  mspace_calloc behaves as calloc, but operates within
+  the given space.
+*/
+void* mspace_calloc(mspace msp, size_t n_elements, size_t elem_size);
+
+/*
+  mspace_memalign behaves as memalign, but operates within
+  the given space.
+*/
+void* mspace_memalign(mspace msp, size_t alignment, size_t bytes);
+
+/*
+  mspace_independent_calloc behaves as independent_calloc, but
+  operates within the given space.
+*/
+void** mspace_independent_calloc(mspace msp, size_t n_elements,
+                                 size_t elem_size, void* chunks[]);
+
+/*
+  mspace_independent_comalloc behaves as independent_comalloc, but
+  operates within the given space.
+*/
+void** mspace_independent_comalloc(mspace msp, size_t n_elements,
+                                   size_t sizes[], void* chunks[]);
+
+/*
+  mspace_footprint() returns the number of bytes obtained from the
+  system for this space.
+*/
+size_t mspace_footprint(mspace msp);
+
+/*
+  mspace_max_footprint() returns the peak number of bytes obtained from the
+  system for this space.
+*/
+size_t mspace_max_footprint(mspace msp);
+
+
+#if !NO_MALLINFO
+/*
+  mspace_mallinfo behaves as mallinfo, but reports properties of
+  the given space.
+*/
+struct mallinfo mspace_mallinfo(mspace msp);
+#endif /* NO_MALLINFO */
+
+/*
+  mspace_malloc_stats behaves as malloc_stats, but reports
+  properties of the given space.
+*/
+void mspace_malloc_stats(mspace msp);
+
+/*
+  mspace_trim behaves as malloc_trim, but
+  operates within the given space.
+*/
+int mspace_trim(mspace msp, size_t pad);
+
+/*
+  An alias for mallopt.
+*/
+int mspace_mallopt(int, int);
+
+#endif /* MSPACES */
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+};  /* end of extern "C" */
+#endif /* __cplusplus */
+
+/*
+  ========================================================================
+  To make a fully customizable malloc.h header file, cut everything
+  above this line, put into file malloc.h, edit to suit, and #include it
+  on the next line, as well as in programs that use this malloc.
+  ========================================================================
+*/
+
+/* #include "malloc.h" */
+
+/*------------------------------ internal #includes ---------------------- */
+
+#ifdef _MSC_VER
+#pragma warning( disable : 4146 ) /* no "unsigned" warnings */
+#endif /* _MSC_VER */
+
+#ifndef LACKS_STDIO_H
+#include <stdio.h>       /* for printing in malloc_stats */
+#endif
+
+#ifndef LACKS_ERRNO_H
+#include <errno.h>       /* for MALLOC_FAILURE_ACTION */
+#endif /* LACKS_ERRNO_H */
+#if FOOTERS
+#include <time.h>        /* for magic initialization */
+#endif /* FOOTERS */
+#ifndef LACKS_STDLIB_H
+#include <stdlib.h>      /* for abort() */
+#endif /* LACKS_STDLIB_H */
+#ifdef DEBUG
+#if ABORT_ON_ASSERT_FAILURE
+#define assert(x) if(!(x)) ABORT
+#else /* ABORT_ON_ASSERT_FAILURE */
+#include <assert.h>
+#endif /* ABORT_ON_ASSERT_FAILURE */
+#else  /* DEBUG */
+#define assert(x)
+#endif /* DEBUG */
+#ifndef LACKS_STRING_H
+#include <string.h>      /* for memset etc */
+#endif  /* LACKS_STRING_H */
+#if USE_BUILTIN_FFS
+#ifndef LACKS_STRINGS_H
+#include <strings.h>     /* for ffs */
+#endif /* LACKS_STRINGS_H */
+#endif /* USE_BUILTIN_FFS */
+#if HAVE_MMAP
+#ifndef LACKS_SYS_MMAN_H
+#include <sys/mman.h>    /* for mmap */
+#endif /* LACKS_SYS_MMAN_H */
+#ifndef LACKS_FCNTL_H
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#endif /* LACKS_FCNTL_H */
+#endif /* HAVE_MMAP */
+#if HAVE_MORECORE
+#ifndef LACKS_UNISTD_H
+#include <unistd.h>     /* for sbrk */
+#else /* LACKS_UNISTD_H */
+#if !defined(__FreeBSD__) && !defined(__OpenBSD__) && !defined(__NetBSD__)
+extern void*     sbrk(ptrdiff_t);
+#endif /* FreeBSD etc */
+#endif /* LACKS_UNISTD_H */
+#endif /* HAVE_MMAP */
+
+#ifndef WIN32
+#ifndef malloc_getpagesize
+#  ifdef _SC_PAGESIZE         /* some SVR4 systems omit an underscore */
+#    ifndef _SC_PAGE_SIZE
+#      define _SC_PAGE_SIZE _SC_PAGESIZE
+#    endif
+#  endif
+#  ifdef _SC_PAGE_SIZE
+#    define malloc_getpagesize sysconf(_SC_PAGE_SIZE)
+#  else
+#    if defined(BSD) || defined(DGUX) || defined(HAVE_GETPAGESIZE)
+       extern size_t getpagesize();
+#      define malloc_getpagesize getpagesize()
+#    else
+#      ifdef WIN32 /* use supplied emulation of getpagesize */
+#        define malloc_getpagesize getpagesize()
+#      else
+#        ifndef LACKS_SYS_PARAM_H
+#          include <sys/param.h>
+#        endif
+#        ifdef EXEC_PAGESIZE
+#          define malloc_getpagesize EXEC_PAGESIZE
+#        else
+#          ifdef NBPG
+#            ifndef CLSIZE
+#              define malloc_getpagesize NBPG
+#            else
+#              define malloc_getpagesize (NBPG * CLSIZE)
+#            endif
+#          else
+#            ifdef NBPC
+#              define malloc_getpagesize NBPC
+#            else
+#              ifdef PAGESIZE
+#                define malloc_getpagesize PAGESIZE
+#              else /* just guess */
+#                define malloc_getpagesize ((size_t)4096U)
+#              endif
+#            endif
+#          endif
+#        endif
+#      endif
+#    endif
+#  endif
+#endif
+#endif
+
+/* ------------------- size_t and alignment properties -------------------- */
+
+/* The byte and bit size of a size_t */
+#define SIZE_T_SIZE         (sizeof(size_t))
+#define SIZE_T_BITSIZE      (sizeof(size_t) << 3)
+
+/* Some constants coerced to size_t */
+/* Annoying but necessary to avoid errors on some plaftorms */
+#define SIZE_T_ZERO         ((size_t)0)
+#define SIZE_T_ONE          ((size_t)1)
+#define SIZE_T_TWO          ((size_t)2)
+#define TWO_SIZE_T_SIZES    (SIZE_T_SIZE<<1)
+#define FOUR_SIZE_T_SIZES   (SIZE_T_SIZE<<2)
+#define SIX_SIZE_T_SIZES    (FOUR_SIZE_T_SIZES+TWO_SIZE_T_SIZES)
+#define HALF_MAX_SIZE_T     (MAX_SIZE_T / 2U)
+
+/* The bit mask value corresponding to MALLOC_ALIGNMENT */
+#define CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK    (MALLOC_ALIGNMENT - SIZE_T_ONE)
+
+/* True if address a has acceptable alignment */
+#define is_aligned(A)       (((size_t)((A)) & (CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK)) == 0)
+
+/* the number of bytes to offset an address to align it */
+#define align_offset(A)\
+ ((((size_t)(A) & CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK) == 0)? 0 :\
+  ((MALLOC_ALIGNMENT - ((size_t)(A) & CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK)) & CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK))
+
+/* -------------------------- MMAP preliminaries ------------------------- */
+
+/*
+   If HAVE_MORECORE or HAVE_MMAP are false, we just define calls and
+   checks to fail so compiler optimizer can delete code rather than
+   using so many "#if"s.
+*/
+
+
+/* MORECORE and MMAP must return MFAIL on failure */
+#define MFAIL                ((void*)(MAX_SIZE_T))
+#define CMFAIL               ((char*)(MFAIL)) /* defined for convenience */
+
+#if !HAVE_MMAP
+#define IS_MMAPPED_BIT       (SIZE_T_ZERO)
+#define USE_MMAP_BIT         (SIZE_T_ZERO)
+#define CALL_MMAP(s)         MFAIL
+#define CALL_MUNMAP(a, s)    (-1)
+#define DIRECT_MMAP(s)       MFAIL
+
+#else /* HAVE_MMAP */
+#define IS_MMAPPED_BIT       (SIZE_T_ONE)
+#define USE_MMAP_BIT         (SIZE_T_ONE)
+
+#ifndef WIN32
+#define CALL_MUNMAP(a, s)    munmap((a), (s))
+#define MMAP_PROT            (PROT_READ|PROT_WRITE)
+#if !defined(MAP_ANONYMOUS) && defined(MAP_ANON)
+#define MAP_ANONYMOUS        MAP_ANON
+#endif /* MAP_ANON */
+#ifdef MAP_ANONYMOUS
+#define MMAP_FLAGS           (MAP_PRIVATE|MAP_ANONYMOUS)
+#define CALL_MMAP(s)         mmap(0, (s), MMAP_PROT, MMAP_FLAGS, -1, 0)
+#else /* MAP_ANONYMOUS */
+/*
+   Nearly all versions of mmap support MAP_ANONYMOUS, so the following
+   is unlikely to be needed, but is supplied just in case.
+*/
+#define MMAP_FLAGS           (MAP_PRIVATE)
+static int dev_zero_fd = -1; /* Cached file descriptor for /dev/zero. */
+#define CALL_MMAP(s) ((dev_zero_fd < 0) ? \
+           (dev_zero_fd = open("/dev/zero", O_RDWR), \
+            mmap(0, (s), MMAP_PROT, MMAP_FLAGS, dev_zero_fd, 0)) : \
+            mmap(0, (s), MMAP_PROT, MMAP_FLAGS, dev_zero_fd, 0))
+#endif /* MAP_ANONYMOUS */
+
+#define DIRECT_MMAP(s)       CALL_MMAP(s)
+#else /* WIN32 */
+
+/* Win32 MMAP via VirtualAlloc */
+static void* win32mmap(size_t size) {
+  void* ptr = VirtualAlloc(0, size, MEM_RESERVE|MEM_COMMIT, PAGE_READWRITE);
+  return (ptr != 0)? ptr: MFAIL;
+}
+
+/* For direct MMAP, use MEM_TOP_DOWN to minimize interference */
+static void* win32direct_mmap(size_t size) {
+  void* ptr = VirtualAlloc(0, size, MEM_RESERVE|MEM_COMMIT|MEM_TOP_DOWN,
+                           PAGE_READWRITE);
+  return (ptr != 0)? ptr: MFAIL;
+}
+
+/* This function supports releasing coalesed segments */
+static int win32munmap(void* ptr, size_t size) {
+  MEMORY_BASIC_INFORMATION minfo;
+  char* cptr = ptr;
+  while (size) {
+    if (VirtualQuery(cptr, &minfo, sizeof(minfo)) == 0)
+      return -1;
+    if (minfo.BaseAddress != cptr || minfo.AllocationBase != cptr ||
+        minfo.State != MEM_COMMIT || minfo.RegionSize > size)
+      return -1;
+    if (VirtualFree(cptr, 0, MEM_RELEASE) == 0)
+      return -1;
+    cptr += minfo.RegionSize;
+    size -= minfo.RegionSize;
+  }
+  return 0;
+}
+
+#define CALL_MMAP(s)         win32mmap(s)
+#define CALL_MUNMAP(a, s)    win32munmap((a), (s))
+#define DIRECT_MMAP(s)       win32direct_mmap(s)
+#endif /* WIN32 */
+#endif /* HAVE_MMAP */
+
+#if HAVE_MMAP && HAVE_MREMAP
+#define CALL_MREMAP(addr, osz, nsz, mv) mremap((addr), (osz), (nsz), (mv))
+#else  /* HAVE_MMAP && HAVE_MREMAP */
+#define CALL_MREMAP(addr, osz, nsz, mv) MFAIL
+#endif /* HAVE_MMAP && HAVE_MREMAP */
+
+#if HAVE_MORECORE
+#define CALL_MORECORE(S)     MORECORE(S)
+#else  /* HAVE_MORECORE */
+#define CALL_MORECORE(S)     MFAIL
+#endif /* HAVE_MORECORE */
+
+/* mstate bit set if continguous morecore disabled or failed */
+#define USE_NONCONTIGUOUS_BIT (4U)
+
+/* segment bit set in create_mspace_with_base */
+#define EXTERN_BIT            (8U)
+
+
+/* --------------------------- Lock preliminaries ------------------------ */
+
+#if USE_LOCKS
+
+/*
+  When locks are defined, there are up to two global locks:
+
+  * If HAVE_MORECORE, morecore_mutex protects sequences of calls to
+    MORECORE.  In many cases sys_alloc requires two calls, that should
+    not be interleaved with calls by other threads.  This does not
+    protect against direct calls to MORECORE by other threads not
+    using this lock, so there is still code to cope the best we can on
+    interference.
+
+  * magic_init_mutex ensures that mparams.magic and other
+    unique mparams values are initialized only once.
+*/
+
+#ifndef WIN32
+/* By default use posix locks */
+#include <pthread.h>
+#define MLOCK_T pthread_mutex_t
+#define INITIAL_LOCK(l)      pthread_mutex_init(l, NULL)
+#define ACQUIRE_LOCK(l)      pthread_mutex_lock(l)
+#define RELEASE_LOCK(l)      pthread_mutex_unlock(l)
+
+#if HAVE_MORECORE
+static MLOCK_T morecore_mutex = PTHREAD_MUTEX_INITIALIZER;
+#endif /* HAVE_MORECORE */
+
+static MLOCK_T magic_init_mutex = PTHREAD_MUTEX_INITIALIZER;
+
+#else /* WIN32 */
+/*
+   Because lock-protected regions have bounded times, and there
+   are no recursive lock calls, we can use simple spinlocks.
+*/
+
+#define MLOCK_T long
+static int win32_acquire_lock (MLOCK_T *sl) {
+  for (;;) {
+#ifdef InterlockedCompareExchangePointer
+    if (!InterlockedCompareExchange(sl, 1, 0))
+      return 0;
+#else  /* Use older void* version */
+    if (!InterlockedCompareExchange((void**)sl, (void*)1, (void*)0))
+      return 0;
+#endif /* InterlockedCompareExchangePointer */
+    Sleep (0);
+  }
+}
+
+static void win32_release_lock (MLOCK_T *sl) {
+  InterlockedExchange (sl, 0);
+}
+
+#define INITIAL_LOCK(l)      *(l)=0
+#define ACQUIRE_LOCK(l)      win32_acquire_lock(l)
+#define RELEASE_LOCK(l)      win32_release_lock(l)
+#if HAVE_MORECORE
+static MLOCK_T morecore_mutex;
+#endif /* HAVE_MORECORE */
+static MLOCK_T magic_init_mutex;
+#endif /* WIN32 */
+
+#define USE_LOCK_BIT               (2U)
+#else  /* USE_LOCKS */
+#define USE_LOCK_BIT               (0U)
+#define INITIAL_LOCK(l)
+#endif /* USE_LOCKS */
+
+#if USE_LOCKS && HAVE_MORECORE
+#define ACQUIRE_MORECORE_LOCK()    ACQUIRE_LOCK(&morecore_mutex);
+#define RELEASE_MORECORE_LOCK()    RELEASE_LOCK(&morecore_mutex);
+#else /* USE_LOCKS && HAVE_MORECORE */
+#define ACQUIRE_MORECORE_LOCK()
+#define RELEASE_MORECORE_LOCK()
+#endif /* USE_LOCKS && HAVE_MORECORE */
+
+#if USE_LOCKS
+#define ACQUIRE_MAGIC_INIT_LOCK()  ACQUIRE_LOCK(&magic_init_mutex);
+#define RELEASE_MAGIC_INIT_LOCK()  RELEASE_LOCK(&magic_init_mutex);
+#else  /* USE_LOCKS */
+#define ACQUIRE_MAGIC_INIT_LOCK()
+#define RELEASE_MAGIC_INIT_LOCK()
+#endif /* USE_LOCKS */
+
+
+/* -----------------------  Chunk representations ------------------------ */
+
+/*
+  (The following includes lightly edited explanations by Colin Plumb.)
+
+  The malloc_chunk declaration below is misleading (but accurate and
+  necessary).  It declares a "view" into memory allowing access to
+  necessary fields at known offsets from a given base.
+
+  Chunks of memory are maintained using a `boundary tag' method as
+  originally described by Knuth.  (See the paper by Paul Wilson
+  ftp://ftp.cs.utexas.edu/pub/garbage/allocsrv.ps for a survey of such
+  techniques.)  Sizes of free chunks are stored both in the front of
+  each chunk and at the end.  This makes consolidating fragmented
+  chunks into bigger chunks fast.  The head fields also hold bits
+  representing whether chunks are free or in use.
+
+  Here are some pictures to make it clearer.  They are "exploded" to
+  show that the state of a chunk can be thought of as extending from
+  the high 31 bits of the head field of its header through the
+  prev_foot and PINUSE_BIT bit of the following chunk header.
+
+  A chunk that's in use looks like:
+
+   chunk-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+           | Size of previous chunk (if P = 1)                             |
+           +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+         +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+ |P|
+         | Size of this chunk                                         1| +-+
+   mem-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+         |                                                               |
+         +-                                                             -+
+         |                                                               |
+         +-                                                             -+
+         |                                                               :
+         +-      size - sizeof(size_t) available payload bytes          -+
+         :                                                               |
+ chunk-> +-                                                             -+
+         |                                                               |
+         +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+       +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+ |1|
+       | Size of next chunk (may or may not be in use)               | +-+
+ mem-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+
+    And if it's free, it looks like this:
+
+   chunk-> +-                                                             -+
+           | User payload (must be in use, or we would have merged!)       |
+           +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+         +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+ |P|
+         | Size of this chunk                                         0| +-+
+   mem-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+         | Next pointer                                                  |
+         +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+         | Prev pointer                                                  |
+         +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+         |                                                               :
+         +-      size - sizeof(struct chunk) unused bytes               -+
+         :                                                               |
+ chunk-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+         | Size of this chunk                                            |
+         +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+       +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+ |0|
+       | Size of next chunk (must be in use, or we would have merged)| +-+
+ mem-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+       |                                                               :
+       +- User payload                                                -+
+       :                                                               |
+       +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+                                                                     |0|
+                                                                     +-+
+  Note that since we always merge adjacent free chunks, the chunks
+  adjacent to a free chunk must be in use.
+
+  Given a pointer to a chunk (which can be derived trivially from the
+  payload pointer) we can, in O(1) time, find out whether the adjacent
+  chunks are free, and if so, unlink them from the lists that they
+  are on and merge them with the current chunk.
+
+  Chunks always begin on even word boundaries, so the mem portion
+  (which is returned to the user) is also on an even word boundary, and
+  thus at least double-word aligned.
+
+  The P (PINUSE_BIT) bit, stored in the unused low-order bit of the
+  chunk size (which is always a multiple of two words), is an in-use
+  bit for the *previous* chunk.  If that bit is *clear*, then the
+  word before the current chunk size contains the previous chunk
+  size, and can be used to find the front of the previous chunk.
+  The very first chunk allocated always has this bit set, preventing
+  access to non-existent (or non-owned) memory. If pinuse is set for
+  any given chunk, then you CANNOT determine the size of the
+  previous chunk, and might even get a memory addressing fault when
+  trying to do so.
+
+  The C (CINUSE_BIT) bit, stored in the unused second-lowest bit of
+  the chunk size redundantly records whether the current chunk is
+  inuse. This redundancy enables usage checks within free and realloc,
+  and reduces indirection when freeing and consolidating chunks.
+
+  Each freshly allocated chunk must have both cinuse and pinuse set.
+  That is, each allocated chunk borders either a previously allocated
+  and still in-use chunk, or the base of its memory arena. This is
+  ensured by making all allocations from the the `lowest' part of any
+  found chunk.  Further, no free chunk physically borders another one,
+  so each free chunk is known to be preceded and followed by either
+  inuse chunks or the ends of memory.
+
+  Note that the `foot' of the current chunk is actually represented
+  as the prev_foot of the NEXT chunk. This makes it easier to
+  deal with alignments etc but can be very confusing when trying
+  to extend or adapt this code.
+
+  The exceptions to all this are
+
+     1. The special chunk `top' is the top-most available chunk (i.e.,
+        the one bordering the end of available memory). It is treated
+        specially.  Top is never included in any bin, is used only if
+        no other chunk is available, and is released back to the
+        system if it is very large (see M_TRIM_THRESHOLD).  In effect,
+        the top chunk is treated as larger (and thus less well
+        fitting) than any other available chunk.  The top chunk
+        doesn't update its trailing size field since there is no next
+        contiguous chunk that would have to index off it. However,
+        space is still allocated for it (TOP_FOOT_SIZE) to enable
+        separation or merging when space is extended.
+
+     3. Chunks allocated via mmap, which have the lowest-order bit
+        (IS_MMAPPED_BIT) set in their prev_foot fields, and do not set
+        PINUSE_BIT in their head fields.  Because they are allocated
+        one-by-one, each must carry its own prev_foot field, which is
+        also used to hold the offset this chunk has within its mmapped
+        region, which is needed to preserve alignment. Each mmapped
+        chunk is trailed by the first two fields of a fake next-chunk
+        for sake of usage checks.
+
+*/
+
+struct malloc_chunk {
+  size_t               prev_foot;  /* Size of previous chunk (if free).  */
+  size_t               head;       /* Size and inuse bits. */
+  struct malloc_chunk* fd;         /* double links -- used only if free. */
+  struct malloc_chunk* bk;
+};
+
+typedef struct malloc_chunk  mchunk;
+typedef struct malloc_chunk* mchunkptr;
+typedef struct malloc_chunk* sbinptr;  /* The type of bins of chunks */
+typedef unsigned int bindex_t;         /* Described below */
+typedef unsigned int binmap_t;         /* Described below */
+typedef unsigned int flag_t;           /* The type of various bit flag sets */
+
+/* ------------------- Chunks sizes and alignments ----------------------- */
+
+#define MCHUNK_SIZE         (sizeof(mchunk))
+
+#if FOOTERS
+#define CHUNK_OVERHEAD      (TWO_SIZE_T_SIZES)
+#else /* FOOTERS */
+#define CHUNK_OVERHEAD      (SIZE_T_SIZE)
+#endif /* FOOTERS */
+
+/* MMapped chunks need a second word of overhead ... */
+#define MMAP_CHUNK_OVERHEAD (TWO_SIZE_T_SIZES)
+/* ... and additional padding for fake next-chunk at foot */
+#define MMAP_FOOT_PAD       (FOUR_SIZE_T_SIZES)
+
+/* The smallest size we can malloc is an aligned minimal chunk */
+#define MIN_CHUNK_SIZE\
+  ((MCHUNK_SIZE + CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK) & ~CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK)
+
+/* conversion from malloc headers to user pointers, and back */
+#define chunk2mem(p)        ((void*)((char*)(p)       + TWO_SIZE_T_SIZES))
+#define mem2chunk(mem)      ((mchunkptr)((char*)(mem) - TWO_SIZE_T_SIZES))
+/* chunk associated with aligned address A */
+#define align_as_chunk(A)   (mchunkptr)((A) + align_offset(chunk2mem(A)))
+
+/* Bounds on request (not chunk) sizes. */
+#define MAX_REQUEST         ((-MIN_CHUNK_SIZE) << 2)
+#define MIN_REQUEST         (MIN_CHUNK_SIZE - CHUNK_OVERHEAD - SIZE_T_ONE)
+
+/* pad request bytes into a usable size */
+#define pad_request(req) \
+   (((req) + CHUNK_OVERHEAD + CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK) & ~CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK)
+
+/* pad request, checking for minimum (but not maximum) */
+#define request2size(req) \
+  (((req) < MIN_REQUEST)? MIN_CHUNK_SIZE : pad_request(req))
+
+
+/* ------------------ Operations on head and foot fields ----------------- */
+
+/*
+  The head field of a chunk is or'ed with PINUSE_BIT when previous
+  adjacent chunk in use, and or'ed with CINUSE_BIT if this chunk is in
+  use. If the chunk was obtained with mmap, the prev_foot field has
+  IS_MMAPPED_BIT set, otherwise holding the offset of the base of the
+  mmapped region to the base of the chunk.
+*/
+
+#define PINUSE_BIT          (SIZE_T_ONE)
+#define CINUSE_BIT          (SIZE_T_TWO)
+#define INUSE_BITS          (PINUSE_BIT|CINUSE_BIT)
+
+/* Head value for fenceposts */
+#define FENCEPOST_HEAD      (INUSE_BITS|SIZE_T_SIZE)
+
+/* extraction of fields from head words */
+#define cinuse(p)           ((p)->head & CINUSE_BIT)
+#define pinuse(p)           ((p)->head & PINUSE_BIT)
+#define chunksize(p)        ((p)->head & ~(INUSE_BITS))
+
+#define clear_pinuse(p)     ((p)->head &= ~PINUSE_BIT)
+#define clear_cinuse(p)     ((p)->head &= ~CINUSE_BIT)
+
+/* Treat space at ptr +/- offset as a chunk */
+#define chunk_plus_offset(p, s)  ((mchunkptr)(((char*)(p)) + (s)))
+#define chunk_minus_offset(p, s) ((mchunkptr)(((char*)(p)) - (s)))
+
+/* Ptr to next or previous physical malloc_chunk. */
+#define next_chunk(p) ((mchunkptr)( ((char*)(p)) + ((p)->head & ~INUSE_BITS)))
+#define prev_chunk(p) ((mchunkptr)( ((char*)(p)) - ((p)->prev_foot) ))
+
+/* extract next chunk's pinuse bit */
+#define next_pinuse(p)  ((next_chunk(p)->head) & PINUSE_BIT)
+
+/* Get/set size at footer */
+#define get_foot(p, s)  (((mchunkptr)((char*)(p) + (s)))->prev_foot)
+#define set_foot(p, s)  (((mchunkptr)((char*)(p) + (s)))->prev_foot = (s))
+
+/* Set size, pinuse bit, and foot */
+#define set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(p, s)\
+  ((p)->head = (s|PINUSE_BIT), set_foot(p, s))
+
+/* Set size, pinuse bit, foot, and clear next pinuse */
+#define set_free_with_pinuse(p, s, n)\
+  (clear_pinuse(n), set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(p, s))
+
+#define is_mmapped(p)\
+  (!((p)->head & PINUSE_BIT) && ((p)->prev_foot & IS_MMAPPED_BIT))
+
+/* Get the internal overhead associated with chunk p */
+#define overhead_for(p)\
+ (is_mmapped(p)? MMAP_CHUNK_OVERHEAD : CHUNK_OVERHEAD)
+
+/* Return true if malloced space is not necessarily cleared */
+#if MMAP_CLEARS
+#define calloc_must_clear(p) (!is_mmapped(p))
+#else /* MMAP_CLEARS */
+#define calloc_must_clear(p) (1)
+#endif /* MMAP_CLEARS */
+
+/* ---------------------- Overlaid data structures ----------------------- */
+
+/*
+  When chunks are not in use, they are treated as nodes of either
+  lists or trees.
+
+  "Small"  chunks are stored in circular doubly-linked lists, and look
+  like this:
+
+    chunk-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Size of previous chunk                            |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+    `head:' |             Size of chunk, in bytes                         |P|
+      mem-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Forward pointer to next chunk in list             |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Back pointer to previous chunk in list            |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Unused space (may be 0 bytes long)                .
+            .                                                               .
+            .                                                               |
+nextchunk-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+    `foot:' |             Size of chunk, in bytes                           |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+
+  Larger chunks are kept in a form of bitwise digital trees (aka
+  tries) keyed on chunksizes.  Because malloc_tree_chunks are only for
+  free chunks greater than 256 bytes, their size doesn't impose any
+  constraints on user chunk sizes.  Each node looks like:
+
+    chunk-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Size of previous chunk                            |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+    `head:' |             Size of chunk, in bytes                         |P|
+      mem-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Forward pointer to next chunk of same size        |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Back pointer to previous chunk of same size       |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Pointer to left child (child[0])                  |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Pointer to right child (child[1])                 |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Pointer to parent                                 |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             bin index of this chunk                           |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+            |             Unused space                                      .
+            .                                                               |
+nextchunk-> +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+    `foot:' |             Size of chunk, in bytes                           |
+            +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
+
+  Each tree holding treenodes is a tree of unique chunk sizes.  Chunks
+  of the same size are arranged in a circularly-linked list, with only
+  the oldest chunk (the next to be used, in our FIFO ordering)
+  actually in the tree.  (Tree members are distinguished by a non-null
+  parent pointer.)  If a chunk with the same size an an existing node
+  is inserted, it is linked off the existing node using pointers that
+  work in the same way as fd/bk pointers of small chunks.
+
+  Each tree contains a power of 2 sized range of chunk sizes (the
+  smallest is 0x100 <= x < 0x180), which is is divided in half at each
+  tree level, with the chunks in the smaller half of the range (0x100
+  <= x < 0x140 for the top nose) in the left subtree and the larger
+  half (0x140 <= x < 0x180) in the right subtree.  This is, of course,
+  done by inspecting individual bits.
+
+  Using these rules, each node's left subtree contains all smaller
+  sizes than its right subtree.  However, the node at the root of each
+  subtree has no particular ordering relationship to either.  (The
+  dividing line between the subtree sizes is based on trie relation.)
+  If we remove the last chunk of a given size from the interior of the
+  tree, we need to replace it with a leaf node.  The tree ordering
+  rules permit a node to be replaced by any leaf below it.
+
+  The smallest chunk in a tree (a common operation in a best-fit
+  allocator) can be found by walking a path to the leftmost leaf in
+  the tree.  Unlike a usual binary tree, where we follow left child
+  pointers until we reach a null, here we follow the right child
+  pointer any time the left one is null, until we reach a leaf with
+  both child pointers null. The smallest chunk in the tree will be
+  somewhere along that path.
+
+  The worst case number of steps to add, find, or remove a node is
+  bounded by the number of bits differentiating chunks within
+  bins. Under current bin calculations, this ranges from 6 up to 21
+  (for 32 bit sizes) or up to 53 (for 64 bit sizes). The typical case
+  is of course much better.
+*/
+
+struct malloc_tree_chunk {
+  /* The first four fields must be compatible with malloc_chunk */
+  size_t                    prev_foot;
+  size_t                    head;
+  struct malloc_tree_chunk* fd;
+  struct malloc_tree_chunk* bk;
+
+  struct malloc_tree_chunk* child[2];
+  struct malloc_tree_chunk* parent;
+  bindex_t                  index;
+};
+
+typedef struct malloc_tree_chunk  tchunk;
+typedef struct malloc_tree_chunk* tchunkptr;
+typedef struct malloc_tree_chunk* tbinptr; /* The type of bins of trees */
+
+/* A little helper macro for trees */
+#define leftmost_child(t) ((t)->child[0] != 0? (t)->child[0] : (t)->child[1])
+
+/* ----------------------------- Segments -------------------------------- */
+
+/*
+  Each malloc space may include non-contiguous segments, held in a
+  list headed by an embedded malloc_segment record representing the
+  top-most space. Segments also include flags holding properties of
+  the space. Large chunks that are directly allocated by mmap are not
+  included in this list. They are instead independently created and
+  destroyed without otherwise keeping track of them.
+
+  Segment management mainly comes into play for spaces allocated by
+  MMAP.  Any call to MMAP might or might not return memory that is
+  adjacent to an existing segment.  MORECORE normally contiguously
+  extends the current space, so this space is almost always adjacent,
+  which is simpler and faster to deal with. (This is why MORECORE is
+  used preferentially to MMAP when both are available -- see
+  sys_alloc.)  When allocating using MMAP, we don't use any of the
+  hinting mechanisms (inconsistently) supported in various
+  implementations of unix mmap, or distinguish reserving from
+  committing memory. Instead, we just ask for space, and exploit
+  contiguity when we get it.  It is probably possible to do
+  better than this on some systems, but no general scheme seems
+  to be significantly better.
+
+  Management entails a simpler variant of the consolidation scheme
+  used for chunks to reduce fragmentation -- new adjacent memory is
+  normally prepended or appended to an existing segment. However,
+  there are limitations compared to chunk consolidation that mostly
+  reflect the fact that segment processing is relatively infrequent
+  (occurring only when getting memory from system) and that we
+  don't expect to have huge numbers of segments:
+
+  * Segments are not indexed, so traversal requires linear scans.  (It
+    would be possible to index these, but is not worth the extra
+    overhead and complexity for most programs on most platforms.)
+  * New segments are only appended to old ones when holding top-most
+    memory; if they cannot be prepended to others, they are held in
+    different segments.
+
+  Except for the top-most segment of an mstate, each segment record
+  is kept at the tail of its segment. Segments are added by pushing
+  segment records onto the list headed by &mstate.seg for the
+  containing mstate.
+
+  Segment flags control allocation/merge/deallocation policies:
+  * If EXTERN_BIT set, then we did not allocate this segment,
+    and so should not try to deallocate or merge with others.
+    (This currently holds only for the initial segment passed
+    into create_mspace_with_base.)
+  * If IS_MMAPPED_BIT set, the segment may be merged with
+    other surrounding mmapped segments and trimmed/de-allocated
+    using munmap.
+  * If neither bit is set, then the segment was obtained using
+    MORECORE so can be merged with surrounding MORECORE'd segments
+    and deallocated/trimmed using MORECORE with negative arguments.
+*/
+
+struct malloc_segment {
+  char*        base;             /* base address */
+  size_t       size;             /* allocated size */
+  struct malloc_segment* next;   /* ptr to next segment */
+  flag_t       sflags;           /* mmap and extern flag */
+};
+
+#define is_mmapped_segment(S)  ((S)->sflags & IS_MMAPPED_BIT)
+#define is_extern_segment(S)   ((S)->sflags & EXTERN_BIT)
+
+typedef struct malloc_segment  msegment;
+typedef struct malloc_segment* msegmentptr;
+
+/* ---------------------------- malloc_state ----------------------------- */
+
+/*
+   A malloc_state holds all of the bookkeeping for a space.
+   The main fields are:
+
+  Top
+    The topmost chunk of the currently active segment. Its size is
+    cached in topsize.  The actual size of topmost space is
+    topsize+TOP_FOOT_SIZE, which includes space reserved for adding
+    fenceposts and segment records if necessary when getting more
+    space from the system.  The size at which to autotrim top is
+    cached from mparams in trim_check, except that it is disabled if
+    an autotrim fails.
+
+  Designated victim (dv)
+    This is the preferred chunk for servicing small requests that
+    don't have exact fits.  It is normally the chunk split off most
+    recently to service another small request.  Its size is cached in
+    dvsize. The link fields of this chunk are not maintained since it
+    is not kept in a bin.
+
+  SmallBins
+    An array of bin headers for free chunks.  These bins hold chunks
+    with sizes less than MIN_LARGE_SIZE bytes. Each bin contains
+    chunks of all the same size, spaced 8 bytes apart.  To simplify
+    use in double-linked lists, each bin header acts as a malloc_chunk
+    pointing to the real first node, if it exists (else pointing to
+    itself).  This avoids special-casing for headers.  But to avoid
+    waste, we allocate only the fd/bk pointers of bins, and then use
+    repositioning tricks to treat these as the fields of a chunk.
+
+  TreeBins
+    Treebins are pointers to the roots of trees holding a range of
+    sizes. There are 2 equally spaced treebins for each power of two
+    from TREE_SHIFT to TREE_SHIFT+16. The last bin holds anything
+    larger.
+
+  Bin maps
+    There is one bit map for small bins ("smallmap") and one for
+    treebins ("treemap).  Each bin sets its bit when non-empty, and
+    clears the bit when empty.  Bit operations are then used to avoid
+    bin-by-bin searching -- nearly all "search" is done without ever
+    looking at bins that won't be selected.  The bit maps
+    conservatively use 32 bits per map word, even if on 64bit system.
+    For a good description of some of the bit-based techniques used
+    here, see Henry S. Warren Jr's book "Hacker's Delight" (and
+    supplement at http://hackersdelight.org/). Many of these are
+    intended to reduce the branchiness of paths through malloc etc, as
+    well as to reduce the number of memory locations read or written.
+
+  Segments
+    A list of segments headed by an embedded malloc_segment record
+    representing the initial space.
+
+  Address check support
+    The least_addr field is the least address ever obtained from
+    MORECORE or MMAP. Attempted frees and reallocs of any address less
+    than this are trapped (unless INSECURE is defined).
+
+  Magic tag
+    A cross-check field that should always hold same value as mparams.magic.
+
+  Flags
+    Bits recording whether to use MMAP, locks, or contiguous MORECORE
+
+  Statistics
+    Each space keeps track of current and maximum system memory
+    obtained via MORECORE or MMAP.
+
+  Locking
+    If USE_LOCKS is defined, the "mutex" lock is acquired and released
+    around every public call using this mspace.
+*/
+
+/* Bin types, widths and sizes */
+#define NSMALLBINS        (32U)
+#define NTREEBINS         (32U)
+#define SMALLBIN_SHIFT    (3U)
+#define SMALLBIN_WIDTH    (SIZE_T_ONE << SMALLBIN_SHIFT)
+#define TREEBIN_SHIFT     (8U)
+#define MIN_LARGE_SIZE    (SIZE_T_ONE << TREEBIN_SHIFT)
+#define MAX_SMALL_SIZE    (MIN_LARGE_SIZE - SIZE_T_ONE)
+#define MAX_SMALL_REQUEST (MAX_SMALL_SIZE - CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK - CHUNK_OVERHEAD)
+
+struct malloc_state {
+  binmap_t   smallmap;
+  binmap_t   treemap;
+  size_t     dvsize;
+  size_t     topsize;
+  char*      least_addr;
+  mchunkptr  dv;
+  mchunkptr  top;
+  size_t     trim_check;
+  size_t     magic;
+  mchunkptr  smallbins[(NSMALLBINS+1)*2];
+  tbinptr    treebins[NTREEBINS];
+  size_t     footprint;
+  size_t     max_footprint;
+  flag_t     mflags;
+#if USE_LOCKS
+  MLOCK_T    mutex;     /* locate lock among fields that rarely change */
+#endif /* USE_LOCKS */
+  msegment   seg;
+};
+
+typedef struct malloc_state*    mstate;
+
+/* ------------- Global malloc_state and malloc_params ------------------- */
+
+/*
+  malloc_params holds global properties, including those that can be
+  dynamically set using mallopt. There is a single instance, mparams,
+  initialized in init_mparams.
+*/
+
+struct malloc_params {
+  size_t magic;
+  size_t page_size;
+  size_t granularity;
+  size_t mmap_threshold;
+  size_t trim_threshold;
+  flag_t default_mflags;
+};
+
+static struct malloc_params mparams;
+
+/* The global malloc_state used for all non-"mspace" calls */
+static struct malloc_state _gm_;
+#define gm                 (&_gm_)
+#define is_global(M)       ((M) == &_gm_)
+#define is_initialized(M)  ((M)->top != 0)
+
+/* -------------------------- system alloc setup ------------------------- */
+
+/* Operations on mflags */
+
+#define use_lock(M)           ((M)->mflags &   USE_LOCK_BIT)
+#define enable_lock(M)        ((M)->mflags |=  USE_LOCK_BIT)
+#define disable_lock(M)       ((M)->mflags &= ~USE_LOCK_BIT)
+
+#define use_mmap(M)           ((M)->mflags &   USE_MMAP_BIT)
+#define enable_mmap(M)        ((M)->mflags |=  USE_MMAP_BIT)
+#define disable_mmap(M)       ((M)->mflags &= ~USE_MMAP_BIT)
+
+#define use_noncontiguous(M)  ((M)->mflags &   USE_NONCONTIGUOUS_BIT)
+#define disable_contiguous(M) ((M)->mflags |=  USE_NONCONTIGUOUS_BIT)
+
+#define set_lock(M,L)\
+ ((M)->mflags = (L)?\
+  ((M)->mflags | USE_LOCK_BIT) :\
+  ((M)->mflags & ~USE_LOCK_BIT))
+
+/* page-align a size */
+#define page_align(S)\
+ (((S) + (mparams.page_size)) & ~(mparams.page_size - SIZE_T_ONE))
+
+/* granularity-align a size */
+#define granularity_align(S)\
+  (((S) + (mparams.granularity)) & ~(mparams.granularity - SIZE_T_ONE))
+
+#define is_page_aligned(S)\
+   (((size_t)(S) & (mparams.page_size - SIZE_T_ONE)) == 0)
+#define is_granularity_aligned(S)\
+   (((size_t)(S) & (mparams.granularity - SIZE_T_ONE)) == 0)
+
+/*  True if segment S holds address A */
+#define segment_holds(S, A)\
+  ((char*)(A) >= S->base && (char*)(A) < S->base + S->size)
+
+/* Return segment holding given address */
+static msegmentptr segment_holding(mstate m, char* addr) {
+  msegmentptr sp = &m->seg;
+  for (;;) {
+    if (addr >= sp->base && addr < sp->base + sp->size)
+      return sp;
+    if ((sp = sp->next) == 0)
+      return 0;
+  }
+}
+
+/* Return true if segment contains a segment link */
+static int has_segment_link(mstate m, msegmentptr ss) {
+  msegmentptr sp = &m->seg;
+  for (;;) {
+    if ((char*)sp >= ss->base && (char*)sp < ss->base + ss->size)
+      return 1;
+    if ((sp = sp->next) == 0)
+      return 0;
+  }
+}
+
+#ifndef MORECORE_CANNOT_TRIM
+#define should_trim(M,s)  ((s) > (M)->trim_check)
+#else  /* MORECORE_CANNOT_TRIM */
+#define should_trim(M,s)  (0)
+#endif /* MORECORE_CANNOT_TRIM */
+
+/*
+  TOP_FOOT_SIZE is padding at the end of a segment, including space
+  that may be needed to place segment records and fenceposts when new
+  noncontiguous segments are added.
+*/
+#define TOP_FOOT_SIZE\
+  (align_offset(chunk2mem(0))+pad_request(sizeof(struct malloc_segment))+MIN_CHUNK_SIZE)
+
+
+/* -------------------------------  Hooks -------------------------------- */
+
+/*
+  PREACTION should be defined to return 0 on success, and nonzero on
+  failure. If you are not using locking, you can redefine these to do
+  anything you like.
+*/
+
+#if USE_LOCKS
+
+/* Ensure locks are initialized */
+#define GLOBALLY_INITIALIZE() (mparams.page_size == 0 && init_mparams())
+
+#define PREACTION(M)  ((GLOBALLY_INITIALIZE() || use_lock(M))? ACQUIRE_LOCK(&(M)->mutex) : 0)
+#define POSTACTION(M) { if (use_lock(M)) RELEASE_LOCK(&(M)->mutex); }
+#else /* USE_LOCKS */
+
+#ifndef PREACTION
+#define PREACTION(M) (0)
+#endif  /* PREACTION */
+
+#ifndef POSTACTION
+#define POSTACTION(M)
+#endif  /* POSTACTION */
+
+#endif /* USE_LOCKS */
+
+/*
+  CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION is triggered upon detected bad addresses.
+  USAGE_ERROR_ACTION is triggered on detected bad frees and
+  reallocs. The argument p is an address that might have triggered the
+  fault. It is ignored by the two predefined actions, but might be
+  useful in custom actions that try to help diagnose errors.
+*/
+
+#if PROCEED_ON_ERROR
+
+/* A count of the number of corruption errors causing resets */
+int malloc_corruption_error_count;
+
+/* default corruption action */
+static void reset_on_error(mstate m);
+
+#define CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(m)  reset_on_error(m)
+#define USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(m, p)
+
+#else /* PROCEED_ON_ERROR */
+
+#ifndef CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION
+#define CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(m) ABORT
+#endif /* CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION */
+
+#ifndef USAGE_ERROR_ACTION
+#define USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(m,p) ABORT
+#endif /* USAGE_ERROR_ACTION */
+
+#endif /* PROCEED_ON_ERROR */
+
+/* -------------------------- Debugging setup ---------------------------- */
+
+#if ! DEBUG
+
+#define check_free_chunk(M,P)
+#define check_inuse_chunk(M,P)
+#define check_malloced_chunk(M,P,N)
+#define check_mmapped_chunk(M,P)
+#define check_malloc_state(M)
+#define check_top_chunk(M,P)
+
+#else /* DEBUG */
+#define check_free_chunk(M,P)       do_check_free_chunk(M,P)
+#define check_inuse_chunk(M,P)      do_check_inuse_chunk(M,P)
+#define check_top_chunk(M,P)        do_check_top_chunk(M,P)
+#define check_malloced_chunk(M,P,N) do_check_malloced_chunk(M,P,N)
+#define check_mmapped_chunk(M,P)    do_check_mmapped_chunk(M,P)
+#define check_malloc_state(M)       do_check_malloc_state(M)
+
+static void   do_check_any_chunk(mstate m, mchunkptr p);
+static void   do_check_top_chunk(mstate m, mchunkptr p);
+static void   do_check_mmapped_chunk(mstate m, mchunkptr p);
+static void   do_check_inuse_chunk(mstate m, mchunkptr p);
+static void   do_check_free_chunk(mstate m, mchunkptr p);
+static void   do_check_malloced_chunk(mstate m, void* mem, size_t s);
+static void   do_check_tree(mstate m, tchunkptr t);
+static void   do_check_treebin(mstate m, bindex_t i);
+static void   do_check_smallbin(mstate m, bindex_t i);
+static void   do_check_malloc_state(mstate m);
+static int    bin_find(mstate m, mchunkptr x);
+static size_t traverse_and_check(mstate m);
+#endif /* DEBUG */
+
+/* ---------------------------- Indexing Bins ---------------------------- */
+
+#define is_small(s)         (((s) >> SMALLBIN_SHIFT) < NSMALLBINS)
+#define small_index(s)      ((s)  >> SMALLBIN_SHIFT)
+#define small_index2size(i) ((i)  << SMALLBIN_SHIFT)
+#define MIN_SMALL_INDEX     (small_index(MIN_CHUNK_SIZE))
+
+/* addressing by index. See above about smallbin repositioning */
+#define smallbin_at(M, i)   ((sbinptr)((char*)&((M)->smallbins[(i)<<1])))
+#define treebin_at(M,i)     (&((M)->treebins[i]))
+
+/* assign tree index for size S to variable I */
+#if defined(__GNUC__) && defined(i386)
+#define compute_tree_index(S, I)\
+{\
+  size_t X = S >> TREEBIN_SHIFT;\
+  if (X == 0)\
+    I = 0;\
+  else if (X > 0xFFFF)\
+    I = NTREEBINS-1;\
+  else {\
+    unsigned int K;\
+    __asm__("bsrl %1,%0\n\t" : "=r" (K) : "rm"  (X));\
+    I =  (bindex_t)((K << 1) + ((S >> (K + (TREEBIN_SHIFT-1)) & 1)));\
+  }\
+}
+#else /* GNUC */
+#define compute_tree_index(S, I)\
+{\
+  size_t X = S >> TREEBIN_SHIFT;\
+  if (X == 0)\
+    I = 0;\
+  else if (X > 0xFFFF)\
+    I = NTREEBINS-1;\
+  else {\
+    unsigned int Y = (unsigned int)X;\
+    unsigned int N = ((Y - 0x100) >> 16) & 8;\
+    unsigned int K = (((Y <<= N) - 0x1000) >> 16) & 4;\
+    N += K;\
+    N += K = (((Y <<= K) - 0x4000) >> 16) & 2;\
+    K = 14 - N + ((Y <<= K) >> 15);\
+    I = (K << 1) + ((S >> (K + (TREEBIN_SHIFT-1)) & 1));\
+  }\
+}
+#endif /* GNUC */
+
+/* Bit representing maximum resolved size in a treebin at i */
+#define bit_for_tree_index(i) \
+   (i == NTREEBINS-1)? (SIZE_T_BITSIZE-1) : (((i) >> 1) + TREEBIN_SHIFT - 2)
+
+/* Shift placing maximum resolved bit in a treebin at i as sign bit */
+#define leftshift_for_tree_index(i) \
+   ((i == NTREEBINS-1)? 0 : \
+    ((SIZE_T_BITSIZE-SIZE_T_ONE) - (((i) >> 1) + TREEBIN_SHIFT - 2)))
+
+/* The size of the smallest chunk held in bin with index i */
+#define minsize_for_tree_index(i) \
+   ((SIZE_T_ONE << (((i) >> 1) + TREEBIN_SHIFT)) |  \
+   (((size_t)((i) & SIZE_T_ONE)) << (((i) >> 1) + TREEBIN_SHIFT - 1)))
+
+
+/* ------------------------ Operations on bin maps ----------------------- */
+
+/* bit corresponding to given index */
+#define idx2bit(i)              ((binmap_t)(1) << (i))
+
+/* Mark/Clear bits with given index */
+#define mark_smallmap(M,i)      ((M)->smallmap |=  idx2bit(i))
+#define clear_smallmap(M,i)     ((M)->smallmap &= ~idx2bit(i))
+#define smallmap_is_marked(M,i) ((M)->smallmap &   idx2bit(i))
+
+#define mark_treemap(M,i)       ((M)->treemap  |=  idx2bit(i))
+#define clear_treemap(M,i)      ((M)->treemap  &= ~idx2bit(i))
+#define treemap_is_marked(M,i)  ((M)->treemap  &   idx2bit(i))
+
+/* index corresponding to given bit */
+
+#if defined(__GNUC__) && defined(i386)
+#define compute_bit2idx(X, I)\
+{\
+  unsigned int J;\
+  __asm__("bsfl %1,%0\n\t" : "=r" (J) : "rm" (X));\
+  I = (bindex_t)J;\
+}
+
+#else /* GNUC */
+#if  USE_BUILTIN_FFS
+#define compute_bit2idx(X, I) I = ffs(X)-1
+
+#else /* USE_BUILTIN_FFS */
+#define compute_bit2idx(X, I)\
+{\
+  unsigned int Y = X - 1;\
+  unsigned int K = Y >> (16-4) & 16;\
+  unsigned int N = K;        Y >>= K;\
+  N += K = Y >> (8-3) &  8;  Y >>= K;\
+  N += K = Y >> (4-2) &  4;  Y >>= K;\
+  N += K = Y >> (2-1) &  2;  Y >>= K;\
+  N += K = Y >> (1-0) &  1;  Y >>= K;\
+  I = (bindex_t)(N + Y);\
+}
+#endif /* USE_BUILTIN_FFS */
+#endif /* GNUC */
+
+/* isolate the least set bit of a bitmap */
+#define least_bit(x)         ((x) & -(x))
+
+/* mask with all bits to left of least bit of x on */
+#define left_bits(x)         ((x<<1) | -(x<<1))
+
+/* mask with all bits to left of or equal to least bit of x on */
+#define same_or_left_bits(x) ((x) | -(x))
+
+
+/* ----------------------- Runtime Check Support ------------------------- */
+
+/*
+  For security, the main invariant is that malloc/free/etc never
+  writes to a static address other than malloc_state, unless static
+  malloc_state itself has been corrupted, which cannot occur via
+  malloc (because of these checks). In essence this means that we
+  believe all pointers, sizes, maps etc held in malloc_state, but
+  check all of those linked or offsetted from other embedded data
+  structures.  These checks are interspersed with main code in a way
+  that tends to minimize their run-time cost.
+
+  When FOOTERS is defined, in addition to range checking, we also
+  verify footer fields of inuse chunks, which can be used guarantee
+  that the mstate controlling malloc/free is intact.  This is a
+  streamlined version of the approach described by William Robertson
+  et al in "Run-time Detection of Heap-based Overflows" LISA'03
+  http://www.usenix.org/events/lisa03/tech/robertson.html The footer
+  of an inuse chunk holds the xor of its mstate and a random seed,
+  that is checked upon calls to free() and realloc().  This is
+  (probablistically) unguessable from outside the program, but can be
+  computed by any code successfully malloc'ing any chunk, so does not
+  itself provide protection against code that has already broken
+  security through some other means.  Unlike Robertson et al, we
+  always dynamically check addresses of all offset chunks (previous,
+  next, etc). This turns out to be cheaper than relying on hashes.
+*/
+
+#if !INSECURE
+/* Check if address a is at least as high as any from MORECORE or MMAP */
+#define ok_address(M, a) ((char*)(a) >= (M)->least_addr)
+/* Check if address of next chunk n is higher than base chunk p */
+#define ok_next(p, n)    ((char*)(p) < (char*)(n))
+/* Check if p has its cinuse bit on */
+#define ok_cinuse(p)     cinuse(p)
+/* Check if p has its pinuse bit on */
+#define ok_pinuse(p)     pinuse(p)
+
+#else /* !INSECURE */
+#define ok_address(M, a) (1)
+#define ok_next(b, n)    (1)
+#define ok_cinuse(p)     (1)
+#define ok_pinuse(p)     (1)
+#endif /* !INSECURE */
+
+#if (FOOTERS && !INSECURE)
+/* Check if (alleged) mstate m has expected magic field */
+#define ok_magic(M)      ((M)->magic == mparams.magic)
+#else  /* (FOOTERS && !INSECURE) */
+#define ok_magic(M)      (1)
+#endif /* (FOOTERS && !INSECURE) */
+
+
+/* In gcc, use __builtin_expect to minimize impact of checks */
+#if !INSECURE
+#if defined(__GNUC__) && __GNUC__ >= 3
+#define RTCHECK(e)  __builtin_expect(e, 1)
+#else /* GNUC */
+#define RTCHECK(e)  (e)
+#endif /* GNUC */
+#else /* !INSECURE */
+#define RTCHECK(e)  (1)
+#endif /* !INSECURE */
+
+/* macros to set up inuse chunks with or without footers */
+
+#if !FOOTERS
+
+#define mark_inuse_foot(M,p,s)
+
+/* Set cinuse bit and pinuse bit of next chunk */
+#define set_inuse(M,p,s)\
+  ((p)->head = (((p)->head & PINUSE_BIT)|s|CINUSE_BIT),\
+  ((mchunkptr)(((char*)(p)) + (s)))->head |= PINUSE_BIT)
+
+/* Set cinuse and pinuse of this chunk and pinuse of next chunk */
+#define set_inuse_and_pinuse(M,p,s)\
+  ((p)->head = (s|PINUSE_BIT|CINUSE_BIT),\
+  ((mchunkptr)(((char*)(p)) + (s)))->head |= PINUSE_BIT)
+
+/* Set size, cinuse and pinuse bit of this chunk */
+#define set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(M, p, s)\
+  ((p)->head = (s|PINUSE_BIT|CINUSE_BIT))
+
+#else /* FOOTERS */
+
+/* Set foot of inuse chunk to be xor of mstate and seed */
+#define mark_inuse_foot(M,p,s)\
+  (((mchunkptr)((char*)(p) + (s)))->prev_foot = ((size_t)(M) ^ mparams.magic))
+
+#define get_mstate_for(p)\
+  ((mstate)(((mchunkptr)((char*)(p) +\
+    (chunksize(p))))->prev_foot ^ mparams.magic))
+
+#define set_inuse(M,p,s)\
+  ((p)->head = (((p)->head & PINUSE_BIT)|s|CINUSE_BIT),\
+  (((mchunkptr)(((char*)(p)) + (s)))->head |= PINUSE_BIT), \
+  mark_inuse_foot(M,p,s))
+
+#define set_inuse_and_pinuse(M,p,s)\
+  ((p)->head = (s|PINUSE_BIT|CINUSE_BIT),\
+  (((mchunkptr)(((char*)(p)) + (s)))->head |= PINUSE_BIT),\
+ mark_inuse_foot(M,p,s))
+
+#define set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(M, p, s)\
+  ((p)->head = (s|PINUSE_BIT|CINUSE_BIT),\
+  mark_inuse_foot(M, p, s))
+
+#endif /* !FOOTERS */
+
+/* ---------------------------- setting mparams -------------------------- */
+
+/* Initialize mparams */
+static int init_mparams(void) {
+  if (mparams.page_size == 0) {
+    size_t s;
+
+    mparams.mmap_threshold = DEFAULT_MMAP_THRESHOLD;
+    mparams.trim_threshold = DEFAULT_TRIM_THRESHOLD;
+#if MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS
+    mparams.default_mflags = USE_LOCK_BIT|USE_MMAP_BIT;
+#else  /* MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS */
+    mparams.default_mflags = USE_LOCK_BIT|USE_MMAP_BIT|USE_NONCONTIGUOUS_BIT;
+#endif /* MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS */
+
+#if (FOOTERS && !INSECURE)
+    {
+#if USE_DEV_RANDOM
+      int fd;
+      unsigned char buf[sizeof(size_t)];
+      /* Try to use /dev/urandom, else fall back on using time */
+      if ((fd = open("/dev/urandom", O_RDONLY)) >= 0 &&
+          read(fd, buf, sizeof(buf)) == sizeof(buf)) {
+        s = *((size_t *) buf);
+        close(fd);
+      }
+      else
+#endif /* USE_DEV_RANDOM */
+        s = (size_t)(time(0) ^ (size_t)0x55555555U);
+
+      s |= (size_t)8U;    /* ensure nonzero */
+      s &= ~(size_t)7U;   /* improve chances of fault for bad values */
+
+    }
+#else /* (FOOTERS && !INSECURE) */
+    s = (size_t)0x58585858U;
+#endif /* (FOOTERS && !INSECURE) */
+    ACQUIRE_MAGIC_INIT_LOCK();
+    if (mparams.magic == 0) {
+      mparams.magic = s;
+      /* Set up lock for main malloc area */
+      INITIAL_LOCK(&gm->mutex);
+      gm->mflags = mparams.default_mflags;
+    }
+    RELEASE_MAGIC_INIT_LOCK();
+
+#ifndef WIN32
+    mparams.page_size = malloc_getpagesize;
+    mparams.granularity = ((DEFAULT_GRANULARITY != 0)?
+                           DEFAULT_GRANULARITY : mparams.page_size);
+#else /* WIN32 */
+    {
+      SYSTEM_INFO system_info;
+      GetSystemInfo(&system_info);
+      mparams.page_size = system_info.dwPageSize;
+      mparams.granularity = system_info.dwAllocationGranularity;
+    }
+#endif /* WIN32 */
+
+    /* Sanity-check configuration:
+       size_t must be unsigned and as wide as pointer type.
+       ints must be at least 4 bytes.
+       alignment must be at least 8.
+       Alignment, min chunk size, and page size must all be powers of 2.
+    */
+    if ((sizeof(size_t) != sizeof(char*)) ||
+        (MAX_SIZE_T < MIN_CHUNK_SIZE)  ||
+        (sizeof(int) < 4)  ||
+        (MALLOC_ALIGNMENT < (size_t)8U) ||
+        ((MALLOC_ALIGNMENT    & (MALLOC_ALIGNMENT-SIZE_T_ONE))    != 0) ||
+        ((MCHUNK_SIZE         & (MCHUNK_SIZE-SIZE_T_ONE))         != 0) ||
+        ((mparams.granularity & (mparams.granularity-SIZE_T_ONE)) != 0) ||
+        ((mparams.page_size   & (mparams.page_size-SIZE_T_ONE))   != 0))
+      ABORT;
+  }
+  return 0;
+}
+
+/* support for mallopt */
+static int change_mparam(int param_number, int value) {
+  size_t val = (size_t)value;
+  init_mparams();
+  switch(param_number) {
+  case M_TRIM_THRESHOLD:
+    mparams.trim_threshold = val;
+    return 1;
+  case M_GRANULARITY:
+    if (val >= mparams.page_size && ((val & (val-1)) == 0)) {
+      mparams.granularity = val;
+      return 1;
+    }
+    else
+      return 0;
+  case M_MMAP_THRESHOLD:
+    mparams.mmap_threshold = val;
+    return 1;
+  default:
+    return 0;
+  }
+}
+
+#if DEBUG
+/* ------------------------- Debugging Support --------------------------- */
+
+/* Check properties of any chunk, whether free, inuse, mmapped etc  */
+static void do_check_any_chunk(mstate m, mchunkptr p) {
+  assert((is_aligned(chunk2mem(p))) || (p->head == FENCEPOST_HEAD));
+  assert(ok_address(m, p));
+}
+
+/* Check properties of top chunk */
+static void do_check_top_chunk(mstate m, mchunkptr p) {
+  msegmentptr sp = segment_holding(m, (char*)p);
+  size_t  sz = chunksize(p);
+  assert(sp != 0);
+  assert((is_aligned(chunk2mem(p))) || (p->head == FENCEPOST_HEAD));
+  assert(ok_address(m, p));
+  assert(sz == m->topsize);
+  assert(sz > 0);
+  assert(sz == ((sp->base + sp->size) - (char*)p) - TOP_FOOT_SIZE);
+  assert(pinuse(p));
+  assert(!next_pinuse(p));
+}
+
+/* Check properties of (inuse) mmapped chunks */
+static void do_check_mmapped_chunk(mstate m, mchunkptr p) {
+  size_t  sz = chunksize(p);
+  size_t len = (sz + (p->prev_foot & ~IS_MMAPPED_BIT) + MMAP_FOOT_PAD);
+  assert(is_mmapped(p));
+  assert(use_mmap(m));
+  assert((is_aligned(chunk2mem(p))) || (p->head == FENCEPOST_HEAD));
+  assert(ok_address(m, p));
+  assert(!is_small(sz));
+  assert((len & (mparams.page_size-SIZE_T_ONE)) == 0);
+  assert(chunk_plus_offset(p, sz)->head == FENCEPOST_HEAD);
+  assert(chunk_plus_offset(p, sz+SIZE_T_SIZE)->head == 0);
+}
+
+/* Check properties of inuse chunks */
+static void do_check_inuse_chunk(mstate m, mchunkptr p) {
+  do_check_any_chunk(m, p);
+  assert(cinuse(p));
+  assert(next_pinuse(p));
+  /* If not pinuse and not mmapped, previous chunk has OK offset */
+  assert(is_mmapped(p) || pinuse(p) || next_chunk(prev_chunk(p)) == p);
+  if (is_mmapped(p))
+    do_check_mmapped_chunk(m, p);
+}
+
+/* Check properties of free chunks */
+static void do_check_free_chunk(mstate m, mchunkptr p) {
+  size_t sz = p->head & ~(PINUSE_BIT|CINUSE_BIT);
+  mchunkptr next = chunk_plus_offset(p, sz);
+  do_check_any_chunk(m, p);
+  assert(!cinuse(p));
+  assert(!next_pinuse(p));
+  assert (!is_mmapped(p));
+  if (p != m->dv && p != m->top) {
+    if (sz >= MIN_CHUNK_SIZE) {
+      assert((sz & CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK) == 0);
+      assert(is_aligned(chunk2mem(p)));
+      assert(next->prev_foot == sz);
+      assert(pinuse(p));
+      assert (next == m->top || cinuse(next));
+      assert(p->fd->bk == p);
+      assert(p->bk->fd == p);
+    }
+    else  /* markers are always of size SIZE_T_SIZE */
+      assert(sz == SIZE_T_SIZE);
+  }
+}
+
+/* Check properties of malloced chunks at the point they are malloced */
+static void do_check_malloced_chunk(mstate m, void* mem, size_t s) {
+  if (mem != 0) {
+    mchunkptr p = mem2chunk(mem);
+    size_t sz = p->head & ~(PINUSE_BIT|CINUSE_BIT);
+    do_check_inuse_chunk(m, p);
+    assert((sz & CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK) == 0);
+    assert(sz >= MIN_CHUNK_SIZE);
+    assert(sz >= s);
+    /* unless mmapped, size is less than MIN_CHUNK_SIZE more than request */
+    assert(is_mmapped(p) || sz < (s + MIN_CHUNK_SIZE));
+  }
+}
+
+/* Check a tree and its subtrees.  */
+static void do_check_tree(mstate m, tchunkptr t) {
+  tchunkptr head = 0;
+  tchunkptr u = t;
+  bindex_t tindex = t->index;
+  size_t tsize = chunksize(t);
+  bindex_t idx;
+  compute_tree_index(tsize, idx);
+  assert(tindex == idx);
+  assert(tsize >= MIN_LARGE_SIZE);
+  assert(tsize >= minsize_for_tree_index(idx));
+  assert((idx == NTREEBINS-1) || (tsize < minsize_for_tree_index((idx+1))));
+
+  do { /* traverse through chain of same-sized nodes */
+    do_check_any_chunk(m, ((mchunkptr)u));
+    assert(u->index == tindex);
+    assert(chunksize(u) == tsize);
+    assert(!cinuse(u));
+    assert(!next_pinuse(u));
+    assert(u->fd->bk == u);
+    assert(u->bk->fd == u);
+    if (u->parent == 0) {
+      assert(u->child[0] == 0);
+      assert(u->child[1] == 0);
+    }
+    else {
+      assert(head == 0); /* only one node on chain has parent */
+      head = u;
+      assert(u->parent != u);
+      assert (u->parent->child[0] == u ||
+              u->parent->child[1] == u ||
+              *((tbinptr*)(u->parent)) == u);
+      if (u->child[0] != 0) {
+        assert(u->child[0]->parent == u);
+        assert(u->child[0] != u);
+        do_check_tree(m, u->child[0]);
+      }
+      if (u->child[1] != 0) {
+        assert(u->child[1]->parent == u);
+        assert(u->child[1] != u);
+        do_check_tree(m, u->child[1]);
+      }
+      if (u->child[0] != 0 && u->child[1] != 0) {
+        assert(chunksize(u->child[0]) < chunksize(u->child[1]));
+      }
+    }
+    u = u->fd;
+  } while (u != t);
+  assert(head != 0);
+}
+
+/*  Check all the chunks in a treebin.  */
+static void do_check_treebin(mstate m, bindex_t i) {
+  tbinptr* tb = treebin_at(m, i);
+  tchunkptr t = *tb;
+  int empty = (m->treemap & (1U << i)) == 0;
+  if (t == 0)
+    assert(empty);
+  if (!empty)
+    do_check_tree(m, t);
+}
+
+/*  Check all the chunks in a smallbin.  */
+static void do_check_smallbin(mstate m, bindex_t i) {
+  sbinptr b = smallbin_at(m, i);
+  mchunkptr p = b->bk;
+  unsigned int empty = (m->smallmap & (1U << i)) == 0;
+  if (p == b)
+    assert(empty);
+  if (!empty) {
+    for (; p != b; p = p->bk) {
+      size_t size = chunksize(p);
+      mchunkptr q;
+      /* each chunk claims to be free */
+      do_check_free_chunk(m, p);
+      /* chunk belongs in bin */
+      assert(small_index(size) == i);
+      assert(p->bk == b || chunksize(p->bk) == chunksize(p));
+      /* chunk is followed by an inuse chunk */
+      q = next_chunk(p);
+      if (q->head != FENCEPOST_HEAD)
+        do_check_inuse_chunk(m, q);
+    }
+  }
+}
+
+/* Find x in a bin. Used in other check functions. */
+static int bin_find(mstate m, mchunkptr x) {
+  size_t size = chunksize(x);
+  if (is_small(size)) {
+    bindex_t sidx = small_index(size);
+    sbinptr b = smallbin_at(m, sidx);
+    if (smallmap_is_marked(m, sidx)) {
+      mchunkptr p = b;
+      do {
+        if (p == x)
+          return 1;
+      } while ((p = p->fd) != b);
+    }
+  }
+  else {
+    bindex_t tidx;
+    compute_tree_index(size, tidx);
+    if (treemap_is_marked(m, tidx)) {
+      tchunkptr t = *treebin_at(m, tidx);
+      size_t sizebits = size << leftshift_for_tree_index(tidx);
+      while (t != 0 && chunksize(t) != size) {
+        t = t->child[(sizebits >> (SIZE_T_BITSIZE-SIZE_T_ONE)) & 1];
+        sizebits <<= 1;
+      }
+      if (t != 0) {
+        tchunkptr u = t;
+        do {
+          if (u == (tchunkptr)x)
+            return 1;
+        } while ((u = u->fd) != t);
+      }
+    }
+  }
+  return 0;
+}
+
+/* Traverse each chunk and check it; return total */
+static size_t traverse_and_check(mstate m) {
+  size_t sum = 0;
+  if (is_initialized(m)) {
+    msegmentptr s = &m->seg;
+    sum += m->topsize + TOP_FOOT_SIZE;
+    while (s != 0) {
+      mchunkptr q = align_as_chunk(s->base);
+      mchunkptr lastq = 0;
+      assert(pinuse(q));
+      while (segment_holds(s, q) &&
+             q != m->top && q->head != FENCEPOST_HEAD) {
+        sum += chunksize(q);
+        if (cinuse(q)) {
+          assert(!bin_find(m, q));
+          do_check_inuse_chunk(m, q);
+        }
+        else {
+          assert(q == m->dv || bin_find(m, q));
+          assert(lastq == 0 || cinuse(lastq)); /* Not 2 consecutive free */
+          do_check_free_chunk(m, q);
+        }
+        lastq = q;
+        q = next_chunk(q);
+      }
+      s = s->next;
+    }
+  }
+  return sum;
+}
+
+/* Check all properties of malloc_state. */
+static void do_check_malloc_state(mstate m) {
+  bindex_t i;
+  size_t total;
+  /* check bins */
+  for (i = 0; i < NSMALLBINS; ++i)
+    do_check_smallbin(m, i);
+  for (i = 0; i < NTREEBINS; ++i)
+    do_check_treebin(m, i);
+
+  if (m->dvsize != 0) { /* check dv chunk */
+    do_check_any_chunk(m, m->dv);
+    assert(m->dvsize == chunksize(m->dv));
+    assert(m->dvsize >= MIN_CHUNK_SIZE);
+    assert(bin_find(m, m->dv) == 0);
+  }
+
+  if (m->top != 0) {   /* check top chunk */
+    do_check_top_chunk(m, m->top);
+    assert(m->topsize == chunksize(m->top));
+    assert(m->topsize > 0);
+    assert(bin_find(m, m->top) == 0);
+  }
+
+  total = traverse_and_check(m);
+  assert(total <= m->footprint);
+  assert(m->footprint <= m->max_footprint);
+}
+#endif /* DEBUG */
+
+/* ----------------------------- statistics ------------------------------ */
+
+#if !NO_MALLINFO
+static struct mallinfo internal_mallinfo(mstate m) {
+  struct mallinfo nm = { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 };
+  if (!PREACTION(m)) {
+    check_malloc_state(m);
+    if (is_initialized(m)) {
+      size_t nfree = SIZE_T_ONE; /* top always free */
+      size_t mfree = m->topsize + TOP_FOOT_SIZE;
+      size_t sum = mfree;
+      msegmentptr s = &m->seg;
+      while (s != 0) {
+        mchunkptr q = align_as_chunk(s->base);
+        while (segment_holds(s, q) &&
+               q != m->top && q->head != FENCEPOST_HEAD) {
+          size_t sz = chunksize(q);
+          sum += sz;
+          if (!cinuse(q)) {
+            mfree += sz;
+            ++nfree;
+          }
+          q = next_chunk(q);
+        }
+        s = s->next;
+      }
+
+      nm.arena    = sum;
+      nm.ordblks  = nfree;
+      nm.hblkhd   = m->footprint - sum;
+      nm.usmblks  = m->max_footprint;
+      nm.uordblks = m->footprint - mfree;
+      nm.fordblks = mfree;
+      nm.keepcost = m->topsize;
+    }
+
+    POSTACTION(m);
+  }
+  return nm;
+}
+#endif /* !NO_MALLINFO */
+
+static void internal_malloc_stats(mstate m) {
+  if (!PREACTION(m)) {
+    size_t maxfp = 0;
+    size_t fp = 0;
+    size_t used = 0;
+    check_malloc_state(m);
+    if (is_initialized(m)) {
+      msegmentptr s = &m->seg;
+      maxfp = m->max_footprint;
+      fp = m->footprint;
+      used = fp - (m->topsize + TOP_FOOT_SIZE);
+
+      while (s != 0) {
+        mchunkptr q = align_as_chunk(s->base);
+        while (segment_holds(s, q) &&
+               q != m->top && q->head != FENCEPOST_HEAD) {
+          if (!cinuse(q))
+            used -= chunksize(q);
+          q = next_chunk(q);
+        }
+        s = s->next;
+      }
+    }
+
+#ifndef LACKS_STDIO_H
+    fprintf(stderr, "max system bytes = %10lu\n", (unsigned long)(maxfp));
+    fprintf(stderr, "system bytes     = %10lu\n", (unsigned long)(fp));
+    fprintf(stderr, "in use bytes     = %10lu\n", (unsigned long)(used));
+#endif
+
+    POSTACTION(m);
+  }
+}
+
+/* ----------------------- Operations on smallbins ----------------------- */
+
+/*
+  Various forms of linking and unlinking are defined as macros.  Even
+  the ones for trees, which are very long but have very short typical
+  paths.  This is ugly but reduces reliance on inlining support of
+  compilers.
+*/
+
+/* Link a free chunk into a smallbin  */
+#define insert_small_chunk(M, P, S) {\
+  bindex_t I  = small_index(S);\
+  mchunkptr B = smallbin_at(M, I);\
+  mchunkptr F = B;\
+  assert(S >= MIN_CHUNK_SIZE);\
+  if (!smallmap_is_marked(M, I))\
+    mark_smallmap(M, I);\
+  else if (RTCHECK(ok_address(M, B->fd)))\
+    F = B->fd;\
+  else {\
+    CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+  }\
+  B->fd = P;\
+  F->bk = P;\
+  P->fd = F;\
+  P->bk = B;\
+}
+
+/* Unlink a chunk from a smallbin  */
+#define unlink_small_chunk(M, P, S) {\
+  mchunkptr F = P->fd;\
+  mchunkptr B = P->bk;\
+  bindex_t I = small_index(S);\
+  assert(P != B);\
+  assert(P != F);\
+  assert(chunksize(P) == small_index2size(I));\
+  if (F == B)\
+    clear_smallmap(M, I);\
+  else if (RTCHECK((F == smallbin_at(M,I) || ok_address(M, F)) &&\
+                   (B == smallbin_at(M,I) || ok_address(M, B)))) {\
+    F->bk = B;\
+    B->fd = F;\
+  }\
+  else {\
+    CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+  }\
+}
+
+/* Unlink the first chunk from a smallbin */
+#define unlink_first_small_chunk(M, B, P, I) {\
+  mchunkptr F = P->fd;\
+  assert(P != B);\
+  assert(P != F);\
+  assert(chunksize(P) == small_index2size(I));\
+  if (B == F)\
+    clear_smallmap(M, I);\
+  else if (RTCHECK(ok_address(M, F))) {\
+    B->fd = F;\
+    F->bk = B;\
+  }\
+  else {\
+    CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+  }\
+}
+
+/* Replace dv node, binning the old one */
+/* Used only when dvsize known to be small */
+#define replace_dv(M, P, S) {\
+  size_t DVS = M->dvsize;\
+  if (DVS != 0) {\
+    mchunkptr DV = M->dv;\
+    assert(is_small(DVS));\
+    insert_small_chunk(M, DV, DVS);\
+  }\
+  M->dvsize = S;\
+  M->dv = P;\
+}
+
+/* ------------------------- Operations on trees ------------------------- */
+
+/* Insert chunk into tree */
+#define insert_large_chunk(M, X, S) {\
+  tbinptr* H;\
+  bindex_t I;\
+  compute_tree_index(S, I);\
+  H = treebin_at(M, I);\
+  X->index = I;\
+  X->child[0] = X->child[1] = 0;\
+  if (!treemap_is_marked(M, I)) {\
+    mark_treemap(M, I);\
+    *H = X;\
+    X->parent = (tchunkptr)H;\
+    X->fd = X->bk = X;\
+  }\
+  else {\
+    tchunkptr T = *H;\
+    size_t K = S << leftshift_for_tree_index(I);\
+    for (;;) {\
+      if (chunksize(T) != S) {\
+        tchunkptr* C = &(T->child[(K >> (SIZE_T_BITSIZE-SIZE_T_ONE)) & 1]);\
+        K <<= 1;\
+        if (*C != 0)\
+          T = *C;\
+        else if (RTCHECK(ok_address(M, C))) {\
+          *C = X;\
+          X->parent = T;\
+          X->fd = X->bk = X;\
+          break;\
+        }\
+        else {\
+          CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+          break;\
+        }\
+      }\
+      else {\
+        tchunkptr F = T->fd;\
+        if (RTCHECK(ok_address(M, T) && ok_address(M, F))) {\
+          T->fd = F->bk = X;\
+          X->fd = F;\
+          X->bk = T;\
+          X->parent = 0;\
+          break;\
+        }\
+        else {\
+          CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+          break;\
+        }\
+      }\
+    }\
+  }\
+}
+
+/*
+  Unlink steps:
+
+  1. If x is a chained node, unlink it from its same-sized fd/bk links
+     and choose its bk node as its replacement.
+  2. If x was the last node of its size, but not a leaf node, it must
+     be replaced with a leaf node (not merely one with an open left or
+     right), to make sure that lefts and rights of descendents
+     correspond properly to bit masks.  We use the rightmost descendent
+     of x.  We could use any other leaf, but this is easy to locate and
+     tends to counteract removal of leftmosts elsewhere, and so keeps
+     paths shorter than minimally guaranteed.  This doesn't loop much
+     because on average a node in a tree is near the bottom.
+  3. If x is the base of a chain (i.e., has parent links) relink
+     x's parent and children to x's replacement (or null if none).
+*/
+
+#define unlink_large_chunk(M, X) {\
+  tchunkptr XP = X->parent;\
+  tchunkptr R;\
+  if (X->bk != X) {\
+    tchunkptr F = X->fd;\
+    R = X->bk;\
+    if (RTCHECK(ok_address(M, F))) {\
+      F->bk = R;\
+      R->fd = F;\
+    }\
+    else {\
+      CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+    }\
+  }\
+  else {\
+    tchunkptr* RP;\
+    if (((R = *(RP = &(X->child[1]))) != 0) ||\
+        ((R = *(RP = &(X->child[0]))) != 0)) {\
+      tchunkptr* CP;\
+      while ((*(CP = &(R->child[1])) != 0) ||\
+             (*(CP = &(R->child[0])) != 0)) {\
+        R = *(RP = CP);\
+      }\
+      if (RTCHECK(ok_address(M, RP)))\
+        *RP = 0;\
+      else {\
+        CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+      }\
+    }\
+  }\
+  if (XP != 0) {\
+    tbinptr* H = treebin_at(M, X->index);\
+    if (X == *H) {\
+      if ((*H = R) == 0) \
+        clear_treemap(M, X->index);\
+    }\
+    else if (RTCHECK(ok_address(M, XP))) {\
+      if (XP->child[0] == X) \
+        XP->child[0] = R;\
+      else \
+        XP->child[1] = R;\
+    }\
+    else\
+      CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+    if (R != 0) {\
+      if (RTCHECK(ok_address(M, R))) {\
+        tchunkptr C0, C1;\
+        R->parent = XP;\
+        if ((C0 = X->child[0]) != 0) {\
+          if (RTCHECK(ok_address(M, C0))) {\
+            R->child[0] = C0;\
+            C0->parent = R;\
+          }\
+          else\
+            CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+        }\
+        if ((C1 = X->child[1]) != 0) {\
+          if (RTCHECK(ok_address(M, C1))) {\
+            R->child[1] = C1;\
+            C1->parent = R;\
+          }\
+          else\
+            CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+        }\
+      }\
+      else\
+        CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(M);\
+    }\
+  }\
+}
+
+/* Relays to large vs small bin operations */
+
+#define insert_chunk(M, P, S)\
+  if (is_small(S)) insert_small_chunk(M, P, S)\
+  else { tchunkptr TP = (tchunkptr)(P); insert_large_chunk(M, TP, S); }
+
+#define unlink_chunk(M, P, S)\
+  if (is_small(S)) unlink_small_chunk(M, P, S)\
+  else { tchunkptr TP = (tchunkptr)(P); unlink_large_chunk(M, TP); }
+
+
+/* Relays to internal calls to malloc/free from realloc, memalign etc */
+
+#if ONLY_MSPACES
+#define internal_malloc(m, b) mspace_malloc(m, b)
+#define internal_free(m, mem) mspace_free(m,mem);
+#else /* ONLY_MSPACES */
+#if MSPACES
+#define internal_malloc(m, b)\
+   (m == gm)? dlmalloc(b) : mspace_malloc(m, b)
+#define internal_free(m, mem)\
+   if (m == gm) dlfree(mem); else mspace_free(m,mem);
+#else /* MSPACES */
+#define internal_malloc(m, b) dlmalloc(b)
+#define internal_free(m, mem) dlfree(mem)
+#endif /* MSPACES */
+#endif /* ONLY_MSPACES */
+
+/* -----------------------  Direct-mmapping chunks ----------------------- */
+
+/*
+  Directly mmapped chunks are set up with an offset to the start of
+  the mmapped region stored in the prev_foot field of the chunk. This
+  allows reconstruction of the required argument to MUNMAP when freed,
+  and also allows adjustment of the returned chunk to meet alignment
+  requirements (especially in memalign).  There is also enough space
+  allocated to hold a fake next chunk of size SIZE_T_SIZE to maintain
+  the PINUSE bit so frees can be checked.
+*/
+
+/* Malloc using mmap */
+static void* mmap_alloc(mstate m, size_t nb) {
+  size_t mmsize = granularity_align(nb + SIX_SIZE_T_SIZES + CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK);
+  if (mmsize > nb) {     /* Check for wrap around 0 */
+    char* mm = (char*)(DIRECT_MMAP(mmsize));
+    if (mm != CMFAIL) {
+      size_t offset = align_offset(chunk2mem(mm));
+      size_t psize = mmsize - offset - MMAP_FOOT_PAD;
+      mchunkptr p = (mchunkptr)(mm + offset);
+      p->prev_foot = offset | IS_MMAPPED_BIT;
+      (p)->head = (psize|CINUSE_BIT);
+      mark_inuse_foot(m, p, psize);
+      chunk_plus_offset(p, psize)->head = FENCEPOST_HEAD;
+      chunk_plus_offset(p, psize+SIZE_T_SIZE)->head = 0;
+
+      if (mm < m->least_addr)
+        m->least_addr = mm;
+      if ((m->footprint += mmsize) > m->max_footprint)
+        m->max_footprint = m->footprint;
+      assert(is_aligned(chunk2mem(p)));
+      check_mmapped_chunk(m, p);
+      return chunk2mem(p);
+    }
+  }
+  return 0;
+}
+
+/* Realloc using mmap */
+static mchunkptr mmap_resize(mstate m, mchunkptr oldp, size_t nb) {
+  size_t oldsize = chunksize(oldp);
+  if (is_small(nb)) /* Can't shrink mmap regions below small size */
+    return 0;
+  /* Keep old chunk if big enough but not too big */
+  if (oldsize >= nb + SIZE_T_SIZE &&
+      (oldsize - nb) <= (mparams.granularity << 1))
+    return oldp;
+  else {
+    size_t offset = oldp->prev_foot & ~IS_MMAPPED_BIT;
+    size_t oldmmsize = oldsize + offset + MMAP_FOOT_PAD;
+    size_t newmmsize = granularity_align(nb + SIX_SIZE_T_SIZES +
+                                         CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK);
+    char* cp = (char*)CALL_MREMAP((char*)oldp - offset,
+                                  oldmmsize, newmmsize, 1);
+    if (cp != CMFAIL) {
+      mchunkptr newp = (mchunkptr)(cp + offset);
+      size_t psize = newmmsize - offset - MMAP_FOOT_PAD;
+      newp->head = (psize|CINUSE_BIT);
+      mark_inuse_foot(m, newp, psize);
+      chunk_plus_offset(newp, psize)->head = FENCEPOST_HEAD;
+      chunk_plus_offset(newp, psize+SIZE_T_SIZE)->head = 0;
+
+      if (cp < m->least_addr)
+        m->least_addr = cp;
+      if ((m->footprint += newmmsize - oldmmsize) > m->max_footprint)
+        m->max_footprint = m->footprint;
+      check_mmapped_chunk(m, newp);
+      return newp;
+    }
+  }
+  return 0;
+}
+
+/* -------------------------- mspace management -------------------------- */
+
+/* Initialize top chunk and its size */
+static void init_top(mstate m, mchunkptr p, size_t psize) {
+  /* Ensure alignment */
+  size_t offset = align_offset(chunk2mem(p));
+  p = (mchunkptr)((char*)p + offset);
+  psize -= offset;
+
+  m->top = p;
+  m->topsize = psize;
+  p->head = psize | PINUSE_BIT;
+  /* set size of fake trailing chunk holding overhead space only once */
+  chunk_plus_offset(p, psize)->head = TOP_FOOT_SIZE;
+  m->trim_check = mparams.trim_threshold; /* reset on each update */
+}
+
+/* Initialize bins for a new mstate that is otherwise zeroed out */
+static void init_bins(mstate m) {
+  /* Establish circular links for smallbins */
+  bindex_t i;
+  for (i = 0; i < NSMALLBINS; ++i) {
+    sbinptr bin = smallbin_at(m,i);
+    bin->fd = bin->bk = bin;
+  }
+}
+
+#if PROCEED_ON_ERROR
+
+/* default corruption action */
+static void reset_on_error(mstate m) {
+  int i;
+  ++malloc_corruption_error_count;
+  /* Reinitialize fields to forget about all memory */
+  m->smallbins = m->treebins = 0;
+  m->dvsize = m->topsize = 0;
+  m->seg.base = 0;
+  m->seg.size = 0;
+  m->seg.next = 0;
+  m->top = m->dv = 0;
+  for (i = 0; i < NTREEBINS; ++i)
+    *treebin_at(m, i) = 0;
+  init_bins(m);
+}
+#endif /* PROCEED_ON_ERROR */
+
+/* Allocate chunk and prepend remainder with chunk in successor base. */
+static void* prepend_alloc(mstate m, char* newbase, char* oldbase,
+                           size_t nb) {
+  mchunkptr p = align_as_chunk(newbase);
+  mchunkptr oldfirst = align_as_chunk(oldbase);
+  size_t psize = (char*)oldfirst - (char*)p;
+  mchunkptr q = chunk_plus_offset(p, nb);
+  size_t qsize = psize - nb;
+  set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(m, p, nb);
+
+  assert((char*)oldfirst > (char*)q);
+  assert(pinuse(oldfirst));
+  assert(qsize >= MIN_CHUNK_SIZE);
+
+  /* consolidate remainder with first chunk of old base */
+  if (oldfirst == m->top) {
+    size_t tsize = m->topsize += qsize;
+    m->top = q;
+    q->head = tsize | PINUSE_BIT;
+    check_top_chunk(m, q);
+  }
+  else if (oldfirst == m->dv) {
+    size_t dsize = m->dvsize += qsize;
+    m->dv = q;
+    set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(q, dsize);
+  }
+  else {
+    if (!cinuse(oldfirst)) {
+      size_t nsize = chunksize(oldfirst);
+      unlink_chunk(m, oldfirst, nsize);
+      oldfirst = chunk_plus_offset(oldfirst, nsize);
+      qsize += nsize;
+    }
+    set_free_with_pinuse(q, qsize, oldfirst);
+    insert_chunk(m, q, qsize);
+    check_free_chunk(m, q);
+  }
+
+  check_malloced_chunk(m, chunk2mem(p), nb);
+  return chunk2mem(p);
+}
+
+
+/* Add a segment to hold a new noncontiguous region */
+static void add_segment(mstate m, char* tbase, size_t tsize, flag_t mmapped) {
+  /* Determine locations and sizes of segment, fenceposts, old top */
+  char* old_top = (char*)m->top;
+  msegmentptr oldsp = segment_holding(m, old_top);
+  char* old_end = oldsp->base + oldsp->size;
+  size_t ssize = pad_request(sizeof(struct malloc_segment));
+  char* rawsp = old_end - (ssize + FOUR_SIZE_T_SIZES + CHUNK_ALIGN_MASK);
+  size_t offset = align_offset(chunk2mem(rawsp));
+  char* asp = rawsp + offset;
+  char* csp = (asp < (old_top + MIN_CHUNK_SIZE))? old_top : asp;
+  mchunkptr sp = (mchunkptr)csp;
+  msegmentptr ss = (msegmentptr)(chunk2mem(sp));
+  mchunkptr tnext = chunk_plus_offset(sp, ssize);
+  mchunkptr p = tnext;
+  int nfences = 0;
+
+  /* reset top to new space */
+  init_top(m, (mchunkptr)tbase, tsize - TOP_FOOT_SIZE);
+
+  /* Set up segment record */
+  assert(is_aligned(ss));
+  set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(m, sp, ssize);
+  *ss = m->seg; /* Push current record */
+  m->seg.base = tbase;
+  m->seg.size = tsize;
+  m->seg.sflags = mmapped;
+  m->seg.next = ss;
+
+  /* Insert trailing fenceposts */
+  for (;;) {
+    mchunkptr nextp = chunk_plus_offset(p, SIZE_T_SIZE);
+    p->head = FENCEPOST_HEAD;
+    ++nfences;
+    if ((char*)(&(nextp->head)) < old_end)
+      p = nextp;
+    else
+      break;
+  }
+  assert(nfences >= 2);
+
+  /* Insert the rest of old top into a bin as an ordinary free chunk */
+  if (csp != old_top) {
+    mchunkptr q = (mchunkptr)old_top;
+    size_t psize = csp - old_top;
+    mchunkptr tn = chunk_plus_offset(q, psize);
+    set_free_with_pinuse(q, psize, tn);
+    insert_chunk(m, q, psize);
+  }
+
+  check_top_chunk(m, m->top);
+}
+
+/* -------------------------- System allocation -------------------------- */
+
+/* Get memory from system using MORECORE or MMAP */
+static void* sys_alloc(mstate m, size_t nb) {
+  char* tbase = CMFAIL;
+  size_t tsize = 0;
+  flag_t mmap_flag = 0;
+
+  init_mparams();
+
+  /* Directly map large chunks */
+  if (use_mmap(m) && nb >= mparams.mmap_threshold) {
+    void* mem = mmap_alloc(m, nb);
+    if (mem != 0)
+      return mem;
+  }
+
+  /*
+    Try getting memory in any of three ways (in most-preferred to
+    least-preferred order):
+    1. A call to MORECORE that can normally contiguously extend memory.
+       (disabled if not MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS or not HAVE_MORECORE or
+       or main space is mmapped or a previous contiguous call failed)
+    2. A call to MMAP new space (disabled if not HAVE_MMAP).
+       Note that under the default settings, if MORECORE is unable to
+       fulfill a request, and HAVE_MMAP is true, then mmap is
+       used as a noncontiguous system allocator. This is a useful backup
+       strategy for systems with holes in address spaces -- in this case
+       sbrk cannot contiguously expand the heap, but mmap may be able to
+       find space.
+    3. A call to MORECORE that cannot usually contiguously extend memory.
+       (disabled if not HAVE_MORECORE)
+  */
+
+  if (MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS && !use_noncontiguous(m)) {
+    char* br = CMFAIL;
+    msegmentptr ss = (m->top == 0)? 0 : segment_holding(m, (char*)m->top);
+    size_t asize = 0;
+    ACQUIRE_MORECORE_LOCK();
+
+    if (ss == 0) {  /* First time through or recovery */
+      char* base = (char*)CALL_MORECORE(0);
+      if (base != CMFAIL) {
+        asize = granularity_align(nb + TOP_FOOT_SIZE + SIZE_T_ONE);
+        /* Adjust to end on a page boundary */
+        if (!is_page_aligned(base))
+          asize += (page_align((size_t)base) - (size_t)base);
+        /* Can't call MORECORE if size is negative when treated as signed */
+        if (asize < HALF_MAX_SIZE_T &&
+            (br = (char*)(CALL_MORECORE(asize))) == base) {
+          tbase = base;
+          tsize = asize;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    else {
+      /* Subtract out existing available top space from MORECORE request. */
+      asize = granularity_align(nb - m->topsize + TOP_FOOT_SIZE + SIZE_T_ONE);
+      /* Use mem here only if it did continuously extend old space */
+      if (asize < HALF_MAX_SIZE_T &&
+          (br = (char*)(CALL_MORECORE(asize))) == ss->base+ss->size) {
+        tbase = br;
+        tsize = asize;
+      }
+    }
+
+    if (tbase == CMFAIL) {    /* Cope with partial failure */
+      if (br != CMFAIL) {    /* Try to use/extend the space we did get */
+        if (asize < HALF_MAX_SIZE_T &&
+            asize < nb + TOP_FOOT_SIZE + SIZE_T_ONE) {
+          size_t esize = granularity_align(nb + TOP_FOOT_SIZE + SIZE_T_ONE - asize);
+          if (esize < HALF_MAX_SIZE_T) {
+            char* end = (char*)CALL_MORECORE(esize);
+            if (end != CMFAIL)
+              asize += esize;
+            else {            /* Can't use; try to release */
+              end = (char*)CALL_MORECORE(-asize);
+              br = CMFAIL;
+            }
+          }
+        }
+      }
+      if (br != CMFAIL) {    /* Use the space we did get */
+        tbase = br;
+        tsize = asize;
+      }
+      else
+        disable_contiguous(m); /* Don't try contiguous path in the future */
+    }
+
+    RELEASE_MORECORE_LOCK();
+  }
+
+  if (HAVE_MMAP && tbase == CMFAIL) {  /* Try MMAP */
+    size_t req = nb + TOP_FOOT_SIZE + SIZE_T_ONE;
+    size_t rsize = granularity_align(req);
+    if (rsize > nb) { /* Fail if wraps around zero */
+      char* mp = (char*)(CALL_MMAP(rsize));
+      if (mp != CMFAIL) {
+        tbase = mp;
+        tsize = rsize;
+        mmap_flag = IS_MMAPPED_BIT;
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  if (HAVE_MORECORE && tbase == CMFAIL) { /* Try noncontiguous MORECORE */
+    size_t asize = granularity_align(nb + TOP_FOOT_SIZE + SIZE_T_ONE);
+    if (asize < HALF_MAX_SIZE_T) {
+      char* br = CMFAIL;
+      char* end = CMFAIL;
+      ACQUIRE_MORECORE_LOCK();
+      br = (char*)(CALL_MORECORE(asize));
+      end = (char*)(CALL_MORECORE(0));
+      RELEASE_MORECORE_LOCK();
+      if (br != CMFAIL && end != CMFAIL && br < end) {
+        size_t ssize = end - br;
+        if (ssize > nb + TOP_FOOT_SIZE) {
+          tbase = br;
+          tsize = ssize;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+  }
+
+  if (tbase != CMFAIL) {
+
+    if ((m->footprint += tsize) > m->max_footprint)
+      m->max_footprint = m->footprint;
+
+    if (!is_initialized(m)) { /* first-time initialization */
+      m->seg.base = m->least_addr = tbase;
+      m->seg.size = tsize;
+      m->seg.sflags = mmap_flag;
+      m->magic = mparams.magic;
+      init_bins(m);
+      if (is_global(m)) 
+        init_top(m, (mchunkptr)tbase, tsize - TOP_FOOT_SIZE);
+      else {
+        /* Offset top by embedded malloc_state */
+        mchunkptr mn = next_chunk(mem2chunk(m));
+        init_top(m, mn, (size_t)((tbase + tsize) - (char*)mn) -TOP_FOOT_SIZE);
+      }
+    }
+
+    else {
+      /* Try to merge with an existing segment */
+      msegmentptr sp = &m->seg;
+      while (sp != 0 && tbase != sp->base + sp->size)
+        sp = sp->next;
+      if (sp != 0 &&
+          !is_extern_segment(sp) &&
+          (sp->sflags & IS_MMAPPED_BIT) == mmap_flag &&
+          segment_holds(sp, m->top)) { /* append */
+        sp->size += tsize;
+        init_top(m, m->top, m->topsize + tsize);
+      }
+      else {
+        if (tbase < m->least_addr)
+          m->least_addr = tbase;
+        sp = &m->seg;
+        while (sp != 0 && sp->base != tbase + tsize)
+          sp = sp->next;
+        if (sp != 0 &&
+            !is_extern_segment(sp) &&
+            (sp->sflags & IS_MMAPPED_BIT) == mmap_flag) {
+          char* oldbase = sp->base;
+          sp->base = tbase;
+          sp->size += tsize;
+          return prepend_alloc(m, tbase, oldbase, nb);
+        }
+        else
+          add_segment(m, tbase, tsize, mmap_flag);
+      }
+    }
+
+    if (nb < m->topsize) { /* Allocate from new or extended top space */
+      size_t rsize = m->topsize -= nb;
+      mchunkptr p = m->top;
+      mchunkptr r = m->top = chunk_plus_offset(p, nb);
+      r->head = rsize | PINUSE_BIT;
+      set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(m, p, nb);
+      check_top_chunk(m, m->top);
+      check_malloced_chunk(m, chunk2mem(p), nb);
+      return chunk2mem(p);
+    }
+  }
+
+  MALLOC_FAILURE_ACTION;
+  return 0;
+}
+
+/* -----------------------  system deallocation -------------------------- */
+
+/* Unmap and unlink any mmapped segments that don't contain used chunks */
+static size_t release_unused_segments(mstate m) {
+  size_t released = 0;
+  msegmentptr pred = &m->seg;
+  msegmentptr sp = pred->next;
+  while (sp != 0) {
+    char* base = sp->base;
+    size_t size = sp->size;
+    msegmentptr next = sp->next;
+    if (is_mmapped_segment(sp) && !is_extern_segment(sp)) {
+      mchunkptr p = align_as_chunk(base);
+      size_t psize = chunksize(p);
+      /* Can unmap if first chunk holds entire segment and not pinned */
+      if (!cinuse(p) && (char*)p + psize >= base + size - TOP_FOOT_SIZE) {
+        tchunkptr tp = (tchunkptr)p;
+        assert(segment_holds(sp, (char*)sp));
+        if (p == m->dv) {
+          m->dv = 0;
+          m->dvsize = 0;
+        }
+        else {
+          unlink_large_chunk(m, tp);
+        }
+        if (CALL_MUNMAP(base, size) == 0) {
+          released += size;
+          m->footprint -= size;
+          /* unlink obsoleted record */
+          sp = pred;
+          sp->next = next;
+        }
+        else { /* back out if cannot unmap */
+          insert_large_chunk(m, tp, psize);
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    pred = sp;
+    sp = next;
+  }
+  return released;
+}
+
+static int sys_trim(mstate m, size_t pad) {
+  size_t released = 0;
+  if (pad < MAX_REQUEST && is_initialized(m)) {
+    pad += TOP_FOOT_SIZE; /* ensure enough room for segment overhead */
+
+    if (m->topsize > pad) {
+      /* Shrink top space in granularity-size units, keeping at least one */
+      size_t unit = mparams.granularity;
+      size_t extra = ((m->topsize - pad + (unit - SIZE_T_ONE)) / unit -
+                      SIZE_T_ONE) * unit;
+      msegmentptr sp = segment_holding(m, (char*)m->top);
+
+      if (!is_extern_segment(sp)) {
+        if (is_mmapped_segment(sp)) {
+          if (HAVE_MMAP &&
+              sp->size >= extra &&
+              !has_segment_link(m, sp)) { /* can't shrink if pinned */
+            size_t newsize = sp->size - extra;
+            /* Prefer mremap, fall back to munmap */
+            if ((CALL_MREMAP(sp->base, sp->size, newsize, 0) != MFAIL) ||
+                (CALL_MUNMAP(sp->base + newsize, extra) == 0)) {
+              released = extra;
+            }
+          }
+        }
+        else if (HAVE_MORECORE) {
+          if (extra >= HALF_MAX_SIZE_T) /* Avoid wrapping negative */
+            extra = (HALF_MAX_SIZE_T) + SIZE_T_ONE - unit;
+          ACQUIRE_MORECORE_LOCK();
+          {
+            /* Make sure end of memory is where we last set it. */
+            char* old_br = (char*)(CALL_MORECORE(0));
+            if (old_br == sp->base + sp->size) {
+              char* rel_br = (char*)(CALL_MORECORE(-extra));
+              char* new_br = (char*)(CALL_MORECORE(0));
+              if (rel_br != CMFAIL && new_br < old_br)
+                released = old_br - new_br;
+            }
+          }
+          RELEASE_MORECORE_LOCK();
+        }
+      }
+
+      if (released != 0) {
+        sp->size -= released;
+        m->footprint -= released;
+        init_top(m, m->top, m->topsize - released);
+        check_top_chunk(m, m->top);
+      }
+    }
+
+    /* Unmap any unused mmapped segments */
+    if (HAVE_MMAP) 
+      released += release_unused_segments(m);
+
+    /* On failure, disable autotrim to avoid repeated failed future calls */
+    if (released == 0)
+      m->trim_check = MAX_SIZE_T;
+  }
+
+  return (released != 0)? 1 : 0;
+}
+
+/* ---------------------------- malloc support --------------------------- */
+
+/* allocate a large request from the best fitting chunk in a treebin */
+static void* tmalloc_large(mstate m, size_t nb) {
+  tchunkptr v = 0;
+  size_t rsize = -nb; /* Unsigned negation */
+  tchunkptr t;
+  bindex_t idx;
+  compute_tree_index(nb, idx);
+
+  if ((t = *treebin_at(m, idx)) != 0) {
+    /* Traverse tree for this bin looking for node with size == nb */
+    size_t sizebits = nb << leftshift_for_tree_index(idx);
+    tchunkptr rst = 0;  /* The deepest untaken right subtree */
+    for (;;) {
+      tchunkptr rt;
+      size_t trem = chunksize(t) - nb;
+      if (trem < rsize) {
+        v = t;
+        if ((rsize = trem) == 0)
+          break;
+      }
+      rt = t->child[1];
+      t = t->child[(sizebits >> (SIZE_T_BITSIZE-SIZE_T_ONE)) & 1];
+      if (rt != 0 && rt != t)
+        rst = rt;
+      if (t == 0) {
+        t = rst; /* set t to least subtree holding sizes > nb */
+        break;
+      }
+      sizebits <<= 1;
+    }
+  }
+
+  if (t == 0 && v == 0) { /* set t to root of next non-empty treebin */
+    binmap_t leftbits = left_bits(idx2bit(idx)) & m->treemap;
+    if (leftbits != 0) {
+      bindex_t i;
+      binmap_t leastbit = least_bit(leftbits);
+      compute_bit2idx(leastbit, i);
+      t = *treebin_at(m, i);
+    }
+  }
+
+  while (t != 0) { /* find smallest of tree or subtree */
+    size_t trem = chunksize(t) - nb;
+    if (trem < rsize) {
+      rsize = trem;
+      v = t;
+    }
+    t = leftmost_child(t);
+  }
+
+  /*  If dv is a better fit, return 0 so malloc will use it */
+  if (v != 0 && rsize < (size_t)(m->dvsize - nb)) {
+    if (RTCHECK(ok_address(m, v))) { /* split */
+      mchunkptr r = chunk_plus_offset(v, nb);
+      assert(chunksize(v) == rsize + nb);
+      if (RTCHECK(ok_next(v, r))) {
+        unlink_large_chunk(m, v);
+        if (rsize < MIN_CHUNK_SIZE)
+          set_inuse_and_pinuse(m, v, (rsize + nb));
+        else {
+          set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(m, v, nb);
+          set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(r, rsize);
+          insert_chunk(m, r, rsize);
+        }
+        return chunk2mem(v);
+      }
+    }
+    CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(m);
+  }
+  return 0;
+}
+
+/* allocate a small request from the best fitting chunk in a treebin */
+static void* tmalloc_small(mstate m, size_t nb) {
+  tchunkptr t, v;
+  size_t rsize;
+  bindex_t i;
+  binmap_t leastbit = least_bit(m->treemap);
+  compute_bit2idx(leastbit, i);
+
+  v = t = *treebin_at(m, i);
+  rsize = chunksize(t) - nb;
+
+  while ((t = leftmost_child(t)) != 0) {
+    size_t trem = chunksize(t) - nb;
+    if (trem < rsize) {
+      rsize = trem;
+      v = t;
+    }
+  }
+
+  if (RTCHECK(ok_address(m, v))) {
+    mchunkptr r = chunk_plus_offset(v, nb);
+    assert(chunksize(v) == rsize + nb);
+    if (RTCHECK(ok_next(v, r))) {
+      unlink_large_chunk(m, v);
+      if (rsize < MIN_CHUNK_SIZE)
+        set_inuse_and_pinuse(m, v, (rsize + nb));
+      else {
+        set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(m, v, nb);
+        set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(r, rsize);
+        replace_dv(m, r, rsize);
+      }
+      return chunk2mem(v);
+    }
+  }
+
+  CORRUPTION_ERROR_ACTION(m);
+  return 0;
+}
+
+/* --------------------------- realloc support --------------------------- */
+
+static void* internal_realloc(mstate m, void* oldmem, size_t bytes) {
+  if (bytes >= MAX_REQUEST) {
+    MALLOC_FAILURE_ACTION;
+    return 0;
+  }
+  if (!PREACTION(m)) {
+    mchunkptr oldp = mem2chunk(oldmem);
+    size_t oldsize = chunksize(oldp);
+    mchunkptr next = chunk_plus_offset(oldp, oldsize);
+    mchunkptr newp = 0;
+    void* extra = 0;
+
+    /* Try to either shrink or extend into top. Else malloc-copy-free */
+
+    if (RTCHECK(ok_address(m, oldp) && ok_cinuse(oldp) &&
+                ok_next(oldp, next) && ok_pinuse(next))) {
+      size_t nb = request2size(bytes);
+      if (is_mmapped(oldp))
+        newp = mmap_resize(m, oldp, nb);
+      else if (oldsize >= nb) { /* already big enough */
+        size_t rsize = oldsize - nb;
+        newp = oldp;
+        if (rsize >= MIN_CHUNK_SIZE) {
+          mchunkptr remainder = chunk_plus_offset(newp, nb);
+          set_inuse(m, newp, nb);
+          set_inuse(m, remainder, rsize);
+          extra = chunk2mem(remainder);
+        }
+      }
+      else if (next == m->top && oldsize + m->topsize > nb) {
+        /* Expand into top */
+        size_t newsize = oldsize + m->topsize;
+        size_t newtopsize = newsize - nb;
+        mchunkptr newtop = chunk_plus_offset(oldp, nb);
+        set_inuse(m, oldp, nb);
+        newtop->head = newtopsize |PINUSE_BIT;
+        m->top = newtop;
+        m->topsize = newtopsize;
+        newp = oldp;
+      }
+    }
+    else {
+      USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(m, oldmem);
+      POSTACTION(m);
+      return 0;
+    }
+
+    POSTACTION(m);
+
+    if (newp != 0) {
+      if (extra != 0) {
+        internal_free(m, extra);
+      }
+      check_inuse_chunk(m, newp);
+      return chunk2mem(newp);
+    }
+    else {
+      void* newmem = internal_malloc(m, bytes);
+      if (newmem != 0) {
+        size_t oc = oldsize - overhead_for(oldp);
+        memcpy(newmem, oldmem, (oc < bytes)? oc : bytes);
+        internal_free(m, oldmem);
+      }
+      return newmem;
+    }
+  }
+  return 0;
+}
+
+/* --------------------------- memalign support -------------------------- */
+
+static void* internal_memalign(mstate m, size_t alignment, size_t bytes) {
+  if (alignment <= MALLOC_ALIGNMENT)    /* Can just use malloc */
+    return internal_malloc(m, bytes);
+  if (alignment <  MIN_CHUNK_SIZE) /* must be at least a minimum chunk size */
+    alignment = MIN_CHUNK_SIZE;
+  if ((alignment & (alignment-SIZE_T_ONE)) != 0) {/* Ensure a power of 2 */
+    size_t a = MALLOC_ALIGNMENT << 1;
+    while (a < alignment) a <<= 1;
+    alignment = a;
+  }
+  
+  if (bytes >= MAX_REQUEST - alignment) {
+    if (m != 0)  { /* Test isn't needed but avoids compiler warning */
+      MALLOC_FAILURE_ACTION;
+    }
+  }
+  else {
+    size_t nb = request2size(bytes);
+    size_t req = nb + alignment + MIN_CHUNK_SIZE - CHUNK_OVERHEAD;
+    char* mem = (char*)internal_malloc(m, req);
+    if (mem != 0) {
+      void* leader = 0;
+      void* trailer = 0;
+      mchunkptr p = mem2chunk(mem);
+
+      if (PREACTION(m)) return 0;
+      if ((((size_t)(mem)) % alignment) != 0) { /* misaligned */
+        /*
+          Find an aligned spot inside chunk.  Since we need to give
+          back leading space in a chunk of at least MIN_CHUNK_SIZE, if
+          the first calculation places us at a spot with less than
+          MIN_CHUNK_SIZE leader, we can move to the next aligned spot.
+          We've allocated enough total room so that this is always
+          possible.
+        */
+        char* br = (char*)mem2chunk((size_t)(((size_t)(mem +
+                                                       alignment -
+                                                       SIZE_T_ONE)) &
+                                             -alignment));
+        char* pos = ((size_t)(br - (char*)(p)) >= MIN_CHUNK_SIZE)?
+          br : br+alignment;
+        mchunkptr newp = (mchunkptr)pos;
+        size_t leadsize = pos - (char*)(p);
+        size_t newsize = chunksize(p) - leadsize;
+
+        if (is_mmapped(p)) { /* For mmapped chunks, just adjust offset */
+          newp->prev_foot = p->prev_foot + leadsize;
+          newp->head = (newsize|CINUSE_BIT);
+        }
+        else { /* Otherwise, give back leader, use the rest */
+          set_inuse(m, newp, newsize);
+          set_inuse(m, p, leadsize);
+          leader = chunk2mem(p);
+        }
+        p = newp;
+      }
+
+      /* Give back spare room at the end */
+      if (!is_mmapped(p)) {
+        size_t size = chunksize(p);
+        if (size > nb + MIN_CHUNK_SIZE) {
+          size_t remainder_size = size - nb;
+          mchunkptr remainder = chunk_plus_offset(p, nb);
+          set_inuse(m, p, nb);
+          set_inuse(m, remainder, remainder_size);
+          trailer = chunk2mem(remainder);
+        }
+      }
+
+      assert (chunksize(p) >= nb);
+      assert((((size_t)(chunk2mem(p))) % alignment) == 0);
+      check_inuse_chunk(m, p);
+      POSTACTION(m);
+      if (leader != 0) {
+        internal_free(m, leader);
+      }
+      if (trailer != 0) {
+        internal_free(m, trailer);
+      }
+      return chunk2mem(p);
+    }
+  }
+  return 0;
+}
+
+/* ------------------------ comalloc/coalloc support --------------------- */
+
+static void** ialloc(mstate m,
+                     size_t n_elements,
+                     size_t* sizes,
+                     int opts,
+                     void* chunks[]) {
+  /*
+    This provides common support for independent_X routines, handling
+    all of the combinations that can result.
+
+    The opts arg has:
+    bit 0 set if all elements are same size (using sizes[0])
+    bit 1 set if elements should be zeroed
+  */
+
+  size_t    element_size;   /* chunksize of each element, if all same */
+  size_t    contents_size;  /* total size of elements */
+  size_t    array_size;     /* request size of pointer array */
+  void*     mem;            /* malloced aggregate space */
+  mchunkptr p;              /* corresponding chunk */
+  size_t    remainder_size; /* remaining bytes while splitting */
+  void**    marray;         /* either "chunks" or malloced ptr array */
+  mchunkptr array_chunk;    /* chunk for malloced ptr array */
+  flag_t    was_enabled;    /* to disable mmap */
+  size_t    size;
+  size_t    i;
+
+  /* compute array length, if needed */
+  if (chunks != 0) {
+    if (n_elements == 0)
+      return chunks; /* nothing to do */
+    marray = chunks;
+    array_size = 0;
+  }
+  else {
+    /* if empty req, must still return chunk representing empty array */
+    if (n_elements == 0)
+      return (void**)internal_malloc(m, 0);
+    marray = 0;
+    array_size = request2size(n_elements * (sizeof(void*)));
+  }
+
+  /* compute total element size */
+  if (opts & 0x1) { /* all-same-size */
+    element_size = request2size(*sizes);
+    contents_size = n_elements * element_size;
+  }
+  else { /* add up all the sizes */
+    element_size = 0;
+    contents_size = 0;
+    for (i = 0; i != n_elements; ++i)
+      contents_size += request2size(sizes[i]);
+  }
+
+  size = contents_size + array_size;
+
+  /*
+     Allocate the aggregate chunk.  First disable direct-mmapping so
+     malloc won't use it, since we would not be able to later
+     free/realloc space internal to a segregated mmap region.
+  */
+  was_enabled = use_mmap(m);
+  disable_mmap(m);
+  mem = internal_malloc(m, size - CHUNK_OVERHEAD);
+  if (was_enabled)
+    enable_mmap(m);
+  if (mem == 0)
+    return 0;
+
+  if (PREACTION(m)) return 0;
+  p = mem2chunk(mem);
+  remainder_size = chunksize(p);
+
+  assert(!is_mmapped(p));
+
+  if (opts & 0x2) {       /* optionally clear the elements */
+    memset((size_t*)mem, 0, remainder_size - SIZE_T_SIZE - array_size);
+  }
+
+  /* If not provided, allocate the pointer array as final part of chunk */
+  if (marray == 0) {
+    size_t  array_chunk_size;
+    array_chunk = chunk_plus_offset(p, contents_size);
+    array_chunk_size = remainder_size - contents_size;
+    marray = (void**) (chunk2mem(array_chunk));
+    set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(m, array_chunk, array_chunk_size);
+    remainder_size = contents_size;
+  }
+
+  /* split out elements */
+  for (i = 0; ; ++i) {
+    marray[i] = chunk2mem(p);
+    if (i != n_elements-1) {
+      if (element_size != 0)
+        size = element_size;
+      else
+        size = request2size(sizes[i]);
+      remainder_size -= size;
+      set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(m, p, size);
+      p = chunk_plus_offset(p, size);
+    }
+    else { /* the final element absorbs any overallocation slop */
+      set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(m, p, remainder_size);
+      break;
+    }
+  }
+
+#if DEBUG
+  if (marray != chunks) {
+    /* final element must have exactly exhausted chunk */
+    if (element_size != 0) {
+      assert(remainder_size == element_size);
+    }
+    else {
+      assert(remainder_size == request2size(sizes[i]));
+    }
+    check_inuse_chunk(m, mem2chunk(marray));
+  }
+  for (i = 0; i != n_elements; ++i)
+    check_inuse_chunk(m, mem2chunk(marray[i]));
+
+#endif /* DEBUG */
+
+  POSTACTION(m);
+  return marray;
+}
+
+
+/* -------------------------- public routines ---------------------------- */
+
+#if !ONLY_MSPACES
+
+void* dlmalloc(size_t bytes) {
+  /*
+     Basic algorithm:
+     If a small request (< 256 bytes minus per-chunk overhead):
+       1. If one exists, use a remainderless chunk in associated smallbin.
+          (Remainderless means that there are too few excess bytes to
+          represent as a chunk.)
+       2. If it is big enough, use the dv chunk, which is normally the
+          chunk adjacent to the one used for the most recent small request.
+       3. If one exists, split the smallest available chunk in a bin,
+          saving remainder in dv.
+       4. If it is big enough, use the top chunk.
+       5. If available, get memory from system and use it
+     Otherwise, for a large request:
+       1. Find the smallest available binned chunk that fits, and use it
+          if it is better fitting than dv chunk, splitting if necessary.
+       2. If better fitting than any binned chunk, use the dv chunk.
+       3. If it is big enough, use the top chunk.
+       4. If request size >= mmap threshold, try to directly mmap this chunk.
+       5. If available, get memory from system and use it
+
+     The ugly goto's here ensure that postaction occurs along all paths.
+  */
+
+  if (!PREACTION(gm)) {
+    void* mem;
+    size_t nb;
+    if (bytes <= MAX_SMALL_REQUEST) {
+      bindex_t idx;
+      binmap_t smallbits;
+      nb = (bytes < MIN_REQUEST)? MIN_CHUNK_SIZE : pad_request(bytes);
+      idx = small_index(nb);
+      smallbits = gm->smallmap >> idx;
+
+      if ((smallbits & 0x3U) != 0) { /* Remainderless fit to a smallbin. */
+        mchunkptr b, p;
+        idx += ~smallbits & 1;       /* Uses next bin if idx empty */
+        b = smallbin_at(gm, idx);
+        p = b->fd;
+        assert(chunksize(p) == small_index2size(idx));
+        unlink_first_small_chunk(gm, b, p, idx);
+        set_inuse_and_pinuse(gm, p, small_index2size(idx));
+        mem = chunk2mem(p);
+        check_malloced_chunk(gm, mem, nb);
+        goto postaction;
+      }
+
+      else if (nb > gm->dvsize) {
+        if (smallbits != 0) { /* Use chunk in next nonempty smallbin */
+          mchunkptr b, p, r;
+          size_t rsize;
+          bindex_t i;
+          binmap_t leftbits = (smallbits << idx) & left_bits(idx2bit(idx));
+          binmap_t leastbit = least_bit(leftbits);
+          compute_bit2idx(leastbit, i);
+          b = smallbin_at(gm, i);
+          p = b->fd;
+          assert(chunksize(p) == small_index2size(i));
+          unlink_first_small_chunk(gm, b, p, i);
+          rsize = small_index2size(i) - nb;
+          /* Fit here cannot be remainderless if 4byte sizes */
+          if (SIZE_T_SIZE != 4 && rsize < MIN_CHUNK_SIZE)
+            set_inuse_and_pinuse(gm, p, small_index2size(i));
+          else {
+            set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(gm, p, nb);
+            r = chunk_plus_offset(p, nb);
+            set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(r, rsize);
+            replace_dv(gm, r, rsize);
+          }
+          mem = chunk2mem(p);
+          check_malloced_chunk(gm, mem, nb);
+          goto postaction;
+        }
+
+        else if (gm->treemap != 0 && (mem = tmalloc_small(gm, nb)) != 0) {
+          check_malloced_chunk(gm, mem, nb);
+          goto postaction;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    else if (bytes >= MAX_REQUEST)
+      nb = MAX_SIZE_T; /* Too big to allocate. Force failure (in sys alloc) */
+    else {
+      nb = pad_request(bytes);
+      if (gm->treemap != 0 && (mem = tmalloc_large(gm, nb)) != 0) {
+        check_malloced_chunk(gm, mem, nb);
+        goto postaction;
+      }
+    }
+
+    if (nb <= gm->dvsize) {
+      size_t rsize = gm->dvsize - nb;
+      mchunkptr p = gm->dv;
+      if (rsize >= MIN_CHUNK_SIZE) { /* split dv */
+        mchunkptr r = gm->dv = chunk_plus_offset(p, nb);
+        gm->dvsize = rsize;
+        set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(r, rsize);
+        set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(gm, p, nb);
+      }
+      else { /* exhaust dv */
+        size_t dvs = gm->dvsize;
+        gm->dvsize = 0;
+        gm->dv = 0;
+        set_inuse_and_pinuse(gm, p, dvs);
+      }
+      mem = chunk2mem(p);
+      check_malloced_chunk(gm, mem, nb);
+      goto postaction;
+    }
+
+    else if (nb < gm->topsize) { /* Split top */
+      size_t rsize = gm->topsize -= nb;
+      mchunkptr p = gm->top;
+      mchunkptr r = gm->top = chunk_plus_offset(p, nb);
+      r->head = rsize | PINUSE_BIT;
+      set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(gm, p, nb);
+      mem = chunk2mem(p);
+      check_top_chunk(gm, gm->top);
+      check_malloced_chunk(gm, mem, nb);
+      goto postaction;
+    }
+
+    mem = sys_alloc(gm, nb);
+
+  postaction:
+    POSTACTION(gm);
+    return mem;
+  }
+
+  return 0;
+}
+
+void dlfree(void* mem) {
+  /*
+     Consolidate freed chunks with preceeding or succeeding bordering
+     free chunks, if they exist, and then place in a bin.  Intermixed
+     with special cases for top, dv, mmapped chunks, and usage errors.
+  */
+
+  if (mem != 0) {
+    mchunkptr p  = mem2chunk(mem);
+#if FOOTERS
+    mstate fm = get_mstate_for(p);
+    if (!ok_magic(fm)) {
+      USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(fm, p);
+      return;
+    }
+#else /* FOOTERS */
+#define fm gm
+#endif /* FOOTERS */
+    if (!PREACTION(fm)) {
+      check_inuse_chunk(fm, p);
+      if (RTCHECK(ok_address(fm, p) && ok_cinuse(p))) {
+        size_t psize = chunksize(p);
+        mchunkptr next = chunk_plus_offset(p, psize);
+        if (!pinuse(p)) {
+          size_t prevsize = p->prev_foot;
+          if ((prevsize & IS_MMAPPED_BIT) != 0) {
+            prevsize &= ~IS_MMAPPED_BIT;
+            psize += prevsize + MMAP_FOOT_PAD;
+            if (CALL_MUNMAP((char*)p - prevsize, psize) == 0)
+              fm->footprint -= psize;
+            goto postaction;
+          }
+          else {
+            mchunkptr prev = chunk_minus_offset(p, prevsize);
+            psize += prevsize;
+            p = prev;
+            if (RTCHECK(ok_address(fm, prev))) { /* consolidate backward */
+              if (p != fm->dv) {
+                unlink_chunk(fm, p, prevsize);
+              }
+              else if ((next->head & INUSE_BITS) == INUSE_BITS) {
+                fm->dvsize = psize;
+                set_free_with_pinuse(p, psize, next);
+                goto postaction;
+              }
+            }
+            else
+              goto erroraction;
+          }
+        }
+
+        if (RTCHECK(ok_next(p, next) && ok_pinuse(next))) {
+          if (!cinuse(next)) {  /* consolidate forward */
+            if (next == fm->top) {
+              size_t tsize = fm->topsize += psize;
+              fm->top = p;
+              p->head = tsize | PINUSE_BIT;
+              if (p == fm->dv) {
+                fm->dv = 0;
+                fm->dvsize = 0;
+              }
+              if (should_trim(fm, tsize))
+                sys_trim(fm, 0);
+              goto postaction;
+            }
+            else if (next == fm->dv) {
+              size_t dsize = fm->dvsize += psize;
+              fm->dv = p;
+              set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(p, dsize);
+              goto postaction;
+            }
+            else {
+              size_t nsize = chunksize(next);
+              psize += nsize;
+              unlink_chunk(fm, next, nsize);
+              set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(p, psize);
+              if (p == fm->dv) {
+                fm->dvsize = psize;
+                goto postaction;
+              }
+            }
+          }
+          else
+            set_free_with_pinuse(p, psize, next);
+          insert_chunk(fm, p, psize);
+          check_free_chunk(fm, p);
+          goto postaction;
+        }
+      }
+    erroraction:
+      USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(fm, p);
+    postaction:
+      POSTACTION(fm);
+    }
+  }
+#if !FOOTERS
+#undef fm
+#endif /* FOOTERS */
+}
+
+void* dlcalloc(size_t n_elements, size_t elem_size) {
+  void* mem;
+  size_t req = 0;
+  if (n_elements != 0) {
+    req = n_elements * elem_size;
+    if (((n_elements | elem_size) & ~(size_t)0xffff) &&
+        (req / n_elements != elem_size))
+      req = MAX_SIZE_T; /* force downstream failure on overflow */
+  }
+  mem = dlmalloc(req);
+  if (mem != 0 && calloc_must_clear(mem2chunk(mem)))
+    memset(mem, 0, req);
+  return mem;
+}
+
+void* dlrealloc(void* oldmem, size_t bytes) {
+  if (oldmem == 0)
+    return dlmalloc(bytes);
+#ifdef REALLOC_ZERO_BYTES_FREES
+  if (bytes == 0) {
+    dlfree(oldmem);
+    return 0;
+  }
+#endif /* REALLOC_ZERO_BYTES_FREES */
+  else {
+#if ! FOOTERS
+    mstate m = gm;
+#else /* FOOTERS */
+    mstate m = get_mstate_for(mem2chunk(oldmem));
+    if (!ok_magic(m)) {
+      USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(m, oldmem);
+      return 0;
+    }
+#endif /* FOOTERS */
+    return internal_realloc(m, oldmem, bytes);
+  }
+}
+
+void* dlmemalign(size_t alignment, size_t bytes) {
+  return internal_memalign(gm, alignment, bytes);
+}
+
+void** dlindependent_calloc(size_t n_elements, size_t elem_size,
+                                 void* chunks[]) {
+  size_t sz = elem_size; /* serves as 1-element array */
+  return ialloc(gm, n_elements, &sz, 3, chunks);
+}
+
+void** dlindependent_comalloc(size_t n_elements, size_t sizes[],
+                                   void* chunks[]) {
+  return ialloc(gm, n_elements, sizes, 0, chunks);
+}
+
+void* dlvalloc(size_t bytes) {
+  size_t pagesz;
+  init_mparams();
+  pagesz = mparams.page_size;
+  return dlmemalign(pagesz, bytes);
+}
+
+void* dlpvalloc(size_t bytes) {
+  size_t pagesz;
+  init_mparams();
+  pagesz = mparams.page_size;
+  return dlmemalign(pagesz, (bytes + pagesz - SIZE_T_ONE) & ~(pagesz - SIZE_T_ONE));
+}
+
+int dlmalloc_trim(size_t pad) {
+  int result = 0;
+  if (!PREACTION(gm)) {
+    result = sys_trim(gm, pad);
+    POSTACTION(gm);
+  }
+  return result;
+}
+
+size_t dlmalloc_footprint(void) {
+  return gm->footprint;
+}
+
+size_t dlmalloc_max_footprint(void) {
+  return gm->max_footprint;
+}
+
+#if !NO_MALLINFO
+struct mallinfo dlmallinfo(void) {
+  return internal_mallinfo(gm);
+}
+#endif /* NO_MALLINFO */
+
+void dlmalloc_stats() {
+  internal_malloc_stats(gm);
+}
+
+size_t dlmalloc_usable_size(void* mem) {
+  if (mem != 0) {
+    mchunkptr p = mem2chunk(mem);
+    if (cinuse(p))
+      return chunksize(p) - overhead_for(p);
+  }
+  return 0;
+}
+
+int dlmallopt(int param_number, int value) {
+  return change_mparam(param_number, value);
+}
+
+#endif /* !ONLY_MSPACES */
+
+/* ----------------------------- user mspaces ---------------------------- */
+
+#if MSPACES
+
+static mstate init_user_mstate(char* tbase, size_t tsize) {
+  size_t msize = pad_request(sizeof(struct malloc_state));
+  mchunkptr mn;
+  mchunkptr msp = align_as_chunk(tbase);
+  mstate m = (mstate)(chunk2mem(msp));
+  memset(m, 0, msize);
+  INITIAL_LOCK(&m->mutex);
+  msp->head = (msize|PINUSE_BIT|CINUSE_BIT);
+  m->seg.base = m->least_addr = tbase;
+  m->seg.size = m->footprint = m->max_footprint = tsize;
+  m->magic = mparams.magic;
+  m->mflags = mparams.default_mflags;
+  disable_contiguous(m);
+  init_bins(m);
+  mn = next_chunk(mem2chunk(m));
+  init_top(m, mn, (size_t)((tbase + tsize) - (char*)mn) - TOP_FOOT_SIZE);
+  check_top_chunk(m, m->top);
+  return m;
+}
+
+mspace create_mspace(size_t capacity, int locked) {
+  mstate m = 0;
+  size_t msize = pad_request(sizeof(struct malloc_state));
+  init_mparams(); /* Ensure pagesize etc initialized */
+
+  if (capacity < (size_t) -(msize + TOP_FOOT_SIZE + mparams.page_size)) {
+    size_t rs = ((capacity == 0)? mparams.granularity :
+                 (capacity + TOP_FOOT_SIZE + msize));
+    size_t tsize = granularity_align(rs);
+    char* tbase = (char*)(CALL_MMAP(tsize));
+    if (tbase != CMFAIL) {
+      m = init_user_mstate(tbase, tsize);
+      m->seg.sflags = IS_MMAPPED_BIT;
+      set_lock(m, locked);
+    }
+  }
+  return (mspace)m;
+}
+
+mspace create_mspace_with_base(void* base, size_t capacity, int locked) {
+  mstate m = 0;
+  size_t msize = pad_request(sizeof(struct malloc_state));
+  init_mparams(); /* Ensure pagesize etc initialized */
+
+  if (capacity > msize + TOP_FOOT_SIZE &&
+      capacity < (size_t) -(msize + TOP_FOOT_SIZE + mparams.page_size)) {
+    m = init_user_mstate((char*)base, capacity);
+    m->seg.sflags = EXTERN_BIT;
+    set_lock(m, locked);
+  }
+  return (mspace)m;
+}
+
+size_t destroy_mspace(mspace msp) {
+  size_t freed = 0;
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (ok_magic(ms)) {
+    msegmentptr sp = &ms->seg;
+    while (sp != 0) {
+      char* base = sp->base;
+      size_t size = sp->size;
+      flag_t flag = sp->sflags;
+      sp = sp->next;
+      if ((flag & IS_MMAPPED_BIT) && !(flag & EXTERN_BIT) &&
+          CALL_MUNMAP(base, size) == 0)
+        freed += size;
+    }
+  }
+  else {
+    USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+  }
+  return freed;
+}
+
+/*
+  mspace versions of routines are near-clones of the global
+  versions. This is not so nice but better than the alternatives.
+*/
+
+
+void* mspace_malloc(mspace msp, size_t bytes) {
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (!ok_magic(ms)) {
+    USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+    return 0;
+  }
+  if (!PREACTION(ms)) {
+    void* mem;
+    size_t nb;
+    if (bytes <= MAX_SMALL_REQUEST) {
+      bindex_t idx;
+      binmap_t smallbits;
+      nb = (bytes < MIN_REQUEST)? MIN_CHUNK_SIZE : pad_request(bytes);
+      idx = small_index(nb);
+      smallbits = ms->smallmap >> idx;
+
+      if ((smallbits & 0x3U) != 0) { /* Remainderless fit to a smallbin. */
+        mchunkptr b, p;
+        idx += ~smallbits & 1;       /* Uses next bin if idx empty */
+        b = smallbin_at(ms, idx);
+        p = b->fd;
+        assert(chunksize(p) == small_index2size(idx));
+        unlink_first_small_chunk(ms, b, p, idx);
+        set_inuse_and_pinuse(ms, p, small_index2size(idx));
+        mem = chunk2mem(p);
+        check_malloced_chunk(ms, mem, nb);
+        goto postaction;
+      }
+
+      else if (nb > ms->dvsize) {
+        if (smallbits != 0) { /* Use chunk in next nonempty smallbin */
+          mchunkptr b, p, r;
+          size_t rsize;
+          bindex_t i;
+          binmap_t leftbits = (smallbits << idx) & left_bits(idx2bit(idx));
+          binmap_t leastbit = least_bit(leftbits);
+          compute_bit2idx(leastbit, i);
+          b = smallbin_at(ms, i);
+          p = b->fd;
+          assert(chunksize(p) == small_index2size(i));
+          unlink_first_small_chunk(ms, b, p, i);
+          rsize = small_index2size(i) - nb;
+          /* Fit here cannot be remainderless if 4byte sizes */
+          if (SIZE_T_SIZE != 4 && rsize < MIN_CHUNK_SIZE)
+            set_inuse_and_pinuse(ms, p, small_index2size(i));
+          else {
+            set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(ms, p, nb);
+            r = chunk_plus_offset(p, nb);
+            set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(r, rsize);
+            replace_dv(ms, r, rsize);
+          }
+          mem = chunk2mem(p);
+          check_malloced_chunk(ms, mem, nb);
+          goto postaction;
+        }
+
+        else if (ms->treemap != 0 && (mem = tmalloc_small(ms, nb)) != 0) {
+          check_malloced_chunk(ms, mem, nb);
+          goto postaction;
+        }
+      }
+    }
+    else if (bytes >= MAX_REQUEST)
+      nb = MAX_SIZE_T; /* Too big to allocate. Force failure (in sys alloc) */
+    else {
+      nb = pad_request(bytes);
+      if (ms->treemap != 0 && (mem = tmalloc_large(ms, nb)) != 0) {
+        check_malloced_chunk(ms, mem, nb);
+        goto postaction;
+      }
+    }
+
+    if (nb <= ms->dvsize) {
+      size_t rsize = ms->dvsize - nb;
+      mchunkptr p = ms->dv;
+      if (rsize >= MIN_CHUNK_SIZE) { /* split dv */
+        mchunkptr r = ms->dv = chunk_plus_offset(p, nb);
+        ms->dvsize = rsize;
+        set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(r, rsize);
+        set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(ms, p, nb);
+      }
+      else { /* exhaust dv */
+        size_t dvs = ms->dvsize;
+        ms->dvsize = 0;
+        ms->dv = 0;
+        set_inuse_and_pinuse(ms, p, dvs);
+      }
+      mem = chunk2mem(p);
+      check_malloced_chunk(ms, mem, nb);
+      goto postaction;
+    }
+
+    else if (nb < ms->topsize) { /* Split top */
+      size_t rsize = ms->topsize -= nb;
+      mchunkptr p = ms->top;
+      mchunkptr r = ms->top = chunk_plus_offset(p, nb);
+      r->head = rsize | PINUSE_BIT;
+      set_size_and_pinuse_of_inuse_chunk(ms, p, nb);
+      mem = chunk2mem(p);
+      check_top_chunk(ms, ms->top);
+      check_malloced_chunk(ms, mem, nb);
+      goto postaction;
+    }
+
+    mem = sys_alloc(ms, nb);
+
+  postaction:
+    POSTACTION(ms);
+    return mem;
+  }
+
+  return 0;
+}
+
+void mspace_free(mspace msp, void* mem) {
+  if (mem != 0) {
+    mchunkptr p  = mem2chunk(mem);
+#if FOOTERS
+    mstate fm = get_mstate_for(p);
+#else /* FOOTERS */
+    mstate fm = (mstate)msp;
+#endif /* FOOTERS */
+    if (!ok_magic(fm)) {
+      USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(fm, p);
+      return;
+    }
+    if (!PREACTION(fm)) {
+      check_inuse_chunk(fm, p);
+      if (RTCHECK(ok_address(fm, p) && ok_cinuse(p))) {
+        size_t psize = chunksize(p);
+        mchunkptr next = chunk_plus_offset(p, psize);
+        if (!pinuse(p)) {
+          size_t prevsize = p->prev_foot;
+          if ((prevsize & IS_MMAPPED_BIT) != 0) {
+            prevsize &= ~IS_MMAPPED_BIT;
+            psize += prevsize + MMAP_FOOT_PAD;
+            if (CALL_MUNMAP((char*)p - prevsize, psize) == 0)
+              fm->footprint -= psize;
+            goto postaction;
+          }
+          else {
+            mchunkptr prev = chunk_minus_offset(p, prevsize);
+            psize += prevsize;
+            p = prev;
+            if (RTCHECK(ok_address(fm, prev))) { /* consolidate backward */
+              if (p != fm->dv) {
+                unlink_chunk(fm, p, prevsize);
+              }
+              else if ((next->head & INUSE_BITS) == INUSE_BITS) {
+                fm->dvsize = psize;
+                set_free_with_pinuse(p, psize, next);
+                goto postaction;
+              }
+            }
+            else
+              goto erroraction;
+          }
+        }
+
+        if (RTCHECK(ok_next(p, next) && ok_pinuse(next))) {
+          if (!cinuse(next)) {  /* consolidate forward */
+            if (next == fm->top) {
+              size_t tsize = fm->topsize += psize;
+              fm->top = p;
+              p->head = tsize | PINUSE_BIT;
+              if (p == fm->dv) {
+                fm->dv = 0;
+                fm->dvsize = 0;
+              }
+              if (should_trim(fm, tsize))
+                sys_trim(fm, 0);
+              goto postaction;
+            }
+            else if (next == fm->dv) {
+              size_t dsize = fm->dvsize += psize;
+              fm->dv = p;
+              set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(p, dsize);
+              goto postaction;
+            }
+            else {
+              size_t nsize = chunksize(next);
+              psize += nsize;
+              unlink_chunk(fm, next, nsize);
+              set_size_and_pinuse_of_free_chunk(p, psize);
+              if (p == fm->dv) {
+                fm->dvsize = psize;
+                goto postaction;
+              }
+            }
+          }
+          else
+            set_free_with_pinuse(p, psize, next);
+          insert_chunk(fm, p, psize);
+          check_free_chunk(fm, p);
+          goto postaction;
+        }
+      }
+    erroraction:
+      USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(fm, p);
+    postaction:
+      POSTACTION(fm);
+    }
+  }
+}
+
+void* mspace_calloc(mspace msp, size_t n_elements, size_t elem_size) {
+  void* mem;
+  size_t req = 0;
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (!ok_magic(ms)) {
+    USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+    return 0;
+  }
+  if (n_elements != 0) {
+    req = n_elements * elem_size;
+    if (((n_elements | elem_size) & ~(size_t)0xffff) &&
+        (req / n_elements != elem_size))
+      req = MAX_SIZE_T; /* force downstream failure on overflow */
+  }
+  mem = internal_malloc(ms, req);
+  if (mem != 0 && calloc_must_clear(mem2chunk(mem)))
+    memset(mem, 0, req);
+  return mem;
+}
+
+void* mspace_realloc(mspace msp, void* oldmem, size_t bytes) {
+  if (oldmem == 0)
+    return mspace_malloc(msp, bytes);
+#ifdef REALLOC_ZERO_BYTES_FREES
+  if (bytes == 0) {
+    mspace_free(msp, oldmem);
+    return 0;
+  }
+#endif /* REALLOC_ZERO_BYTES_FREES */
+  else {
+#if FOOTERS
+    mchunkptr p  = mem2chunk(oldmem);
+    mstate ms = get_mstate_for(p);
+#else /* FOOTERS */
+    mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+#endif /* FOOTERS */
+    if (!ok_magic(ms)) {
+      USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+      return 0;
+    }
+    return internal_realloc(ms, oldmem, bytes);
+  }
+}
+
+void* mspace_memalign(mspace msp, size_t alignment, size_t bytes) {
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (!ok_magic(ms)) {
+    USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+    return 0;
+  }
+  return internal_memalign(ms, alignment, bytes);
+}
+
+void** mspace_independent_calloc(mspace msp, size_t n_elements,
+                                 size_t elem_size, void* chunks[]) {
+  size_t sz = elem_size; /* serves as 1-element array */
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (!ok_magic(ms)) {
+    USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+    return 0;
+  }
+  return ialloc(ms, n_elements, &sz, 3, chunks);
+}
+
+void** mspace_independent_comalloc(mspace msp, size_t n_elements,
+                                   size_t sizes[], void* chunks[]) {
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (!ok_magic(ms)) {
+    USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+    return 0;
+  }
+  return ialloc(ms, n_elements, sizes, 0, chunks);
+}
+
+int mspace_trim(mspace msp, size_t pad) {
+  int result = 0;
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (ok_magic(ms)) {
+    if (!PREACTION(ms)) {
+      result = sys_trim(ms, pad);
+      POSTACTION(ms);
+    }
+  }
+  else {
+    USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+  }
+  return result;
+}
+
+void mspace_malloc_stats(mspace msp) {
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (ok_magic(ms)) {
+    internal_malloc_stats(ms);
+  }
+  else {
+    USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+  }
+}
+
+size_t mspace_footprint(mspace msp) {
+  size_t result;
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (ok_magic(ms)) {
+    result = ms->footprint;
+  }
+  USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+  return result;
+}
+
+
+size_t mspace_max_footprint(mspace msp) {
+  size_t result;
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (ok_magic(ms)) {
+    result = ms->max_footprint;
+  }
+  USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+  return result;
+}
+
+
+#if !NO_MALLINFO
+struct mallinfo mspace_mallinfo(mspace msp) {
+  mstate ms = (mstate)msp;
+  if (!ok_magic(ms)) {
+    USAGE_ERROR_ACTION(ms,ms);
+  }
+  return internal_mallinfo(ms);
+}
+#endif /* NO_MALLINFO */
+
+int mspace_mallopt(int param_number, int value) {
+  return change_mparam(param_number, value);
+}
+
+#endif /* MSPACES */
+
+/* -------------------- Alternative MORECORE functions ------------------- */
+
+/*
+  Guidelines for creating a custom version of MORECORE:
+
+  * For best performance, MORECORE should allocate in multiples of pagesize.
+  * MORECORE may allocate more memory than requested. (Or even less,
+      but this will usually result in a malloc failure.)
+  * MORECORE must not allocate memory when given argument zero, but
+      instead return one past the end address of memory from previous
+      nonzero call.
+  * For best performance, consecutive calls to MORECORE with positive
+      arguments should return increasing addresses, indicating that
+      space has been contiguously extended.
+  * Even though consecutive calls to MORECORE need not return contiguous
+      addresses, it must be OK for malloc'ed chunks to span multiple
+      regions in those cases where they do happen to be contiguous.
+  * MORECORE need not handle negative arguments -- it may instead
+      just return MFAIL when given negative arguments.
+      Negative arguments are always multiples of pagesize. MORECORE
+      must not misinterpret negative args as large positive unsigned
+      args. You can suppress all such calls from even occurring by defining
+      MORECORE_CANNOT_TRIM,
+
+  As an example alternative MORECORE, here is a custom allocator
+  kindly contributed for pre-OSX macOS.  It uses virtually but not
+  necessarily physically contiguous non-paged memory (locked in,
+  present and won't get swapped out).  You can use it by uncommenting
+  this section, adding some #includes, and setting up the appropriate
+  defines above:
+
+      #define MORECORE osMoreCore
+
+  There is also a shutdown routine that should somehow be called for
+  cleanup upon program exit.
+
+  #define MAX_POOL_ENTRIES 100
+  #define MINIMUM_MORECORE_SIZE  (64 * 1024U)
+  static int next_os_pool;
+  void *our_os_pools[MAX_POOL_ENTRIES];
+
+  void *osMoreCore(int size)
+  {
+    void *ptr = 0;
+    static void *sbrk_top = 0;
+
+    if (size > 0)
+    {
+      if (size < MINIMUM_MORECORE_SIZE)
+         size = MINIMUM_MORECORE_SIZE;
+      if (CurrentExecutionLevel() == kTaskLevel)
+         ptr = PoolAllocateResident(size + RM_PAGE_SIZE, 0);
+      if (ptr == 0)
+      {
+        return (void *) MFAIL;
+      }
+      // save ptrs so they can be freed during cleanup
+      our_os_pools[next_os_pool] = ptr;
+      next_os_pool++;
+      ptr = (void *) ((((size_t) ptr) + RM_PAGE_MASK) & ~RM_PAGE_MASK);
+      sbrk_top = (char *) ptr + size;
+      return ptr;
+    }
+    else if (size < 0)
+    {
+      // we don't currently support shrink behavior
+      return (void *) MFAIL;
+    }
+    else
+    {
+      return sbrk_top;
+    }
+  }
+
+  // cleanup any allocated memory pools
+  // called as last thing before shutting down driver
+
+  void osCleanupMem(void)
+  {
+    void **ptr;
+
+    for (ptr = our_os_pools; ptr < &our_os_pools[MAX_POOL_ENTRIES]; ptr++)
+      if (*ptr)
+      {
+         PoolDeallocate(*ptr);
+         *ptr = 0;
+      }
+  }
+
+*/
+
+
+/* -----------------------------------------------------------------------
+History:
+    V2.8.3 Thu Sep 22 11:16:32 2005  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Add max_footprint functions
+      * Ensure all appropriate literals are size_t
+      * Fix conditional compilation problem for some #define settings
+      * Avoid concatenating segments with the one provided
+        in create_mspace_with_base
+      * Rename some variables to avoid compiler shadowing warnings
+      * Use explicit lock initialization.
+      * Better handling of sbrk interference.
+      * Simplify and fix segment insertion, trimming and mspace_destroy
+      * Reinstate REALLOC_ZERO_BYTES_FREES option from 2.7.x
+      * Thanks especially to Dennis Flanagan for help on these.
+
+    V2.8.2 Sun Jun 12 16:01:10 2005  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Fix memalign brace error.
+
+    V2.8.1 Wed Jun  8 16:11:46 2005  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Fix improper #endif nesting in C++
+      * Add explicit casts needed for C++
+
+    V2.8.0 Mon May 30 14:09:02 2005  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Use trees for large bins
+      * Support mspaces
+      * Use segments to unify sbrk-based and mmap-based system allocation,
+        removing need for emulation on most platforms without sbrk.
+      * Default safety checks
+      * Optional footer checks. Thanks to William Robertson for the idea.
+      * Internal code refactoring
+      * Incorporate suggestions and platform-specific changes.
+        Thanks to Dennis Flanagan, Colin Plumb, Niall Douglas,
+        Aaron Bachmann,  Emery Berger, and others.
+      * Speed up non-fastbin processing enough to remove fastbins.
+      * Remove useless cfree() to avoid conflicts with other apps.
+      * Remove internal memcpy, memset. Compilers handle builtins better.
+      * Remove some options that no one ever used and rename others.
+
+    V2.7.2 Sat Aug 17 09:07:30 2002  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Fix malloc_state bitmap array misdeclaration
+
+    V2.7.1 Thu Jul 25 10:58:03 2002  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Allow tuning of FIRST_SORTED_BIN_SIZE
+      * Use PTR_UINT as type for all ptr->int casts. Thanks to John Belmonte.
+      * Better detection and support for non-contiguousness of MORECORE.
+        Thanks to Andreas Mueller, Conal Walsh, and Wolfram Gloger
+      * Bypass most of malloc if no frees. Thanks To Emery Berger.
+      * Fix freeing of old top non-contiguous chunk im sysmalloc.
+      * Raised default trim and map thresholds to 256K.
+      * Fix mmap-related #defines. Thanks to Lubos Lunak.
+      * Fix copy macros; added LACKS_FCNTL_H. Thanks to Neal Walfield.
+      * Branch-free bin calculation
+      * Default trim and mmap thresholds now 256K.
+
+    V2.7.0 Sun Mar 11 14:14:06 2001  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Introduce independent_comalloc and independent_calloc.
+        Thanks to Michael Pachos for motivation and help.
+      * Make optional .h file available
+      * Allow > 2GB requests on 32bit systems.
+      * new WIN32 sbrk, mmap, munmap, lock code from <Walter@GeNeSys-e.de>.
+        Thanks also to Andreas Mueller <a.mueller at paradatec.de>,
+        and Anonymous.
+      * Allow override of MALLOC_ALIGNMENT (Thanks to Ruud Waij for
+        helping test this.)
+      * memalign: check alignment arg
+      * realloc: don't try to shift chunks backwards, since this
+        leads to  more fragmentation in some programs and doesn't
+        seem to help in any others.
+      * Collect all cases in malloc requiring system memory into sysmalloc
+      * Use mmap as backup to sbrk
+      * Place all internal state in malloc_state
+      * Introduce fastbins (although similar to 2.5.1)
+      * Many minor tunings and cosmetic improvements
+      * Introduce USE_PUBLIC_MALLOC_WRAPPERS, USE_MALLOC_LOCK
+      * Introduce MALLOC_FAILURE_ACTION, MORECORE_CONTIGUOUS
+        Thanks to Tony E. Bennett <tbennett@nvidia.com> and others.
+      * Include errno.h to support default failure action.
+
+    V2.6.6 Sun Dec  5 07:42:19 1999  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * return null for negative arguments
+      * Added Several WIN32 cleanups from Martin C. Fong <mcfong at yahoo.com>
+         * Add 'LACKS_SYS_PARAM_H' for those systems without 'sys/param.h'
+          (e.g. WIN32 platforms)
+         * Cleanup header file inclusion for WIN32 platforms
+         * Cleanup code to avoid Microsoft Visual C++ compiler complaints
+         * Add 'USE_DL_PREFIX' to quickly allow co-existence with existing
+           memory allocation routines
+         * Set 'malloc_getpagesize' for WIN32 platforms (needs more work)
+         * Use 'assert' rather than 'ASSERT' in WIN32 code to conform to
+           usage of 'assert' in non-WIN32 code
+         * Improve WIN32 'sbrk()' emulation's 'findRegion()' routine to
+           avoid infinite loop
+      * Always call 'fREe()' rather than 'free()'
+
+    V2.6.5 Wed Jun 17 15:57:31 1998  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Fixed ordering problem with boundary-stamping
+
+    V2.6.3 Sun May 19 08:17:58 1996  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Added pvalloc, as recommended by H.J. Liu
+      * Added 64bit pointer support mainly from Wolfram Gloger
+      * Added anonymously donated WIN32 sbrk emulation
+      * Malloc, calloc, getpagesize: add optimizations from Raymond Nijssen
+      * malloc_extend_top: fix mask error that caused wastage after
+        foreign sbrks
+      * Add linux mremap support code from HJ Liu
+
+    V2.6.2 Tue Dec  5 06:52:55 1995  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Integrated most documentation with the code.
+      * Add support for mmap, with help from
+        Wolfram Gloger (Gloger@lrz.uni-muenchen.de).
+      * Use last_remainder in more cases.
+      * Pack bins using idea from  colin@nyx10.cs.du.edu
+      * Use ordered bins instead of best-fit threshhold
+      * Eliminate block-local decls to simplify tracing and debugging.
+      * Support another case of realloc via move into top
+      * Fix error occuring when initial sbrk_base not word-aligned.
+      * Rely on page size for units instead of SBRK_UNIT to
+        avoid surprises about sbrk alignment conventions.
+      * Add mallinfo, mallopt. Thanks to Raymond Nijssen
+        (raymond@es.ele.tue.nl) for the suggestion.
+      * Add `pad' argument to malloc_trim and top_pad mallopt parameter.
+      * More precautions for cases where other routines call sbrk,
+        courtesy of Wolfram Gloger (Gloger@lrz.uni-muenchen.de).
+      * Added macros etc., allowing use in linux libc from
+        H.J. Lu (hjl@gnu.ai.mit.edu)
+      * Inverted this history list
+
+    V2.6.1 Sat Dec  2 14:10:57 1995  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Re-tuned and fixed to behave more nicely with V2.6.0 changes.
+      * Removed all preallocation code since under current scheme
+        the work required to undo bad preallocations exceeds
+        the work saved in good cases for most test programs.
+      * No longer use return list or unconsolidated bins since
+        no scheme using them consistently outperforms those that don't
+        given above changes.
+      * Use best fit for very large chunks to prevent some worst-cases.
+      * Added some support for debugging
+
+    V2.6.0 Sat Nov  4 07:05:23 1995  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Removed footers when chunks are in use. Thanks to
+        Paul Wilson (wilson@cs.texas.edu) for the suggestion.
+
+    V2.5.4 Wed Nov  1 07:54:51 1995  Doug Lea  (dl at gee)
+      * Added malloc_trim, with help from Wolfram Gloger
+        (wmglo@Dent.MED.Uni-Muenchen.DE).
+
+    V2.5.3 Tue Apr 26 10:16:01 1994  Doug Lea  (dl at g)
+
+    V2.5.2 Tue Apr  5 16:20:40 1994  Doug Lea  (dl at g)
+      * realloc: try to expand in both directions
+      * malloc: swap order of clean-bin strategy;
+      * realloc: only conditionally expand backwards
+      * Try not to scavenge used bins
+      * Use bin counts as a guide to preallocation
+      * Occasionally bin return list chunks in first scan
+      * Add a few optimizations from colin@nyx10.cs.du.edu
+
+    V2.5.1 Sat Aug 14 15:40:43 1993  Doug Lea  (dl at g)
+      * faster bin computation & slightly different binning
+      * merged all consolidations to one part of malloc proper
+         (eliminating old malloc_find_space & malloc_clean_bin)
+      * Scan 2 returns chunks (not just 1)
+      * Propagate failure in realloc if malloc returns 0
+      * Add stuff to allow compilation on non-ANSI compilers
+          from kpv@research.att.com
+
+    V2.5 Sat Aug  7 07:41:59 1993  Doug Lea  (dl at g.oswego.edu)
+      * removed potential for odd address access in prev_chunk
+      * removed dependency on getpagesize.h
+      * misc cosmetics and a bit more internal documentation
+      * anticosmetics: mangled names in macros to evade debugger strangeness
+      * tested on sparc, hp-700, dec-mips, rs6000
+          with gcc & native cc (hp, dec only) allowing
+          Detlefs & Zorn comparison study (in SIGPLAN Notices.)
+
+    Trial version Fri Aug 28 13:14:29 1992  Doug Lea  (dl at g.oswego.edu)
+      * Based loosely on libg++-1.2X malloc. (It retains some of the overall
+         structure of old version,  but most details differ.)
+ 
+*/
+
+#endif /* !HAVE_MALLOC */
\ No newline at end of file
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/stdlib/SDL_qsort.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,418 @@
+/* qsort.c
+ * (c) 1998 Gareth McCaughan
+ *
+ * This is a drop-in replacement for the C library's |qsort()| routine.
+ *
+ * Features:
+ *   - Median-of-three pivoting (and more)
+ *   - Truncation and final polishing by a single insertion sort
+ *   - Early truncation when no swaps needed in pivoting step
+ *   - Explicit recursion, guaranteed not to overflow
+ *   - A few little wrinkles stolen from the GNU |qsort()|.
+ *   - separate code for non-aligned / aligned / word-size objects
+ *
+ * This code may be reproduced freely provided
+ *   - this file is retained unaltered apart from minor
+ *     changes for portability and efficiency
+ *   - no changes are made to this comment
+ *   - any changes that *are* made are clearly flagged
+ *   - the _ID string below is altered by inserting, after
+ *     the date, the string " altered" followed at your option
+ *     by other material. (Exceptions: you may change the name
+ *     of the exported routine without changing the ID string.
+ *     You may change the values of the macros TRUNC_* and
+ *     PIVOT_THRESHOLD without changing the ID string, provided
+ *     they remain constants with TRUNC_nonaligned, TRUNC_aligned
+ *     and TRUNC_words/WORD_BYTES between 8 and 24, and
+ *     PIVOT_THRESHOLD between 32 and 200.)
+ *
+ * You may use it in anything you like; you may make money
+ * out of it; you may distribute it in object form or as
+ * part of an executable without including source code;
+ * you don't have to credit me. (But it would be nice if
+ * you did.)
+ *
+ * If you find problems with this code, or find ways of
+ * making it significantly faster, please let me know!
+ * My e-mail address, valid as of early 1998 and certainly
+ * OK for at least the next 18 months, is
+ *    gjm11@dpmms.cam.ac.uk
+ * Thanks!
+ *
+ * Gareth McCaughan   Peterhouse   Cambridge   1998
+ */
+
+/*
+#include <assert.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+*/
+#define assert(X)
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
+
+#ifndef HAVE_QSORT
+
+static char _ID[]="<qsort.c gjm 1.12 1998-03-19>";
+
+/* How many bytes are there per word? (Must be a power of 2,
+ * and must in fact equal sizeof(int).)
+ */
+#define WORD_BYTES sizeof(int)
+
+/* How big does our stack need to be? Answer: one entry per
+ * bit in a |size_t|.
+ */
+#define STACK_SIZE (8*sizeof(size_t))
+
+/* Different situations have slightly different requirements,
+ * and we make life epsilon easier by using different truncation
+ * points for the three different cases.
+ * So far, I have tuned TRUNC_words and guessed that the same
+ * value might work well for the other two cases. Of course
+ * what works well on my machine might work badly on yours.
+ */
+#define TRUNC_nonaligned	12
+#define TRUNC_aligned		12
+#define TRUNC_words		12*WORD_BYTES	/* nb different meaning */
+
+/* We use a simple pivoting algorithm for shortish sub-arrays
+ * and a more complicated one for larger ones. The threshold
+ * is PIVOT_THRESHOLD.
+ */
+#define PIVOT_THRESHOLD 40
+
+typedef struct { char * first; char * last; } stack_entry;
+#define pushLeft {stack[stacktop].first=ffirst;stack[stacktop++].last=last;}
+#define pushRight {stack[stacktop].first=first;stack[stacktop++].last=llast;}
+#define doLeft {first=ffirst;llast=last;continue;}
+#define doRight {ffirst=first;last=llast;continue;}
+#define pop {if (--stacktop<0) break;\
+  first=ffirst=stack[stacktop].first;\
+  last=llast=stack[stacktop].last;\
+  continue;}
+
+/* Some comments on the implementation.
+ * 1. When we finish partitioning the array into "low"
+ *    and "high", we forget entirely about short subarrays,
+ *    because they'll be done later by insertion sort.
+ *    Doing lots of little insertion sorts might be a win
+ *    on large datasets for locality-of-reference reasons,
+ *    but it makes the code much nastier and increases
+ *    bookkeeping overhead.
+ * 2. We always save the shorter and get to work on the
+ *    longer. This guarantees that every time we push
+ *    an item onto the stack its size is <= 1/2 of that
+ *    of its parent; so the stack can't need more than
+ *    log_2(max-array-size) entries.
+ * 3. We choose a pivot by looking at the first, last
+ *    and middle elements. We arrange them into order
+ *    because it's easy to do that in conjunction with
+ *    choosing the pivot, and it makes things a little
+ *    easier in the partitioning step. Anyway, the pivot
+ *    is the middle of these three. It's still possible
+ *    to construct datasets where the algorithm takes
+ *    time of order n^2, but it simply never happens in
+ *    practice.
+ * 3' Newsflash: On further investigation I find that
+ *    it's easy to construct datasets where median-of-3
+ *    simply isn't good enough. So on large-ish subarrays
+ *    we do a more sophisticated pivoting: we take three
+ *    sets of 3 elements, find their medians, and then
+ *    take the median of those.
+ * 4. We copy the pivot element to a separate place
+ *    because that way we can always do our comparisons
+ *    directly against a pointer to that separate place,
+ *    and don't have to wonder "did we move the pivot
+ *    element?". This makes the inner loop better.
+ * 5. It's possible to make the pivoting even more
+ *    reliable by looking at more candidates when n
+ *    is larger. (Taking this to its logical conclusion
+ *    results in a variant of quicksort that doesn't
+ *    have that n^2 worst case.) However, the overhead
+ *    from the extra bookkeeping means that it's just
+ *    not worth while.
+ * 6. This is pretty clean and portable code. Here are
+ *    all the potential portability pitfalls and problems
+ *    I know of:
+ *      - In one place (the insertion sort) I construct
+ *        a pointer that points just past the end of the
+ *        supplied array, and assume that (a) it won't
+ *        compare equal to any pointer within the array,
+ *        and (b) it will compare equal to a pointer
+ *        obtained by stepping off the end of the array.
+ *        These might fail on some segmented architectures.
+ *      - I assume that there are 8 bits in a |char| when
+ *        computing the size of stack needed. This would
+ *        fail on machines with 9-bit or 16-bit bytes.
+ *      - I assume that if |((int)base&(sizeof(int)-1))==0|
+ *        and |(size&(sizeof(int)-1))==0| then it's safe to
+ *        get at array elements via |int*|s, and that if
+ *        actually |size==sizeof(int)| as well then it's
+ *        safe to treat the elements as |int|s. This might
+ *        fail on systems that convert pointers to integers
+ *        in non-standard ways.
+ *      - I assume that |8*sizeof(size_t)<=INT_MAX|. This
+ *        would be false on a machine with 8-bit |char|s,
+ *        16-bit |int|s and 4096-bit |size_t|s. :-)
+ */
+
+/* The recursion logic is the same in each case: */
+#define Recurse(Trunc)				\
+      { size_t l=last-ffirst,r=llast-first;	\
+        if (l<Trunc) {				\
+          if (r>=Trunc) doRight			\
+          else pop				\
+        }					\
+        else if (l<=r) { pushLeft; doRight }	\
+        else if (r>=Trunc) { pushRight; doLeft }\
+        else doLeft				\
+      }
+
+/* and so is the pivoting logic: */
+#define Pivot(swapper,sz)			\
+  if ((size_t)(last-first)>PIVOT_THRESHOLD*sz) mid=pivot_big(first,mid,last,sz,compare);\
+  else {	\
+    if (compare(first,mid)<0) {			\
+      if (compare(mid,last)>0) {		\
+        swapper(mid,last);			\
+        if (compare(first,mid)>0) swapper(first,mid);\
+      }						\
+    }						\
+    else {					\
+      if (compare(mid,last)>0) swapper(first,last)\
+      else {					\
+        swapper(first,mid);			\
+        if (compare(mid,last)>0) swapper(mid,last);\
+      }						\
+    }						\
+    first+=sz; last-=sz;			\
+  }
+
+#ifdef DEBUG_QSORT
+#include <stdio.h>
+#endif
+
+/* and so is the partitioning logic: */
+#define Partition(swapper,sz) {			\
+  int swapped=0;				\
+  do {						\
+    while (compare(first,pivot)<0) first+=sz;	\
+    while (compare(pivot,last)<0) last-=sz;	\
+    if (first<last) {				\
+      swapper(first,last); swapped=1;		\
+      first+=sz; last-=sz; }			\
+    else if (first==last) { first+=sz; last-=sz; break; }\
+  } while (first<=last);			\
+  if (!swapped) pop				\
+}
+
+/* and so is the pre-insertion-sort operation of putting
+ * the smallest element into place as a sentinel.
+ * Doing this makes the inner loop nicer. I got this
+ * idea from the GNU implementation of qsort().
+ */
+#define PreInsertion(swapper,limit,sz)		\
+  first=base;					\
+  last=first + (nmemb>limit ? limit : nmemb-1)*sz;\
+  while (last!=base) {				\
+    if (compare(first,last)>0) first=last;	\
+    last-=sz; }					\
+  if (first!=base) swapper(first,(char*)base);
+
+/* and so is the insertion sort, in the first two cases: */
+#define Insertion(swapper)			\
+  last=((char*)base)+nmemb*size;		\
+  for (first=((char*)base)+size;first!=last;first+=size) {	\
+    char *test;					\
+    /* Find the right place for |first|.	\
+     * My apologies for var reuse. */		\
+    for (test=first-size;compare(test,first)>0;test-=size) ;	\
+    test+=size;					\
+    if (test!=first) {				\
+      /* Shift everything in [test,first)	\
+       * up by one, and place |first|		\
+       * where |test| is. */			\
+      memcpy(pivot,first,size);			\
+      memmove(test+size,test,first-test);	\
+      memcpy(test,pivot,size);			\
+    }						\
+  }
+
+#define SWAP_nonaligned(a,b) { \
+  register char *aa=(a),*bb=(b); \
+  register size_t sz=size; \
+  do { register char t=*aa; *aa++=*bb; *bb++=t; } while (--sz); }
+
+#define SWAP_aligned(a,b) { \
+  register int *aa=(int*)(a),*bb=(int*)(b); \
+  register size_t sz=size; \
+  do { register int t=*aa;*aa++=*bb; *bb++=t; } while (sz-=WORD_BYTES); }
+
+#define SWAP_words(a,b) { \
+  register int t=*((int*)a); *((int*)a)=*((int*)b); *((int*)b)=t; }
+
+/* ---------------------------------------------------------------------- */
+
+static char * pivot_big(char *first, char *mid, char *last, size_t size,
+                        int compare(const void *, const void *)) {
+  int d=(((last-first)/size)>>3)*size;
+  char *m1,*m2,*m3;
+  { char *a=first, *b=first+d, *c=first+2*d;
+#ifdef DEBUG_QSORT
+fprintf(stderr,"< %d %d %d\n",*(int*)a,*(int*)b,*(int*)c);
+#endif
+    m1 = compare(a,b)<0 ?
+           (compare(b,c)<0 ? b : (compare(a,c)<0 ? c : a))
+         : (compare(a,c)<0 ? a : (compare(b,c)<0 ? c : b));
+  }
+  { char *a=mid-d, *b=mid, *c=mid+d;
+#ifdef DEBUG_QSORT
+fprintf(stderr,". %d %d %d\n",*(int*)a,*(int*)b,*(int*)c);
+#endif
+    m2 = compare(a,b)<0 ?
+           (compare(b,c)<0 ? b : (compare(a,c)<0 ? c : a))
+         : (compare(a,c)<0 ? a : (compare(b,c)<0 ? c : b));
+  }
+  { char *a=last-2*d, *b=last-d, *c=last;
+#ifdef DEBUG_QSORT
+fprintf(stderr,"> %d %d %d\n",*(int*)a,*(int*)b,*(int*)c);
+#endif
+    m3 = compare(a,b)<0 ?
+           (compare(b,c)<0 ? b : (compare(a,c)<0 ? c : a))
+         : (compare(a,c)<0 ? a : (compare(b,c)<0 ? c : b));
+  }
+#ifdef DEBUG_QSORT
+fprintf(stderr,"-> %d %d %d\n",*(int*)m1,*(int*)m2,*(int*)m3);
+#endif
+  return compare(m1,m2)<0 ?
+           (compare(m2,m3)<0 ? m2 : (compare(m1,m3)<0 ? m3 : m1))
+         : (compare(m1,m3)<0 ? m1 : (compare(m2,m3)<0 ? m3 : m2));
+}
+
+/* ---------------------------------------------------------------------- */
+
+static void qsort_nonaligned(void *base, size_t nmemb, size_t size,
+           int (*compare)(const void *, const void *)) {
+
+  stack_entry stack[STACK_SIZE];
+  int stacktop=0;
+  char *first,*last;
+  char *pivot=malloc(size);
+  size_t trunc=TRUNC_nonaligned*size;
+  assert(pivot!=0);
+
+  first=(char*)base; last=first+(nmemb-1)*size;
+
+  if ((size_t)(last-first)>trunc) {
+    char *ffirst=first, *llast=last;
+    while (1) {
+      /* Select pivot */
+      { char * mid=first+size*((last-first)/size >> 1);
+        Pivot(SWAP_nonaligned,size);
+        memcpy(pivot,mid,size);
+      }
+      /* Partition. */
+      Partition(SWAP_nonaligned,size);
+      /* Prepare to recurse/iterate. */
+      Recurse(trunc)
+    }
+  }
+  PreInsertion(SWAP_nonaligned,TRUNC_nonaligned,size);
+  Insertion(SWAP_nonaligned);
+  free(pivot);
+}
+
+static void qsort_aligned(void *base, size_t nmemb, size_t size,
+           int (*compare)(const void *, const void *)) {
+
+  stack_entry stack[STACK_SIZE];
+  int stacktop=0;
+  char *first,*last;
+  char *pivot=malloc(size);
+  size_t trunc=TRUNC_aligned*size;
+  assert(pivot!=0);
+
+  first=(char*)base; last=first+(nmemb-1)*size;
+
+  if ((size_t)(last-first)>trunc) {
+    char *ffirst=first,*llast=last;
+    while (1) {
+      /* Select pivot */
+      { char * mid=first+size*((last-first)/size >> 1);
+        Pivot(SWAP_aligned,size);
+        memcpy(pivot,mid,size);
+      }
+      /* Partition. */
+      Partition(SWAP_aligned,size);
+      /* Prepare to recurse/iterate. */
+      Recurse(trunc)
+    }
+  }
+  PreInsertion(SWAP_aligned,TRUNC_aligned,size);
+  Insertion(SWAP_aligned);
+  free(pivot);
+}
+
+static void qsort_words(void *base, size_t nmemb,
+           int (*compare)(const void *, const void *)) {
+
+  stack_entry stack[STACK_SIZE];
+  int stacktop=0;
+  char *first,*last;
+  char *pivot=malloc(WORD_BYTES);
+  assert(pivot!=0);
+
+  first=(char*)base; last=first+(nmemb-1)*WORD_BYTES;
+
+  if (last-first>TRUNC_words) {
+    char *ffirst=first, *llast=last;
+    while (1) {
+#ifdef DEBUG_QSORT
+fprintf(stderr,"Doing %d:%d: ",
+        (first-(char*)base)/WORD_BYTES,
+        (last-(char*)base)/WORD_BYTES);
+#endif
+      /* Select pivot */
+      { char * mid=first+WORD_BYTES*((last-first) / (2*WORD_BYTES));
+        Pivot(SWAP_words,WORD_BYTES);
+        *(int*)pivot=*(int*)mid;
+      }
+#ifdef DEBUG_QSORT
+fprintf(stderr,"pivot=%d\n",*(int*)pivot);
+#endif
+      /* Partition. */
+      Partition(SWAP_words,WORD_BYTES);
+      /* Prepare to recurse/iterate. */
+      Recurse(TRUNC_words)
+    }
+  }
+  PreInsertion(SWAP_words,(TRUNC_words/WORD_BYTES),WORD_BYTES);
+  /* Now do insertion sort. */
+  last=((char*)base)+nmemb*WORD_BYTES;
+  for (first=((char*)base)+WORD_BYTES;first!=last;first+=WORD_BYTES) {
+    /* Find the right place for |first|. My apologies for var reuse */
+    int *pl=(int*)(first-WORD_BYTES),*pr=(int*)first;
+    *(int*)pivot=*(int*)first;
+    for (;compare(pl,pivot)>0;pr=pl,--pl) {
+      *pr=*pl; }
+    if (pr!=(int*)first) *pr=*(int*)pivot;
+  }
+  free(pivot);
+}
+
+/* ---------------------------------------------------------------------- */
+
+void SDL_qsort(void *base, size_t nmemb, size_t size,
+           int (*compare)(const void *, const void *)) {
+
+  if (nmemb<=1) return;
+  if (((int)base|size)&(WORD_BYTES-1))
+    qsort_nonaligned(base,nmemb,size,compare);
+  else if (size!=WORD_BYTES)
+    qsort_aligned(base,nmemb,size,compare);
+  else
+    qsort_words(base,nmemb,compare);
+}
+
+#endif /* !HAVE_QSORT */
\ No newline at end of file
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/stdlib/SDL_stdlib.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,70 @@
+/*
+    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
+    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
+
+    Sam Lantinga
+    slouken@libsdl.org
+*/
+
+
+/* This file contains portable stdlib functions for SDL */
+
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+
+#ifndef HAVE_LIBC
+/* These are some C runtime intrinsics that need to be defined */
+
+#if defined(_MSC_VER)
+
+/* Float to long (FIXME!) */
+long _ftol2_sse()
+{
+	return 0;
+}
+
+/* 64-bit math operators (FIXME!) */
+void _allmul()
+{
+}
+void _alldiv()
+{
+}
+void _aulldiv()
+{
+}
+void _allrem()
+{
+}
+void _aullrem()
+{
+}
+void _alldvrm()
+{
+}
+void _aulldvrm()
+{
+}
+void _allshl()
+{
+}
+void _aullshr()
+{
+}
+
+#endif /* MSC_VER */
+
+#endif /* !HAVE_LIBC */
\ No newline at end of file
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/stdlib/SDL_string.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,1108 @@
+/*
+    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
+    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
+
+    Sam Lantinga
+    slouken@libsdl.org
+*/
+
+
+/* This file contains portable string manipulation functions for SDL */
+
+#include "SDL_types.h"
+#include "SDL_ctype.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
+
+
+#define isupperhex(X)   (((X) >= 'A') && ((X) <= 'F'))
+#define islowerhex(X)   (((X) >= 'a') && ((X) <= 'f'))
+
+#if !defined(HAVE_SSCANF) || !defined(HAVE_STRTOL)
+static size_t SDL_ScanLong(const char *text, int radix, long *valuep)
+{
+    const char *textstart = text;
+    long value = 0;
+    SDL_bool negative = SDL_FALSE;
+
+    if ( *text == '-' ) {
+        negative = SDL_TRUE;
+        ++text;
+    }
+    if ( radix == 16 && SDL_strncmp(text, "0x", 2) == 0 ) {
+        text += 2;
+    }
+    for ( ; ; ) {
+        int v;
+        if ( isdigit(*text) ) {
+            v = *text - '0';
+        } else if ( radix == 16 && isupperhex(*text) ) {
+            v = 10 + (*text - 'A');
+        } else if ( radix == 16 && islowerhex(*text) ) {
+            v = 10 + (*text - 'a');
+        } else {
+            break;
+        }
+        value *= radix;
+        value += v;
+        ++text;
+    }
+    if ( valuep ) {
+        if ( negative && value ) {
+            *valuep = -value;
+        } else {
+            *valuep = value;
+        }
+    }
+    return (text - textstart);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_SSCANF
+static size_t SDL_ScanUnsignedLong(const char *text, int radix, unsigned long *valuep)
+{
+    const char *textstart = text;
+    unsigned long value = 0;
+
+    if ( radix == 16 && SDL_strncmp(text, "0x", 2) == 0 ) {
+        text += 2;
+    }
+    for ( ; ; ) {
+        int v;
+        if ( isdigit(*text) ) {
+            v = *text - '0';
+        } else if ( radix == 16 && isupperhex(*text) ) {
+            v = 10 + (*text - 'A');
+        } else if ( radix == 16 && islowerhex(*text) ) {
+            v = 10 + (*text - 'a');
+        } else {
+            break;
+        }
+        value *= radix;
+        value += v;
+        ++text;
+    }
+    if ( valuep ) {
+        *valuep = value;
+    }
+    return (text - textstart);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE
+#if !defined(HAVE_SSCANF) || !defined(HAVE_STRTOLL)
+static size_t SDL_ScanLongLong(const char *text, int radix, Sint64 *valuep)
+{
+    const char *textstart = text;
+    Sint64 value = 0;
+    SDL_bool negative = SDL_FALSE;
+
+    if ( *text == '-' ) {
+        negative = SDL_TRUE;
+        ++text;
+    }
+    if ( radix == 16 && SDL_strncmp(text, "0x", 2) == 0 ) {
+        text += 2;
+    }
+    for ( ; ; ) {
+        int v;
+        if ( isdigit(*text) ) {
+            v = *text - '0';
+        } else if ( radix == 16 && isupperhex(*text) ) {
+            v = 10 + (*text - 'A');
+        } else if ( radix == 16 && islowerhex(*text) ) {
+            v = 10 + (*text - 'a');
+        } else {
+            break;
+        }
+        value *= radix;
+        value += v;
+        ++text;
+    }
+    if ( valuep ) {
+        if ( negative && value ) {
+            *valuep = -value;
+        } else {
+            *valuep = value;
+        }
+    }
+    return (text - textstart);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_SSCANF
+static size_t SDL_ScanUnsignedLongLong(const char *text, int radix, Uint64 *valuep)
+{
+    const char *textstart = text;
+    Uint64 value = 0;
+
+    if ( radix == 16 && SDL_strncmp(text, "0x", 2) == 0 ) {
+        text += 2;
+    }
+    for ( ; ; ) {
+        int v;
+        if ( isdigit(*text) ) {
+            v = *text - '0';
+        } else if ( radix == 16 && isupperhex(*text) ) {
+            v = 10 + (*text - 'A');
+        } else if ( radix == 16 && islowerhex(*text) ) {
+            v = 10 + (*text - 'a');
+        } else {
+            break;
+        }
+        value *= radix;
+        value += v;
+        ++text;
+    }
+    if ( valuep ) {
+        *valuep = value;
+    }
+    return (text - textstart);
+}
+#endif
+#endif /* SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE */
+
+#ifndef HAVE_SSCANF
+static size_t SDL_ScanFloat(const char *text, double *valuep)
+{
+    const char *textstart = text;
+    unsigned long lvalue = 0;
+    double value = 0.0;
+    SDL_bool negative = SDL_FALSE;
+
+    if ( *text == '-' ) {
+        negative = SDL_TRUE;
+        ++text;
+    }
+    text += SDL_ScanUnsignedLong(text, 10, &lvalue);
+    value += lvalue;
+    if ( *text == '.' ) {
+        int mult = 10;
+        ++text;
+        while ( isdigit(*text) ) {
+            lvalue = *text - '0';
+            value += (double)lvalue / mult;
+            mult *= 10;
+            ++text;
+        }
+    }
+    if ( valuep ) {
+        if ( negative && value ) {
+            *valuep = -value;
+        } else {
+            *valuep = value;
+        }
+    }
+    return (text - textstart);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SDL_memset
+void *SDL_memset(void *dst, int c, size_t len)
+{
+    size_t left = (len % 4);
+    if ( len >= 4 ) {
+        Uint32 value = 0;
+        Uint32 *dstp = (Uint32 *)dst;
+        int i;
+        for (i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
+            value <<= 8;
+            value |= c;
+        }
+        len /= 4;
+        while ( len-- ) {
+            *dstp++ = value;
+        }
+    }
+    if ( left > 0 ) {
+        Uint8 value = (Uint8)c;
+        Uint8 *dstp = (Uint8 *)dst;
+	switch(left) {
+	case 3:
+            *dstp++ = value;
+	case 2:
+            *dstp++ = value;
+	case 1:
+            *dstp++ = value;
+        }
+    }
+    return dst;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SDL_memcpy
+void *SDL_memcpy(void *dst, const void *src, size_t len)
+{
+    char *srcp = (char *)src;
+    char *dstp = (char *)dst;
+    while ( len-- ) {
+        *dstp++ = *srcp++;
+    }
+    return dst;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SDL_revcpy
+void *SDL_revcpy(void *dst, const void *src, size_t len)
+{
+    char *srcp = (char *)src;
+    char *dstp = (char *)dst;
+    srcp += len;
+    dstp += len;
+    while ( len-- ) {
+        *dstp-- = *srcp--;
+    }
+    return dst;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef SDL_memcmp
+int SDL_memcmp(const void *s1, const void *s2, size_t len)
+{
+    char *s1p = (char *)s1;
+    char *s2p = (char *)s2;
+    while ( len-- ) {
+        if ( *s1p != *s2p ) {
+            return (*s1p - *s2p);
+    }
+    ++s1p;
+    ++s2p;
+    }
+    return 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRLEN
+size_t SDL_strlen(const char *string)
+{
+    size_t len = 0;
+    while ( *string++ ) {
+        ++len;
+    }
+    return len;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRCPY
+char *SDL_strcpy(char *dst, const char *src)
+{
+    char *dstp = dst;
+    while ( *src ) {
+        *dstp++ = *src++;
+    }
+    *dstp = '\0';
+
+    return dst;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRNCPY
+char *SDL_strncpy(char *dst, const char *src, size_t maxlen)
+{
+    char *dstp = dst;
+    while ( maxlen-- && *src ) {
+        *dstp++ = *src++;
+    }
+    *dstp = '\0';
+
+    return dst;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE__STRREV
+char *SDL_strrev(char *string)
+{
+    size_t len = SDL_strlen(string);
+    char *a = &string[0];
+    char *b = &string[len-1];
+    len /= 2;
+    while ( len-- ) {
+        char c = *a;
+        *a++ = *b;
+        *b-- = c;
+    }
+    return string;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE__STRUPR
+char *SDL_strupr(char *string)
+{
+    char *bufp = string;
+    while ( *bufp ) {
+        *bufp++ = toupper(*bufp);
+    }
+    return string;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE__STRLWR
+char *SDL_strlwr(char *string)
+{
+    char *bufp = string;
+    while ( *bufp ) {
+        *bufp++ = tolower(*bufp);
+    }
+    return string;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRCHR
+char *SDL_strchr(const char *string, int c)
+{
+    while ( *string ) {
+        if ( *string == c ) {
+            return (char *)string;
+        }
+    }
+    return NULL;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRRCHR
+char *SDL_strrchr(const char *string, int c)
+{
+    const char *bufp = string + strlen(string) - 1;
+    while ( bufp >= string ) {
+        if ( *bufp == c ) {
+            return (char *)bufp;
+        }
+    }
+    return NULL;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRSTR
+char *SDL_strstr(const char *haystack, const char *needle)
+{
+    size_t length = strlen(needle);
+    while ( *haystack ) {
+        if ( strncmp(haystack, needle, length) == 0 ) {
+            return (char *)haystack;
+        }
+    }
+    return NULL;
+}
+#endif
+
+#if !defined(HAVE__LTOA)  || !defined(HAVE__I64TOA) || \
+    !defined(HAVE__ULTOA) || !defined(HAVE__UI64TOA)
+static const char ntoa_table[] = {
+    '0', '1', '2', '3', '4', '5', '6', '7', '8', '9',
+    'A', 'B', 'C', 'D', 'E', 'F', 'G', 'H', 'I', 'J',
+    'K', 'L', 'M', 'N', 'O', 'P', 'Q', 'R', 'S', 'T',
+    'U', 'V', 'W', 'X', 'Y', 'Z'
+};
+#endif /* ntoa() conversion table */
+
+#ifndef HAVE__LTOA
+char *SDL_ltoa(long value, char *string, int radix)
+{
+    char *bufp = string;
+
+    if ( value < 0 ) {
+        *bufp++ = '-';
+        value = -value;
+    }
+    if ( value ) {
+        while ( value > 0 ) {
+            *bufp++ = ntoa_table[value % radix];
+            value /= radix;
+        }
+    } else {
+        *bufp++ = '0';
+    }
+    *bufp = '\0';
+
+    /* The numbers went into the string backwards. :) */
+    if ( *string == '-' ) {
+        _strrev(string+1);
+    } else {
+        _strrev(string);
+    }
+
+    return string;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE__ULTOA
+char *SDL_ultoa(unsigned long value, char *string, int radix)
+{
+    char *bufp = string;
+
+    if ( value ) {
+        while ( value > 0 ) {
+            *bufp++ = ntoa_table[value % radix];
+            value /= radix;
+        }
+    } else {
+        *bufp++ = '0';
+    }
+    *bufp = '\0';
+
+    /* The numbers went into the string backwards. :) */
+    _strrev(string);
+
+    return string;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRTOL
+long SDL_strtol(const char *string, char **endp, int base)
+{
+    size_t len;
+    long value;
+
+    len = SDL_ScanLong(string, base ? base : 10, &value);
+    if ( endp ) {
+        *endp = (char *)string + len;
+    }
+    return value;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE
+
+#ifndef HAVE__I64TOA
+char *SDL_lltoa(Sint64 value, char *string, int radix)
+{
+    char *bufp = string;
+
+    if ( value < 0 ) {
+        *bufp++ = '-';
+        value = -value;
+    }
+    if ( value ) {
+        while ( value > 0 ) {
+            *bufp++ = ntoa_table[value % radix];
+            value /= radix;
+        }
+    } else {
+        *bufp++ = '0';
+    }
+    *bufp = '\0';
+
+    /* The numbers went into the string backwards. :) */
+    if ( *string == '-' ) {
+        _strrev(string+1);
+    } else {
+        _strrev(string);
+    }
+
+    return string;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE__UI64TOA
+char *SDL_ulltoa(Uint64 value, char *string, int radix)
+{
+    char *bufp = string;
+
+    if ( value ) {
+        while ( value > 0 ) {
+            *bufp++ = ntoa_table[value % radix];
+            value /= radix;
+        }
+    } else {
+        *bufp++ = '0';
+    }
+    *bufp = '\0';
+
+    /* The numbers went into the string backwards. :) */
+    _strrev(string);
+
+    return string;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRTOLL
+Sint64 SDL_strtoll(const char *string, char **endp, int base)
+{
+    size_t len;
+    Sint64 value;
+
+    len = SDL_ScanLongLong(string, base ? base : 10, &value);
+    if ( endp ) {
+        *endp = (char *)string + len;
+    }
+    return value;
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE */
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRCMP
+int SDL_strcmp(const char *str1, const char *str2)
+{
+    while (*str1 && *str2) {
+        if ( *str1 != *str2 )
+            break;
+        ++str1;
+        ++str2;
+    }
+    return (int)((unsigned char)*str1 - (unsigned char)*str2);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRNCMP
+int SDL_strncmp(const char *str1, const char *str2, size_t maxlen)
+{
+    while ( *str1 && *str2 && maxlen ) {
+        if ( *str1 != *str2 )
+            break;
+        ++str1;
+        ++str2;
+        --maxlen;
+    }
+    if ( ! maxlen ) {
+        return 0;
+    }
+    return (int)((unsigned char)*str1 - (unsigned char)*str2);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_STRCASECMP
+int SDL_strcasecmp(const char *str1, const char *str2)
+{
+    char a = 0;
+    char b = 0;
+    while (*str1 && *str2) {
+        a = tolower(*str1);
+        b = tolower(*str2);
+        if ( a != b )
+            break;
+        ++str1;
+        ++str2;
+    }
+    return (int)((unsigned char)a - (unsigned char)b);
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_SSCANF
+int SDL_sscanf(const char *text, const char *fmt, ...)
+{
+    va_list ap;
+    int retval = 0;
+
+    va_start(ap, fmt);
+    while ( *fmt ) {
+        if ( *fmt == ' ' ) {
+            while ( isspace(*text) ) {
+                ++text;
+            }
+            ++fmt;
+            continue;
+        }
+        if ( *fmt == '%' ) {
+            SDL_bool done = SDL_FALSE;
+            long count = 0;
+            int radix = 10;
+            enum {
+                DO_SHORT,
+                DO_INT,
+                DO_LONG,
+                DO_LONGLONG
+            } inttype = DO_INT;
+            SDL_bool suppress = SDL_FALSE;
+
+            ++fmt;
+            if ( *fmt == '%' ) {
+                if ( *text == '%' ) {
+                    ++text;
+                    ++fmt;
+                    continue;
+                }
+                break;
+            }
+            if ( *fmt == '*' ) {
+                suppress = SDL_TRUE;
+                ++fmt;
+            }
+            fmt += SDL_ScanLong(fmt, 10, &count);
+
+            if ( *fmt == 'c' ) {
+                if ( ! count ) {
+                    count = 1;
+                }
+                if ( suppress ) {
+                    while ( count-- ) {
+                        ++text;
+                    }
+                } else {
+                    char *valuep = va_arg(ap, char*);
+                    while ( count-- ) {
+                        *valuep++ = *text++;
+                    }
+                    ++retval;
+                }
+                continue;
+            }
+
+            while ( isspace(*text) ) {
+                ++text;
+            }
+
+            /* FIXME: implement more of the format specifiers */
+            while (!done) {
+                switch(*fmt) {
+                    case '*':
+                        suppress = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    case 'h':
+                        if ( inttype > DO_SHORT ) {
+                            ++inttype;
+                        }
+                        break;
+                    case 'l':
+                        if ( inttype < DO_LONGLONG ) {
+                            ++inttype;
+                        }
+                        break;
+                    case 'I':
+                        if ( SDL_strncmp(fmt, "I64", 3) == 0 ) {
+                            fmt += 2;
+                            inttype = DO_LONGLONG;
+                        }
+                        break;
+                    case 'i':
+                        {
+                            int index = 0;
+                            if ( text[index] == '-' ) {
+                                ++index;
+                            }
+                            if ( text[index] == '0' ) {
+                                if ( tolower(text[index+1]) == 'x' ) {
+                                    radix = 16;
+                                } else {
+                                    radix = 8;
+                                }
+                            }
+                        }
+                        /* Fall through to %d handling */
+                    case 'd':
+#ifdef SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE
+                        if ( inttype == DO_LONGLONG ) {
+                            Sint64 value;
+                            text += SDL_ScanLongLong(text, radix, &value);
+                            if ( ! suppress ) {
+                                Sint64 *valuep = va_arg(ap, Sint64*);
+                                *valuep = value;
+                                ++retval;
+                            }
+                        }
+                        else
+#endif /* SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE */
+                        {
+                            long value;
+                            text += SDL_ScanLong(text, radix, &value);
+                            if ( ! suppress ) {
+                                switch (inttype) {
+                                    case DO_SHORT:
+                                        { short* valuep = va_arg(ap, short*);
+                                            *valuep = (short)value;
+                                        }
+                                        break;
+                                    case DO_INT:
+                                        { int* valuep = va_arg(ap, int*);
+                                            *valuep = (int)value;
+                                        }
+                                        break;
+                                    case DO_LONG:
+                                        { long* valuep = va_arg(ap, long*);
+                                            *valuep = value;
+                                        }
+                                        break;
+                                    case DO_LONGLONG:
+                                        /* Handled above */
+                                        break;
+                                }
+                                ++retval;
+                            }
+                        }
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    case 'o':
+                        if ( radix == 10 ) {
+                            radix = 8;
+                        }
+                        /* Fall through to unsigned handling */
+                    case 'x':
+                    case 'X':
+                        if ( radix == 10 ) {
+                            radix = 16;
+                        }
+                        /* Fall through to unsigned handling */
+                    case 'u':
+#ifdef SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE
+                        if ( inttype == DO_LONGLONG ) {
+                            Uint64 value;
+                            text += SDL_ScanUnsignedLongLong(text, radix, &value);
+                            if ( ! suppress ) {
+                                Uint64 *valuep = va_arg(ap, Uint64*);
+                                *valuep = value;
+                                ++retval;
+                            }
+                        }
+                        else
+#endif /* SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE */
+                        {
+                            unsigned long value;
+                            text += SDL_ScanUnsignedLong(text, radix, &value);
+                            if ( ! suppress ) {
+                                switch (inttype) {
+                                    case DO_SHORT:
+                                        { short* valuep = va_arg(ap, short*);
+                                            *valuep = (short)value;
+                                        }
+                                        break;
+                                    case DO_INT:
+                                        { int* valuep = va_arg(ap, int*);
+                                            *valuep = (int)value;
+                                        }
+                                        break;
+                                    case DO_LONG:
+                                        { long* valuep = va_arg(ap, long*);
+                                            *valuep = value;
+                                        }
+                                        break;
+                                    case DO_LONGLONG:
+                                        /* Handled above */
+                                        break;
+                                }
+                                ++retval;
+                            }
+                        }
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    case 'p':
+                        {
+                            unsigned long value;
+                            text += SDL_ScanUnsignedLong(text, 16, &value);
+                            if ( ! suppress ) {
+                                void** valuep = va_arg(ap, void**);
+                                *valuep = (void*)value;
+                                ++retval;
+                            }
+                        }
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    case 'f':
+                        {
+                            double value;
+                            text += SDL_ScanFloat(text, &value);
+                            if ( ! suppress ) {
+                                float* valuep = va_arg(ap, float*);
+                                *valuep = (float)value;
+                                ++retval;
+                            }
+                        }
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    case 's':
+                        if ( suppress ) {
+                            while ( !isspace(*text) ) {
+                                ++text;
+                                if ( count ) {
+                                    if ( --count == 0 ) {
+                                        break;
+                                    }
+                                }
+                            }
+                        } else {
+                            char *valuep = va_arg(ap, char*);
+                            while ( !isspace(*text) ) {
+                                *valuep++ = *text++;
+                                if ( count ) {
+                                    if ( --count == 0 ) {
+                                        break;
+                                    }
+                                }
+                            }
+                            *valuep = '\0';
+                            ++retval;
+                        }
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    default:
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                }
+                ++fmt;
+            }
+            continue;
+        }
+        if ( *text == *fmt ) {
+            ++text;
+            ++fmt;
+            continue;
+        }
+        /* Text didn't match format specifier */
+        break;
+    }
+    va_end(ap);
+
+    return retval;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_SNPRINTF
+int SDL_snprintf(char *text, size_t maxlen, const char *fmt, ...)
+{
+    va_list ap;
+    int retval;
+
+    va_start(ap, fmt);
+    retval = SDL_vsnprintf(text, maxlen, fmt, ap);
+    va_end(ap);
+
+    return retval;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifndef HAVE_VSNPRINTF
+static size_t SDL_PrintLong(char *text, long value, int radix, size_t maxlen)
+{
+    char num[130];
+    size_t size;
+
+    _ltoa(value, num, radix);
+    size = SDL_strlen(num);
+    if ( size > maxlen ) {
+        size = maxlen;
+    }
+    strncpy(text, num, size);
+
+    return size;
+}
+static size_t SDL_PrintUnsignedLong(char *text, unsigned long value, int radix, size_t maxlen)
+{
+    char num[130];
+    size_t size;
+
+    _ultoa(value, num, radix);
+    size = SDL_strlen(num);
+    if ( size > maxlen ) {
+        size = maxlen;
+    }
+    strncpy(text, num, size);
+
+    return size;
+}
+#ifdef SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE
+static size_t SDL_PrintLongLong(char *text, Sint64 value, int radix, size_t maxlen)
+{
+    char num[130];
+    size_t size;
+
+    _i64toa(value, num, radix);
+    size = SDL_strlen(num);
+    if ( size > maxlen ) {
+        size = maxlen;
+    }
+    strncpy(text, num, size);
+
+    return size;
+}
+static size_t SDL_PrintUnsignedLongLong(char *text, Uint64 value, int radix, size_t maxlen)
+{
+    char num[130];
+    size_t size;
+
+    _ui64toa(value, num, radix);
+    size = SDL_strlen(num);
+    if ( size > maxlen ) {
+        size = maxlen;
+    }
+    strncpy(text, num, size);
+
+    return size;
+}
+#endif /* SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE */
+static size_t SDL_PrintFloat(char *text, double arg, size_t maxlen)
+{
+    char *textstart = text;
+    if ( arg ) {
+        /* This isn't especially accurate, but hey, it's easy. :) */
+        const double precision = 0.00000001;
+        size_t len;
+        unsigned long value;
+
+        if ( arg < 0 ) {
+            *text++ = '-';
+            --maxlen;
+            arg = -arg;
+        }
+        value = (unsigned long)arg;
+        len = SDL_PrintUnsignedLong(text, value, 10, maxlen);
+        text += len;
+        maxlen -= len;
+        arg -= value;
+        if ( arg > precision && maxlen ) {
+            int mult = 10;
+            *text++ = '.';
+            while ( (arg > precision) && maxlen ) {
+                value = (unsigned long)(arg * mult);
+                len = SDL_PrintUnsignedLong(text, value, 10, maxlen);
+                text += len;
+                maxlen -= len;
+                arg -= (double)value / mult;
+                mult *= 10;
+            }
+        }
+    } else {
+        *text++ = '0';
+    }
+    return (text - textstart);
+}
+static size_t SDL_PrintString(char *text, const char *string, size_t maxlen)
+{
+    char *textstart = text;
+    while ( *string && maxlen-- ) {
+        *text++ = *string++;
+    }
+    return (text - textstart);
+}
+int  SDL_vsnprintf(char *text, size_t maxlen, const char *fmt, va_list ap)
+{
+    char *textstart = text;
+    if ( maxlen <= 0 ) {
+        return 0;
+    }
+    --maxlen; /* For the trailing '\0' */
+    while ( *fmt && maxlen ) {
+        if ( *fmt == '%' ) {
+            SDL_bool done = SDL_FALSE;
+            size_t len = 0;
+            SDL_bool do_lowercase = SDL_FALSE;
+            int radix = 10;
+            enum {
+                DO_INT,
+                DO_LONG,
+                DO_LONGLONG
+            } inttype = DO_INT;
+
+            ++fmt;
+            /* FIXME: implement more of the format specifiers */
+            while (!done) {
+                switch(*fmt) {
+                    case '%':
+                        *text = '%';
+                        len = 1;
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    case 'c':
+                        /* char is promoted to int when passed through (...) */
+                        *text = (char)va_arg(ap, int);
+                        len = 1;
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    case 'h':
+                        /* short is promoted to int when passed through (...) */
+                        break;
+                    case 'l':
+                        if ( inttype < DO_LONGLONG ) {
+                            ++inttype;
+                        }
+                        break;
+                    case 'I':
+                        if ( SDL_strncmp(fmt, "I64", 3) == 0 ) {
+                            fmt += 2;
+                            inttype = DO_LONGLONG;
+                        }
+                        break;
+                    case 'i':
+                    case 'd':
+                        switch (inttype) {
+                            case DO_INT:
+                                len = SDL_PrintLong(text, (long)va_arg(ap, int), radix, maxlen);
+                                break;
+                            case DO_LONG:
+                                len = SDL_PrintLong(text, va_arg(ap, long), radix, maxlen);
+                                break;
+                            case DO_LONGLONG:
+#ifdef SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE
+                                len = SDL_PrintLongLong(text, va_arg(ap, Sint64), radix, maxlen);
+#else
+                                len = SDL_PrintLong(text, va_arg(ap, long), radix, maxlen);
+#endif
+                                break;
+                        }
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    case 'p':
+                    case 'x':
+                        do_lowercase = SDL_TRUE;
+                        /* Fall through to 'X' handling */
+                    case 'X':
+                        if ( radix == 10 ) {
+                            radix = 16;
+                        }
+                        if ( *fmt == 'p' ) {
+                            inttype = DO_LONG;
+                        }
+                        /* Fall through to unsigned handling */
+                    case 'o':
+                        if ( radix == 10 ) {
+                            radix = 8;
+                        }
+                        /* Fall through to unsigned handling */
+                    case 'u':
+                        switch (inttype) {
+                            case DO_INT:
+                                len = SDL_PrintUnsignedLong(text, (unsigned long)va_arg(ap, unsigned int), radix, maxlen);
+                                break;
+                            case DO_LONG:
+                                len = SDL_PrintUnsignedLong(text, va_arg(ap, unsigned long), radix, maxlen);
+                                break;
+                            case DO_LONGLONG:
+#ifdef SDL_HAS_64BIT_TYPE
+                                len = SDL_PrintUnsignedLongLong(text, va_arg(ap, Uint64), radix, maxlen);
+#else
+                                len = SDL_PrintUnsignedLong(text, va_arg(ap, unsigned long), radix, maxlen);
+#endif
+                                break;
+                        }
+                        if ( do_lowercase ) {
+                            _strlwr(text);
+                        }
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    case 'f':
+                        len = SDL_PrintFloat(text, va_arg(ap, double), maxlen);
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    case 's':
+                        len = SDL_PrintString(text, va_arg(ap, char*), maxlen);
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                    default:
+                        done = SDL_TRUE;
+                        break;
+                }
+                ++fmt;
+            }
+            text += len;
+            maxlen -= len;
+        } else {
+            *text++ = *fmt++;
+            --maxlen;
+        }
+    }
+    *text = '\0';
+
+    return (text - textstart);
+}
+#endif
--- a/src/thread/SDL_systhread.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/SDL_systhread.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -28,7 +28,7 @@
    saves a system-dependent thread id in thread->id, and returns 0
    on success.
 */
-#ifdef __OS2__
+#if defined(_WIN32) || defined(__OS2__)
 extern int SDL_SYS_CreateThread(SDL_Thread *thread, void *args, pfnSDL_CurrentBeginThread pfnBeginThread, pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread pfnEndThread);
 #else
 extern int SDL_SYS_CreateThread(SDL_Thread *thread, void *args);
--- a/src/thread/SDL_thread.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/SDL_thread.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,13 +22,11 @@
 
 /* System independent thread management routines for SDL */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_mutex.h"
 #include "SDL_thread.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_thread_c.h"
 #include "SDL_systhread.h"
 
@@ -213,8 +211,9 @@
 	*statusloc = userfunc(userdata);
 }
 
-#ifdef __OS2__
-DECLSPEC SDL_Thread * SDLCALL SDL_CreateThread_Core(int (*fn)(void *), void *data, pfnSDL_CurrentBeginThread pfnBeginThread, pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread pfnEndThread)
+#if defined(_WIN32) || defined(__OS2__)
+#undef SDL_CreateThread
+DECLSPEC SDL_Thread * SDLCALL SDL_CreateThread(int (*fn)(void *), void *data, pfnSDL_CurrentBeginThread pfnBeginThread, pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread pfnEndThread)
 #else
 DECLSPEC SDL_Thread * SDLCALL SDL_CreateThread(int (*fn)(void *), void *data)
 #endif
@@ -253,8 +252,8 @@
 	SDL_AddThread(thread);
 
 	/* Create the thread and go! */
-#ifdef __OS2__
-        ret = SDL_SYS_CreateThread(thread, args, pfnBeginThread, pfnEndThread);
+#if defined(_WIN32) || defined(__OS2__)
+	ret = SDL_SYS_CreateThread(thread, args, pfnBeginThread, pfnEndThread);
 #else
 	ret = SDL_SYS_CreateThread(thread, args);
 #endif
--- a/src/thread/generic/SDL_syscond.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/generic/SDL_syscond.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -26,11 +26,9 @@
    implementation, written by Christopher Tate and Owen Smith.  Thanks!
  */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_thread.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
 
 struct SDL_cond
 {
--- a/src/thread/generic/SDL_sysmutex.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/generic/SDL_sysmutex.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,11 +22,9 @@
 
 /* An implementation of mutexes using semaphores */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_thread.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
 #include "SDL_systhread_c.h"
 
 
--- a/src/thread/generic/SDL_syssem.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/generic/SDL_syssem.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,11 +22,10 @@
 
 /* An implementation of semaphores using mutexes and condition variables */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_timer.h"
 #include "SDL_thread.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
 #include "SDL_systhread_c.h"
 
 
--- a/src/thread/os2/SDL_systhread.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/os2/SDL_systhread.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -72,7 +72,7 @@
   // Also save the real parameters we have to pass to thread function
   pThreadParms->args = args;
   // Start the thread using the runtime library of calling app!
-  thread->threadid = thread->handle = (*pfnBeginThread)(threadfunc, 512*1024, pThreadParms);
+  thread->threadid = thread->handle = (*pfnBeginThread)(threadfunc, NULL, 512*1024, pThreadParms);
   if (thread->threadid<=0)
   {
     SDL_SetError("Not enough resources to create thread");
--- a/src/thread/win32/SDL_sysmutex.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/win32/SDL_sysmutex.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,12 +22,11 @@
 
 /* Mutex functions using the Win32 API */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_mutex.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
 
 
 struct SDL_mutex {
--- a/src/thread/win32/SDL_syssem.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/win32/SDL_syssem.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,12 +22,11 @@
 
 /* Semaphore functions using the Win32 API */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_thread.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
 #if defined(_WIN32_WCE) && (_WIN32_WCE < 300)
 #include "win_ce_semaphore.h"
 #endif
--- a/src/thread/win32/SDL_systhread.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/win32/SDL_systhread.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,43 +22,59 @@
 
 /* Win32 thread management routines for SDL */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <windows.h>
-
-#ifndef _WIN32_WCE
-#include <process.h>
-#endif
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_thread.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
 #include "SDL_systhread.h"
 
+typedef struct ThreadStartParms
+{
+  void *args;
+  pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread pfnCurrentEndThread;
+} tThreadStartParms, *pThreadStartParms;
 
 static unsigned __stdcall RunThread(void *data)
 {
-	SDL_RunThread(data);
-	return(0);
+  pThreadStartParms pThreadParms = (pThreadStartParms)data;
+  pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread pfnCurrentEndThread = NULL;
+
+  // Call the thread function!
+  SDL_RunThread(pThreadParms->args);
+
+  // Get the current endthread we have to use!
+  if (pThreadParms)
+  {
+    pfnCurrentEndThread = pThreadParms->pfnCurrentEndThread;
+    free(pThreadParms);
+  }
+  // Call endthread!
+  if (pfnCurrentEndThread)
+    (*pfnCurrentEndThread)(0);
+  return(0);
 }
 
-int SDL_SYS_CreateThread(SDL_Thread *thread, void *args)
+int SDL_SYS_CreateThread(SDL_Thread *thread, void *args, pfnSDL_CurrentBeginThread pfnBeginThread, pfnSDL_CurrentEndThread pfnEndThread)
 {
 	unsigned threadid;
+    pThreadStartParms pThreadParms = (pThreadStartParms)malloc(sizeof(tThreadStartParms));
+    if (!pThreadParms) {
+		SDL_OutOfMemory();
+        return(-1);
+    }
 
-	/*
-	 * Avoid CreateThread: https://bugzilla.libsdl.org/show_bug.cgi?id=22
-	 *
-	 * have to use _beginthreadex if we want the returned handle
-	 * to be accessible after the thread exits
-	 * threads created with _beginthread auto-close the handle
-	 * Windows CE still use CreateThread.
-	 */
-#ifdef _WIN32_WCE
-	thread->handle = CreateThread(NULL, 0, RunThread, args, 0, &threadid);
-#else
-	thread->handle = (SYS_ThreadHandle) _beginthreadex(NULL, 0, RunThread,
-			args, 0, &threadid);
-#endif
+    // Save the function which we will have to call to clear the RTL of calling app!
+    pThreadParms->pfnCurrentEndThread = pfnEndThread;
+    // Also save the real parameters we have to pass to thread function
+    pThreadParms->args = args;
+
+	if (pfnBeginThread) {
+		thread->handle = (SYS_ThreadHandle) pfnBeginThread(NULL, 0, RunThread,
+				pThreadParms, 0, &threadid);
+	} else {
+		thread->handle = CreateThread(NULL, 0, RunThread, pThreadParms, 0, &threadid);
+	}
 	if (thread->handle == NULL) {
 		SDL_SetError("Not enough resources to create thread");
 		return(-1);
--- a/src/thread/win32/SDL_systhread_c.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/win32/SDL_systhread_c.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 typedef HANDLE SYS_ThreadHandle;
 
--- a/src/thread/win32/win_ce_semaphore.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/thread/win32/win_ce_semaphore.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -28,7 +28,7 @@
       and it is not clear how to handle a mixture of WCE semaphores and normal
       events and mutexes. */
 
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 #include "win_ce_semaphore.h"
 
 static SYNCHHANDLE CleanUp (SYNCHHANDLE hSynch, DWORD Flags);
--- a/src/timer/SDL_timer.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/timer/SDL_timer.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,11 +20,9 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <stdio.h>			/* For the definition of NULL */
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_timer.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
 #include "SDL_timer_c.h"
 #include "SDL_mutex.h"
 #include "SDL_systimer.h"
--- a/src/timer/win32/SDL_systimer.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/timer/win32/SDL_systimer.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 #include <mmsystem.h>
 
 #include "SDL_timer.h"
--- a/src/timer/wince/SDL_systimer.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/timer/wince/SDL_systimer.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 #include <mmsystem.h>
 
 #include "SDL_timer.h"
--- a/src/video/Makefile.am	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/Makefile.am	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -30,7 +30,6 @@
 	SDL_gamma.c		\
 	SDL_glfuncs.h		\
 	SDL_leaks.h		\
-	SDL_memops.h		\
 	SDL_pixels.c		\
 	SDL_pixels_c.h		\
 	SDL_surface.c		\
@@ -44,6 +43,10 @@
 	SDL_yuv_sw_c.h		\
 	SDL_yuv_mmx.c		\
 	mmx.h			\
+	math_private.h		\
+	e_log.h			\
+	e_pow.h			\
+	e_sqrt.h		\
 	blank_cursor.h		\
 	default_cursor.h
 
--- a/src/video/SDL_RLEaccel.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_RLEaccel.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -85,16 +85,13 @@
  *   beginning of an opaque line.
  */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
-#include "SDL_memops.h"
 #include "SDL_RLEaccel_c.h"
 
 #if (defined(i386) || defined(__x86_64__)) && defined(__GNUC__) && defined(USE_ASMBLIT)
--- a/src/video/SDL_blit.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_blit.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,17 +20,13 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
 #include "SDL_RLEaccel_c.h"
 #include "SDL_pixels_c.h"
-#include "SDL_memops.h"
 
 #if (defined(i386) || defined(__x86_64__)) && defined(__GNUC__) && defined(USE_ASMBLIT)
 #define MMX_ASMBLIT
--- a/src/video/SDL_blit_0.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_blit_0.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,11 +20,9 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
 
 /* Functions to blit from bitmaps to other surfaces */
--- a/src/video/SDL_blit_1.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_blit_1.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,8 +20,6 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
--- a/src/video/SDL_blit_A.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_blit_A.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,8 +20,6 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
--- a/src/video/SDL_blit_N.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_blit_N.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,8 +20,6 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-
 #include "SDL_types.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
--- a/src/video/SDL_bmp.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_bmp.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -34,11 +34,10 @@
    This code currently supports Win32 DIBs in uncompressed 8 and 24 bpp.
 */
 
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_endian.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 
 /* Compression encodings for BMP files */
 #ifndef BI_RGB
@@ -238,7 +237,7 @@
 	}
 
 	/* Read the surface pixels.  Note that the bmp image is upside down */
-	if ( SDL_RWseek(src, fp_offset+bfOffBits, SEEK_SET) < 0 ) {
+	if ( SDL_RWseek(src, fp_offset+bfOffBits, RW_SEEK_SET) < 0 ) {
 		SDL_Error(SDL_EFSEEK);
 		was_error = 1;
 		goto done;
@@ -319,7 +318,7 @@
 done:
 	if ( was_error ) {
 		if ( src ) {
-			SDL_RWseek(src, fp_offset, SEEK_SET);
+			SDL_RWseek(src, fp_offset, RW_SEEK_SET);
 		}
 		if ( surface ) {
 			SDL_FreeSurface(surface);
@@ -475,11 +474,11 @@
 
 		/* Write the bitmap offset */
 		bfOffBits = SDL_RWtell(dst)-fp_offset;
-		if ( SDL_RWseek(dst, fp_offset+10, SEEK_SET) < 0 ) {
+		if ( SDL_RWseek(dst, fp_offset+10, RW_SEEK_SET) < 0 ) {
 			SDL_Error(SDL_EFSEEK);
 		}
 		SDL_WriteLE32(dst, bfOffBits);
-		if ( SDL_RWseek(dst, fp_offset+bfOffBits, SEEK_SET) < 0 ) {
+		if ( SDL_RWseek(dst, fp_offset+bfOffBits, RW_SEEK_SET) < 0 ) {
 			SDL_Error(SDL_EFSEEK);
 		}
 
@@ -502,11 +501,11 @@
 
 		/* Write the BMP file size */
 		bfSize = SDL_RWtell(dst)-fp_offset;
-		if ( SDL_RWseek(dst, fp_offset+2, SEEK_SET) < 0 ) {
+		if ( SDL_RWseek(dst, fp_offset+2, RW_SEEK_SET) < 0 ) {
 			SDL_Error(SDL_EFSEEK);
 		}
 		SDL_WriteLE32(dst, bfSize);
-		if ( SDL_RWseek(dst, fp_offset+bfSize, SEEK_SET) < 0 ) {
+		if ( SDL_RWseek(dst, fp_offset+bfSize, RW_SEEK_SET) < 0 ) {
 			SDL_Error(SDL_EFSEEK);
 		}
 
--- a/src/video/SDL_cursor.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_cursor.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,14 +22,12 @@
 
 /* General cursor handling code for SDL */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_mutex.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_mouse.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
--- a/src/video/SDL_gamma.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_gamma.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,18 +22,26 @@
 
 /* Gamma correction support */
 
-#define USE_MATH_H	/* Used for calculating gamma ramps */
+#include "SDL_config.h"
 
-#ifdef USE_MATH_H
-#include <math.h>
+#ifdef HAVE_MATH_H
+#include <math.h>	/* Used for calculating gamma ramps */
 #endif
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
 
 #include "SDL_error.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
 
-#ifdef USE_MATH_H
+#ifndef HAVE_MATH_H
+#include "math_private.h"
+#include "e_sqrt.h"
+#include "e_pow.h"
+#include "e_log.h"
+#define pow(x, y)	__ieee754_pow(x, y)
+#define log(x)		__ieee754_log(x)
+#endif
+
 static void CalculateGammaRamp(float gamma, Uint16 *ramp)
 {
 	int i;
@@ -85,7 +93,6 @@
 		*gamma = 1.0f / (sum / count);
 	}
 }
-#endif /* USE_MATH_H */
 
 int SDL_SetGamma(float red, float green, float blue)
 {
@@ -94,7 +101,6 @@
 	SDL_VideoDevice *this  = current_video;	
 
 	succeeded = -1;
-#ifdef USE_MATH_H
 	/* Prefer using SetGammaRamp(), as it's more flexible */
 	{
 		Uint16 ramp[3][256];
@@ -104,9 +110,6 @@
 		CalculateGammaRamp(blue, ramp[2]);
 		succeeded = SDL_SetGammaRamp(ramp[0], ramp[1], ramp[2]);
 	}
-#else
-	SDL_SetError("Gamma correction not supported");
-#endif
 	if ( (succeeded < 0) && video->SetGamma ) {
 		SDL_ClearError();
 		succeeded = video->SetGamma(this, red, green, blue);
@@ -124,7 +127,6 @@
 	SDL_VideoDevice *this  = current_video;	
 
 	succeeded = -1;
-#ifdef USE_MATH_H
 	/* Prefer using GetGammaRamp(), as it's more flexible */
 	{
 		Uint16 ramp[3][256];
@@ -136,9 +138,6 @@
 			CalculateGammaFromRamp(blue, ramp[2]);
 		}
 	}
-#else
-	SDL_SetError("Gamma correction not supported");
-#endif
 	if ( (succeeded < 0) && video->GetGamma ) {
 		SDL_ClearError();
 		succeeded = video->GetGamma(this, red, green, blue);
--- a/src/video/SDL_memops.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
@@ -1,139 +0,0 @@
-/*
-    SDL - Simple DirectMedia Layer
-    Copyright (C) 1997-2006 Sam Lantinga
-
-    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
-    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
-    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
-    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
-
-    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
-    Lesser General Public License for more details.
-
-    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
-    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
-    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA  02110-1301  USA
-
-    Sam Lantinga
-    slouken@libsdl.org
-*/
-
-#ifndef _SDL_memops_h
-#define _SDL_memops_h
-
-/* System dependent optimized memory manipulation routines:
-*/
-#include <string.h>
-
-#if defined(__GNUC__) && defined(i386)
-/* Thanks to Brennan "Bas" Underwood, for the inspiration. :)
- */
-#define SDL_memcpy(dst, src, len)					  \
-do {									  \
-	int u0, u1, u2;						  \
-	__asm__ __volatile__ (						  \
-		"cld\n\t"						  \
-		"rep ; movsl\n\t"					  \
-		"testb $2,%b4\n\t"					  \
-		"je 1f\n\t"						  \
-		"movsw\n"						  \
-		"1:\ttestb $1,%b4\n\t"					  \
-		"je 2f\n\t"						  \
-		"movsb\n"						  \
-		"2:"							  \
-		: "=&c" (u0), "=&D" (u1), "=&S" (u2)			  \
-		: "0" ((unsigned)(len)/4), "q" (len), "1" (dst),"2" (src) \
-		: "memory" );						  \
-} while(0)
-
-#define SDL_memcpy4(dst, src, len)				\
-do {								\
-	int ecx, edi, esi;					\
-	__asm__ __volatile__ (					\
-		"cld\n\t"					\
-		"rep ; movsl"					\
-		: "=&c" (ecx), "=&D" (edi), "=&S" (esi)		\
-		: "0" ((unsigned)(len)), "1" (dst), "2" (src)	\
-		: "memory" );					\
-} while(0)
-
-#define SDL_revcpy(dst, src, len)			\
-do {							\
-	int u0, u1, u2;					\
-	char *dstp = (char *)(dst);			\
-	char *srcp = (char *)(src);			\
-	int n = (len);					\
-	if ( n >= 4 ) {					\
-	__asm__ __volatile__ (				\
-		"std\n\t"				\
-		"rep ; movsl\n\t"			\
-		: "=&c" (u0), "=&D" (u1), "=&S" (u2)	\
-		: "0" (n >> 2),				\
-		  "1" (dstp+(n-4)), "2" (srcp+(n-4))	\
-		: "memory" );				\
-	}						\
-	switch (n & 3) {				\
-		case 3: dstp[2] = srcp[2];		\
-		case 2: dstp[1] = srcp[1];		\
-		case 1: dstp[0] = srcp[0];		\
-			break;				\
-		default:				\
-			break;				\
-	}						\
-} while(0)
-
-#define SDL_memmove(dst, src, len)			\
-do {							\
-	if ( (dst) < (src) ) {				\
-		SDL_memcpy((dst), (src), (len));	\
-	} else {					\
-		SDL_revcpy((dst), (src), (len));	\
-	}						\
-} while(0)
-
-#define SDL_memset4(dst, val, len)				\
-do {								\
-	int u0, u1, u2;					\
-	__asm__ __volatile__ (					\
-		"cld\n\t"					\
-		"rep ; stosl\n\t"				\
-		: "=&D" (u0), "=&a" (u1), "=&c" (u2)		\
-		: "0" (dst), "1" (val), "2" ((Uint32)(len))	\
-		: "memory" );					\
-} while(0)
-
-#endif /* GNU C and x86 */
-
-/* If there are no optimized versions, define the normal versions */
-#ifndef SDL_memcpy
-#define SDL_memcpy(dst, src, len)	memcpy(dst, src, len)
-#endif
-
-#ifndef SDL_memcpy4
-#define SDL_memcpy4(dst, src, len)	memcpy(dst, src, (len) << 2)
-#endif
-
-#ifndef SDL_revcpy
-#define SDL_revcpy(dst, src, len)	memmove(dst, src, len)
-#endif
-
-#ifndef SDL_memset4
-#define SDL_memset4(dst, val, len)		\
-do {						\
-	unsigned _count = (len);		\
-	unsigned _n = (_count + 3) / 4;		\
-	Uint32 *_p = (Uint32 *)(dst);		\
-	Uint32 _val = (val);			\
-        switch (_count % 4) {			\
-        case 0: do {    *_p++ = _val;		\
-        case 3:         *_p++ = _val;		\
-        case 2:         *_p++ = _val;		\
-        case 1:         *_p++ = _val;		\
-		} while ( --_n );		\
-	}					\
-} while(0)
-#endif
-
-#endif /* _SDL_memops_h */
--- a/src/video/SDL_pixels.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_pixels.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,13 +22,11 @@
 
 /* General (mostly internal) pixel/color manipulation routines for SDL */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_endian.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
 #include "SDL_pixels_c.h"
--- a/src/video/SDL_surface.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_surface.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,18 +20,15 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
 #include "SDL_cursor_c.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
 #include "SDL_RLEaccel_c.h"
 #include "SDL_pixels_c.h"
-#include "SDL_memops.h"
 #include "SDL_leaks.h"
 
 
--- a/src/video/SDL_sysvideo.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_sysvideo.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -37,8 +37,7 @@
 #ifndef _WIN32_WCE
 #define HAVE_OPENGL
 #endif
-#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 #endif
 
 #ifdef HAVE_OPENGL
--- a/src/video/SDL_video.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_video.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,15 +22,13 @@
 
 /* The high-level video driver subsystem */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_events.h"
 #include "SDL_mutex.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
 #include "SDL_sysevents.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
--- a/src/video/SDL_yuv.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_yuv.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,12 +22,9 @@
 
 /* This is the implementation of the YUV video surface support */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
-#include "SDL_getenv.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
 #include "SDL_yuvfuncs.h"
 #include "SDL_yuv_sw_c.h"
@@ -57,7 +54,7 @@
 	overlay = NULL;
         yuv_hwaccel = getenv("SDL_VIDEO_YUV_HWACCEL");
 	if ( ((display == SDL_VideoSurface) && video->CreateYUVOverlay) &&
-	     (!yuv_hwaccel || (atoi(yuv_hwaccel) > 0)) ) {
+	     (!yuv_hwaccel || (*yuv_hwaccel != '0')) ) {
 		overlay = video->CreateYUVOverlay(this, w, h, format, display);
 	}
 	/* If hardware YUV overlay failed ... */
--- a/src/video/SDL_yuv_sw.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/SDL_yuv_sw.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -82,12 +82,11 @@
  * SUPPORT, UPDATES, ENHANCEMENTS, OR MODIFICATIONS.
  */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_cpuinfo.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_stretch_c.h"
 #include "SDL_yuvfuncs.h"
 #include "SDL_yuv_sw_c.h"
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/video/e_log.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,140 @@
+/* @(#)e_log.c 5.1 93/09/24 */
+/*
+ * ====================================================
+ * Copyright (C) 1993 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Developed at SunPro, a Sun Microsystems, Inc. business.
+ * Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
+ * software is freely granted, provided that this notice
+ * is preserved.
+ * ====================================================
+ */
+
+#if defined(LIBM_SCCS) && !defined(lint)
+static char rcsid[] = "$NetBSD: e_log.c,v 1.8 1995/05/10 20:45:49 jtc Exp $";
+#endif
+
+/* __ieee754_log(x)
+ * Return the logrithm of x
+ *
+ * Method :
+ *   1. Argument Reduction: find k and f such that
+ *			x = 2^k * (1+f),
+ *	   where  sqrt(2)/2 < 1+f < sqrt(2) .
+ *
+ *   2. Approximation of log(1+f).
+ *	Let s = f/(2+f) ; based on log(1+f) = log(1+s) - log(1-s)
+ *		 = 2s + 2/3 s**3 + 2/5 s**5 + .....,
+ *	     	 = 2s + s*R
+ *      We use a special Reme algorithm on [0,0.1716] to generate
+ * 	a polynomial of degree 14 to approximate R The maximum error
+ *	of this polynomial approximation is bounded by 2**-58.45. In
+ *	other words,
+ *		        2      4      6      8      10      12      14
+ *	    R(z) ~ Lg1*s +Lg2*s +Lg3*s +Lg4*s +Lg5*s  +Lg6*s  +Lg7*s
+ *  	(the values of Lg1 to Lg7 are listed in the program)
+ *	and
+ *	    |      2          14          |     -58.45
+ *	    | Lg1*s +...+Lg7*s    -  R(z) | <= 2
+ *	    |                             |
+ *	Note that 2s = f - s*f = f - hfsq + s*hfsq, where hfsq = f*f/2.
+ *	In order to guarantee error in log below 1ulp, we compute log
+ *	by
+ *		log(1+f) = f - s*(f - R)	(if f is not too large)
+ *		log(1+f) = f - (hfsq - s*(hfsq+R)).	(better accuracy)
+ *
+ *	3. Finally,  log(x) = k*ln2 + log(1+f).
+ *			    = k*ln2_hi+(f-(hfsq-(s*(hfsq+R)+k*ln2_lo)))
+ *	   Here ln2 is split into two floating point number:
+ *			ln2_hi + ln2_lo,
+ *	   where n*ln2_hi is always exact for |n| < 2000.
+ *
+ * Special cases:
+ *	log(x) is NaN with signal if x < 0 (including -INF) ;
+ *	log(+INF) is +INF; log(0) is -INF with signal;
+ *	log(NaN) is that NaN with no signal.
+ *
+ * Accuracy:
+ *	according to an error analysis, the error is always less than
+ *	1 ulp (unit in the last place).
+ *
+ * Constants:
+ * The hexadecimal values are the intended ones for the following
+ * constants. The decimal values may be used, provided that the
+ * compiler will convert from decimal to binary accurately enough
+ * to produce the hexadecimal values shown.
+ */
+
+/*#include "math.h"*/
+#include "math_private.h"
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+static const double
+#else
+static double
+#endif
+ln2_hi  =  6.93147180369123816490e-01,	/* 3fe62e42 fee00000 */
+ln2_lo  =  1.90821492927058770002e-10,	/* 3dea39ef 35793c76 */
+Lg1 = 6.666666666666735130e-01,  /* 3FE55555 55555593 */
+Lg2 = 3.999999999940941908e-01,  /* 3FD99999 9997FA04 */
+Lg3 = 2.857142874366239149e-01,  /* 3FD24924 94229359 */
+Lg4 = 2.222219843214978396e-01,  /* 3FCC71C5 1D8E78AF */
+Lg5 = 1.818357216161805012e-01,  /* 3FC74664 96CB03DE */
+Lg6 = 1.531383769920937332e-01,  /* 3FC39A09 D078C69F */
+Lg7 = 1.479819860511658591e-01;  /* 3FC2F112 DF3E5244 */
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+	double __ieee754_log(double x)
+#else
+	double __ieee754_log(x)
+	double x;
+#endif
+{
+	double hfsq,f,s,z,R,w,t1,t2,dk;
+	int32_t k,hx,i,j;
+	u_int32_t lx;
+
+	EXTRACT_WORDS(hx,lx,x);
+
+	k=0;
+	if (hx < 0x00100000) {			/* x < 2**-1022  */
+	    if (((hx&0x7fffffff)|lx)==0)
+		return -two54/zero;		/* log(+-0)=-inf */
+	    if (hx<0) return (x-x)/zero;	/* log(-#) = NaN */
+	    k -= 54; x *= two54; /* subnormal number, scale up x */
+	    GET_HIGH_WORD(hx,x);
+	}
+	if (hx >= 0x7ff00000) return x+x;
+	k += (hx>>20)-1023;
+	hx &= 0x000fffff;
+	i = (hx+0x95f64)&0x100000;
+	SET_HIGH_WORD(x,hx|(i^0x3ff00000));	/* normalize x or x/2 */
+	k += (i>>20);
+	f = x-1.0;
+	if((0x000fffff&(2+hx))<3) {	/* |f| < 2**-20 */
+	    if(f==zero) {if(k==0) return zero;  else {dk=(double)k;
+				 return dk*ln2_hi+dk*ln2_lo;}
+	    }
+	    R = f*f*(0.5-0.33333333333333333*f);
+	    if(k==0) return f-R; else {dk=(double)k;
+	    	     return dk*ln2_hi-((R-dk*ln2_lo)-f);}
+	}
+ 	s = f/(2.0+f);
+	dk = (double)k;
+	z = s*s;
+	i = hx-0x6147a;
+	w = z*z;
+	j = 0x6b851-hx;
+	t1= w*(Lg2+w*(Lg4+w*Lg6));
+	t2= z*(Lg1+w*(Lg3+w*(Lg5+w*Lg7)));
+	i |= j;
+	R = t2+t1;
+	if(i>0) {
+	    hfsq=0.5*f*f;
+	    if(k==0) return f-(hfsq-s*(hfsq+R)); else
+		     return dk*ln2_hi-((hfsq-(s*(hfsq+R)+dk*ln2_lo))-f);
+	} else {
+	    if(k==0) return f-s*(f-R); else
+		     return dk*ln2_hi-((s*(f-R)-dk*ln2_lo)-f);
+	}
+}
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/video/e_pow.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,302 @@
+/* @(#)e_pow.c 5.1 93/09/24 */
+/*
+ * ====================================================
+ * Copyright (C) 1993 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Developed at SunPro, a Sun Microsystems, Inc. business.
+ * Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
+ * software is freely granted, provided that this notice
+ * is preserved.
+ * ====================================================
+ */
+
+#if defined(LIBM_SCCS) && !defined(lint)
+static char rcsid[] = "$NetBSD: e_pow.c,v 1.9 1995/05/12 04:57:32 jtc Exp $";
+#endif
+
+/* __ieee754_pow(x,y) return x**y
+ *
+ *		      n
+ * Method:  Let x =  2   * (1+f)
+ *	1. Compute and return log2(x) in two pieces:
+ *		log2(x) = w1 + w2,
+ *	   where w1 has 53-24 = 29 bit trailing zeros.
+ *	2. Perform y*log2(x) = n+y' by simulating muti-precision
+ *	   arithmetic, where |y'|<=0.5.
+ *	3. Return x**y = 2**n*exp(y'*log2)
+ *
+ * Special cases:
+ *	1.  (anything) ** 0  is 1
+ *	2.  (anything) ** 1  is itself
+ *	3.  (anything) ** NAN is NAN
+ *	4.  NAN ** (anything except 0) is NAN
+ *	5.  +-(|x| > 1) **  +INF is +INF
+ *	6.  +-(|x| > 1) **  -INF is +0
+ *	7.  +-(|x| < 1) **  +INF is +0
+ *	8.  +-(|x| < 1) **  -INF is +INF
+ *	9.  +-1         ** +-INF is NAN
+ *	10. +0 ** (+anything except 0, NAN)               is +0
+ *	11. -0 ** (+anything except 0, NAN, odd integer)  is +0
+ *	12. +0 ** (-anything except 0, NAN)               is +INF
+ *	13. -0 ** (-anything except 0, NAN, odd integer)  is +INF
+ *	14. -0 ** (odd integer) = -( +0 ** (odd integer) )
+ *	15. +INF ** (+anything except 0,NAN) is +INF
+ *	16. +INF ** (-anything except 0,NAN) is +0
+ *	17. -INF ** (anything)  = -0 ** (-anything)
+ *	18. (-anything) ** (integer) is (-1)**(integer)*(+anything**integer)
+ *	19. (-anything except 0 and inf) ** (non-integer) is NAN
+ *
+ * Accuracy:
+ *	pow(x,y) returns x**y nearly rounded. In particular
+ *			pow(integer,integer)
+ *	always returns the correct integer provided it is
+ *	representable.
+ *
+ * Constants :
+ * The hexadecimal values are the intended ones for the following
+ * constants. The decimal values may be used, provided that the
+ * compiler will convert from decimal to binary accurately enough
+ * to produce the hexadecimal values shown.
+ */
+
+/*#include "math.h"*/
+#include "math_private.h"
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+static const double
+#else
+static double
+#endif
+bp[] = {1.0, 1.5,},
+dp_h[] = { 0.0, 5.84962487220764160156e-01,}, /* 0x3FE2B803, 0x40000000 */
+dp_l[] = { 0.0, 1.35003920212974897128e-08,}, /* 0x3E4CFDEB, 0x43CFD006 */
+	/* poly coefs for (3/2)*(log(x)-2s-2/3*s**3 */
+L1  =  5.99999999999994648725e-01, /* 0x3FE33333, 0x33333303 */
+L2  =  4.28571428578550184252e-01, /* 0x3FDB6DB6, 0xDB6FABFF */
+L3  =  3.33333329818377432918e-01, /* 0x3FD55555, 0x518F264D */
+L4  =  2.72728123808534006489e-01, /* 0x3FD17460, 0xA91D4101 */
+L5  =  2.30660745775561754067e-01, /* 0x3FCD864A, 0x93C9DB65 */
+L6  =  2.06975017800338417784e-01, /* 0x3FCA7E28, 0x4A454EEF */
+P1   =  1.66666666666666019037e-01, /* 0x3FC55555, 0x5555553E */
+P2   = -2.77777777770155933842e-03, /* 0xBF66C16C, 0x16BEBD93 */
+P3   =  6.61375632143793436117e-05, /* 0x3F11566A, 0xAF25DE2C */
+P4   = -1.65339022054652515390e-06, /* 0xBEBBBD41, 0xC5D26BF1 */
+P5   =  4.13813679705723846039e-08, /* 0x3E663769, 0x72BEA4D0 */
+lg2  =  6.93147180559945286227e-01, /* 0x3FE62E42, 0xFEFA39EF */
+lg2_h  =  6.93147182464599609375e-01, /* 0x3FE62E43, 0x00000000 */
+lg2_l  = -1.90465429995776804525e-09, /* 0xBE205C61, 0x0CA86C39 */
+ovt =  8.0085662595372944372e-0017, /* -(1024-log2(ovfl+.5ulp)) */
+cp    =  9.61796693925975554329e-01, /* 0x3FEEC709, 0xDC3A03FD =2/(3ln2) */
+cp_h  =  9.61796700954437255859e-01, /* 0x3FEEC709, 0xE0000000 =(float)cp */
+cp_l  = -7.02846165095275826516e-09, /* 0xBE3E2FE0, 0x145B01F5 =tail of cp_h*/
+ivln2    =  1.44269504088896338700e+00, /* 0x3FF71547, 0x652B82FE =1/ln2 */
+ivln2_h  =  1.44269502162933349609e+00, /* 0x3FF71547, 0x60000000 =24b 1/ln2*/
+ivln2_l  =  1.92596299112661746887e-08; /* 0x3E54AE0B, 0xF85DDF44 =1/ln2 tail*/
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+	double __ieee754_pow(double x, double y)
+#else
+	double __ieee754_pow(x,y)
+	double x, y;
+#endif
+{
+	double z,ax,z_h,z_l,p_h,p_l;
+	double y1,t1,t2,r,s,t,u,v,w;
+	int32_t i,j,k,yisint,n;
+	int32_t hx,hy,ix,iy;
+	u_int32_t lx,ly;
+
+	EXTRACT_WORDS(hx,lx,x);
+	EXTRACT_WORDS(hy,ly,y);
+	ix = hx&0x7fffffff;  iy = hy&0x7fffffff;
+
+    /* y==zero: x**0 = 1 */
+	if((iy|ly)==0) return one;
+
+    /* +-NaN return x+y */
+	if(ix > 0x7ff00000 || ((ix==0x7ff00000)&&(lx!=0)) ||
+	   iy > 0x7ff00000 || ((iy==0x7ff00000)&&(ly!=0)))
+		return x+y;
+
+    /* determine if y is an odd int when x < 0
+     * yisint = 0	... y is not an integer
+     * yisint = 1	... y is an odd int
+     * yisint = 2	... y is an even int
+     */
+	yisint  = 0;
+	if(hx<0) {
+	    if(iy>=0x43400000) yisint = 2; /* even integer y */
+	    else if(iy>=0x3ff00000) {
+		k = (iy>>20)-0x3ff;	   /* exponent */
+		if(k>20) {
+		    j = ly>>(52-k);
+		    if((j<<(52-k))==ly) yisint = 2-(j&1);
+		} else if(ly==0) {
+		    j = iy>>(20-k);
+		    if((j<<(20-k))==iy) yisint = 2-(j&1);
+		}
+	    }
+	}
+
+    /* special value of y */
+	if(ly==0) {
+	    if (iy==0x7ff00000) {	/* y is +-inf */
+	        if(((ix-0x3ff00000)|lx)==0)
+		    return  y - y;	/* inf**+-1 is NaN */
+	        else if (ix >= 0x3ff00000)/* (|x|>1)**+-inf = inf,0 */
+		    return (hy>=0)? y: zero;
+	        else			/* (|x|<1)**-,+inf = inf,0 */
+		    return (hy<0)?-y: zero;
+	    }
+	    if(iy==0x3ff00000) {	/* y is  +-1 */
+		if(hy<0) return one/x; else return x;
+	    }
+	    if(hy==0x40000000) return x*x; /* y is  2 */
+	    if(hy==0x3fe00000) {	/* y is  0.5 */
+		if(hx>=0)	/* x >= +0 */
+		return __ieee754_sqrt(x);
+	    }
+	}
+
+	ax   = x < 0 ? -x : x; /*fabs(x);*/
+    /* special value of x */
+	if(lx==0) {
+	    if(ix==0x7ff00000||ix==0||ix==0x3ff00000){
+		z = ax;			/*x is +-0,+-inf,+-1*/
+		if(hy<0) z = one/z;	/* z = (1/|x|) */
+		if(hx<0) {
+		    if(((ix-0x3ff00000)|yisint)==0) {
+			z = (z-z)/(z-z); /* (-1)**non-int is NaN */
+		    } else if(yisint==1)
+			z = -z;		/* (x<0)**odd = -(|x|**odd) */
+		}
+		return z;
+	    }
+	}
+
+    /* (x<0)**(non-int) is NaN */
+	if(((((u_int32_t)hx>>31)-1)|yisint)==0) return (x-x)/(x-x);
+
+    /* |y| is huge */
+	if(iy>0x41e00000) { /* if |y| > 2**31 */
+	    if(iy>0x43f00000){	/* if |y| > 2**64, must o/uflow */
+		if(ix<=0x3fefffff) return (hy<0)? huge*huge:tiny*tiny;
+		if(ix>=0x3ff00000) return (hy>0)? huge*huge:tiny*tiny;
+	    }
+	/* over/underflow if x is not close to one */
+	    if(ix<0x3fefffff) return (hy<0)? huge*huge:tiny*tiny;
+	    if(ix>0x3ff00000) return (hy>0)? huge*huge:tiny*tiny;
+	/* now |1-x| is tiny <= 2**-20, suffice to compute
+	   log(x) by x-x^2/2+x^3/3-x^4/4 */
+	    t = x-1;		/* t has 20 trailing zeros */
+	    w = (t*t)*(0.5-t*(0.3333333333333333333333-t*0.25));
+	    u = ivln2_h*t;	/* ivln2_h has 21 sig. bits */
+	    v = t*ivln2_l-w*ivln2;
+	    t1 = u+v;
+	    SET_LOW_WORD(t1,0);
+	    t2 = v-(t1-u);
+	} else {
+	    double s2,s_h,s_l,t_h,t_l;
+	    n = 0;
+	/* take care subnormal number */
+	    if(ix<0x00100000)
+		{ax *= two53; n -= 53; GET_HIGH_WORD(ix,ax); }
+	    n  += ((ix)>>20)-0x3ff;
+	    j  = ix&0x000fffff;
+	/* determine interval */
+	    ix = j|0x3ff00000;		/* normalize ix */
+	    if(j<=0x3988E) k=0;		/* |x|<sqrt(3/2) */
+	    else if(j<0xBB67A) k=1;	/* |x|<sqrt(3)   */
+	    else {k=0;n+=1;ix -= 0x00100000;}
+	    SET_HIGH_WORD(ax,ix);
+
+	/* compute s = s_h+s_l = (x-1)/(x+1) or (x-1.5)/(x+1.5) */
+	    u = ax-bp[k];		/* bp[0]=1.0, bp[1]=1.5 */
+	    v = one/(ax+bp[k]);
+	    s = u*v;
+	    s_h = s;
+	    SET_LOW_WORD(s_h,0);
+	/* t_h=ax+bp[k] High */
+	    t_h = zero;
+	    SET_HIGH_WORD(t_h,((ix>>1)|0x20000000)+0x00080000+(k<<18));
+	    t_l = ax - (t_h-bp[k]);
+	    s_l = v*((u-s_h*t_h)-s_h*t_l);
+	/* compute log(ax) */
+	    s2 = s*s;
+	    r = s2*s2*(L1+s2*(L2+s2*(L3+s2*(L4+s2*(L5+s2*L6)))));
+	    r += s_l*(s_h+s);
+	    s2  = s_h*s_h;
+	    t_h = 3.0+s2+r;
+	    SET_LOW_WORD(t_h,0);
+	    t_l = r-((t_h-3.0)-s2);
+	/* u+v = s*(1+...) */
+	    u = s_h*t_h;
+	    v = s_l*t_h+t_l*s;
+	/* 2/(3log2)*(s+...) */
+	    p_h = u+v;
+	    SET_LOW_WORD(p_h,0);
+	    p_l = v-(p_h-u);
+	    z_h = cp_h*p_h;		/* cp_h+cp_l = 2/(3*log2) */
+	    z_l = cp_l*p_h+p_l*cp+dp_l[k];
+	/* log2(ax) = (s+..)*2/(3*log2) = n + dp_h + z_h + z_l */
+	    t = (double)n;
+	    t1 = (((z_h+z_l)+dp_h[k])+t);
+	    SET_LOW_WORD(t1,0);
+	    t2 = z_l-(((t1-t)-dp_h[k])-z_h);
+	}
+
+	s = one; /* s (sign of result -ve**odd) = -1 else = 1 */
+	if(((((u_int32_t)hx>>31)-1)|(yisint-1))==0)
+	    s = -one;/* (-ve)**(odd int) */
+
+    /* split up y into y1+y2 and compute (y1+y2)*(t1+t2) */
+	y1  = y;
+	SET_LOW_WORD(y1,0);
+	p_l = (y-y1)*t1+y*t2;
+	p_h = y1*t1;
+	z = p_l+p_h;
+	EXTRACT_WORDS(j,i,z);
+	if (j>=0x40900000) {				/* z >= 1024 */
+	    if(((j-0x40900000)|i)!=0)			/* if z > 1024 */
+		return s*huge*huge;			/* overflow */
+	    else {
+		if(p_l+ovt>z-p_h) return s*huge*huge;	/* overflow */
+	    }
+	} else if((j&0x7fffffff)>=0x4090cc00 ) {	/* z <= -1075 */
+	    if(((j-0xc090cc00)|i)!=0) 		/* z < -1075 */
+		return s*tiny*tiny;		/* underflow */
+	    else {
+		if(p_l<=z-p_h) return s*tiny*tiny;	/* underflow */
+	    }
+	}
+    /*
+     * compute 2**(p_h+p_l)
+     */
+	i = j&0x7fffffff;
+	k = (i>>20)-0x3ff;
+	n = 0;
+	if(i>0x3fe00000) {		/* if |z| > 0.5, set n = [z+0.5] */
+	    n = j+(0x00100000>>(k+1));
+	    k = ((n&0x7fffffff)>>20)-0x3ff;	/* new k for n */
+	    t = zero;
+	    SET_HIGH_WORD(t,n&~(0x000fffff>>k));
+	    n = ((n&0x000fffff)|0x00100000)>>(20-k);
+	    if(j<0) n = -n;
+	    p_h -= t;
+	}
+	t = p_l+p_h;
+	SET_LOW_WORD(t,0);
+	u = t*lg2_h;
+	v = (p_l-(t-p_h))*lg2+t*lg2_l;
+	z = u+v;
+	w = v-(z-u);
+	t  = z*z;
+	t1  = z - t*(P1+t*(P2+t*(P3+t*(P4+t*P5))));
+	r  = (z*t1)/(t1-two)-(w+z*w);
+	z  = one-(r-z);
+	GET_HIGH_WORD(j,z);
+	j += (n<<20);
+	if((j>>20)<=0) z = scalbn(z,n);	/* subnormal output */
+	else SET_HIGH_WORD(z,j);
+	return s*z;
+}
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/video/e_sqrt.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,493 @@
+/* @(#)e_sqrt.c 5.1 93/09/24 */
+/*
+ * ====================================================
+ * Copyright (C) 1993 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Developed at SunPro, a Sun Microsystems, Inc. business.
+ * Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
+ * software is freely granted, provided that this notice
+ * is preserved.
+ * ====================================================
+ */
+
+#if defined(LIBM_SCCS) && !defined(lint)
+static char rcsid[] = "$NetBSD: e_sqrt.c,v 1.8 1995/05/10 20:46:17 jtc Exp $";
+#endif
+
+/* __ieee754_sqrt(x)
+ * Return correctly rounded sqrt.
+ *           ------------------------------------------
+ *	     |  Use the hardware sqrt if you have one |
+ *           ------------------------------------------
+ * Method:
+ *   Bit by bit method using integer arithmetic. (Slow, but portable)
+ *   1. Normalization
+ *	Scale x to y in [1,4) with even powers of 2:
+ *	find an integer k such that  1 <= (y=x*2^(2k)) < 4, then
+ *		sqrt(x) = 2^k * sqrt(y)
+ *   2. Bit by bit computation
+ *	Let q  = sqrt(y) truncated to i bit after binary point (q = 1),
+ *	     i							 0
+ *                                     i+1         2
+ *	    s  = 2*q , and	y  =  2   * ( y - q  ).		(1)
+ *	     i      i            i                 i
+ *
+ *	To compute q    from q , one checks whether
+ *		    i+1       i
+ *
+ *			      -(i+1) 2
+ *			(q + 2      ) <= y.			(2)
+ *     			  i
+ *							      -(i+1)
+ *	If (2) is false, then q   = q ; otherwise q   = q  + 2      .
+ *		 	       i+1   i             i+1   i
+ *
+ *	With some algebric manipulation, it is not difficult to see
+ *	that (2) is equivalent to
+ *                             -(i+1)
+ *			s  +  2       <= y			(3)
+ *			 i                i
+ *
+ *	The advantage of (3) is that s  and y  can be computed by
+ *				      i      i
+ *	the following recurrence formula:
+ *	    if (3) is false
+ *
+ *	    s     =  s  ,	y    = y   ;			(4)
+ *	     i+1      i		 i+1    i
+ *
+ *	    otherwise,
+ *                         -i                     -(i+1)
+ *	    s	  =  s  + 2  ,  y    = y  -  s  - 2  		(5)
+ *           i+1      i          i+1    i     i
+ *
+ *	One may easily use induction to prove (4) and (5).
+ *	Note. Since the left hand side of (3) contain only i+2 bits,
+ *	      it does not necessary to do a full (53-bit) comparison
+ *	      in (3).
+ *   3. Final rounding
+ *	After generating the 53 bits result, we compute one more bit.
+ *	Together with the remainder, we can decide whether the
+ *	result is exact, bigger than 1/2ulp, or less than 1/2ulp
+ *	(it will never equal to 1/2ulp).
+ *	The rounding mode can be detected by checking whether
+ *	huge + tiny is equal to huge, and whether huge - tiny is
+ *	equal to huge for some floating point number "huge" and "tiny".
+ *
+ * Special cases:
+ *	sqrt(+-0) = +-0 	... exact
+ *	sqrt(inf) = inf
+ *	sqrt(-ve) = NaN		... with invalid signal
+ *	sqrt(NaN) = NaN		... with invalid signal for signaling NaN
+ *
+ * Other methods : see the appended file at the end of the program below.
+ *---------------
+ */
+
+/*#include "math.h"*/
+#include "math_private.h"
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+	double copysign(double x, double y)
+#else
+	double copysign(x,y)
+	double x,y;
+#endif
+{
+	u_int32_t hx,hy;
+	GET_HIGH_WORD(hx,x);
+	GET_HIGH_WORD(hy,y);
+	SET_HIGH_WORD(x,(hx&0x7fffffff)|(hy&0x80000000));
+        return x;
+}
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+	double scalbn (double x, int n)
+#else
+	double scalbn (x,n)
+	double x; int n;
+#endif
+{
+	int32_t k,hx,lx;
+	EXTRACT_WORDS(hx,lx,x);
+        k = (hx&0x7ff00000)>>20;		/* extract exponent */
+        if (k==0) {				/* 0 or subnormal x */
+            if ((lx|(hx&0x7fffffff))==0) return x; /* +-0 */
+	    x *= two54;
+	    GET_HIGH_WORD(hx,x);
+	    k = ((hx&0x7ff00000)>>20) - 54;
+            if (n< -50000) return tiny*x; 	/*underflow*/
+	    }
+        if (k==0x7ff) return x+x;		/* NaN or Inf */
+        k = k+n;
+        if (k >  0x7fe) return huge*copysign(huge,x); /* overflow  */
+        if (k > 0) 				/* normal result */
+	    {SET_HIGH_WORD(x,(hx&0x800fffff)|(k<<20)); return x;}
+        if (k <= -54) {
+            if (n > 50000) 	/* in case integer overflow in n+k */
+		return huge*copysign(huge,x);	/*overflow*/
+	    else return tiny*copysign(tiny,x); 	/*underflow*/
+	}
+        k += 54;				/* subnormal result */
+	SET_HIGH_WORD(x,(hx&0x800fffff)|(k<<20));
+        return x*twom54;
+}
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+	double __ieee754_sqrt(double x)
+#else
+	double __ieee754_sqrt(x)
+	double x;
+#endif
+{
+	double z;
+	int32_t sign = (int)0x80000000;
+	int32_t ix0,s0,q,m,t,i;
+	u_int32_t r,t1,s1,ix1,q1;
+
+	EXTRACT_WORDS(ix0,ix1,x);
+
+    /* take care of Inf and NaN */
+	if((ix0&0x7ff00000)==0x7ff00000) {
+	    return x*x+x;		/* sqrt(NaN)=NaN, sqrt(+inf)=+inf
+					   sqrt(-inf)=sNaN */
+	}
+    /* take care of zero */
+	if(ix0<=0) {
+	    if(((ix0&(~sign))|ix1)==0) return x;/* sqrt(+-0) = +-0 */
+	    else if(ix0<0)
+		return (x-x)/(x-x);		/* sqrt(-ve) = sNaN */
+	}
+    /* normalize x */
+	m = (ix0>>20);
+	if(m==0) {				/* subnormal x */
+	    while(ix0==0) {
+		m -= 21;
+		ix0 |= (ix1>>11); ix1 <<= 21;
+	    }
+	    for(i=0;(ix0&0x00100000)==0;i++) ix0<<=1;
+	    m -= i-1;
+	    ix0 |= (ix1>>(32-i));
+	    ix1 <<= i;
+	}
+	m -= 1023;	/* unbias exponent */
+	ix0 = (ix0&0x000fffff)|0x00100000;
+	if(m&1){	/* odd m, double x to make it even */
+	    ix0 += ix0 + ((ix1&sign)>>31);
+	    ix1 += ix1;
+	}
+	m >>= 1;	/* m = [m/2] */
+
+    /* generate sqrt(x) bit by bit */
+	ix0 += ix0 + ((ix1&sign)>>31);
+	ix1 += ix1;
+	q = q1 = s0 = s1 = 0;	/* [q,q1] = sqrt(x) */
+	r = 0x00200000;		/* r = moving bit from right to left */
+
+	while(r!=0) {
+	    t = s0+r;
+	    if(t<=ix0) {
+		s0   = t+r;
+		ix0 -= t;
+		q   += r;
+	    }
+	    ix0 += ix0 + ((ix1&sign)>>31);
+	    ix1 += ix1;
+	    r>>=1;
+	}
+
+	r = sign;
+	while(r!=0) {
+	    t1 = s1+r;
+	    t  = s0;
+	    if((t<ix0)||((t==ix0)&&(t1<=ix1))) {
+		s1  = t1+r;
+		if(((t1&sign)==sign)&&(s1&sign)==0) s0 += 1;
+		ix0 -= t;
+		if (ix1 < t1) ix0 -= 1;
+		ix1 -= t1;
+		q1  += r;
+	    }
+	    ix0 += ix0 + ((ix1&sign)>>31);
+	    ix1 += ix1;
+	    r>>=1;
+	}
+
+    /* use floating add to find out rounding direction */
+	if((ix0|ix1)!=0) {
+	    z = one-tiny; /* trigger inexact flag */
+	    if (z>=one) {
+	        z = one+tiny;
+	        if (q1==(u_int32_t)0xffffffff) { q1=0; q += 1;}
+		else if (z>one) {
+		    if (q1==(u_int32_t)0xfffffffe) q+=1;
+		    q1+=2;
+		} else
+	            q1 += (q1&1);
+	    }
+	}
+	ix0 = (q>>1)+0x3fe00000;
+	ix1 =  q1>>1;
+	if ((q&1)==1) ix1 |= sign;
+	ix0 += (m <<20);
+	INSERT_WORDS(z,ix0,ix1);
+	return z;
+}
+
+/*
+Other methods  (use floating-point arithmetic)
+-------------
+(This is a copy of a drafted paper by Prof W. Kahan
+and K.C. Ng, written in May, 1986)
+
+	Two algorithms are given here to implement sqrt(x)
+	(IEEE double precision arithmetic) in software.
+	Both supply sqrt(x) correctly rounded. The first algorithm (in
+	Section A) uses newton iterations and involves four divisions.
+	The second one uses reciproot iterations to avoid division, but
+	requires more multiplications. Both algorithms need the ability
+	to chop results of arithmetic operations instead of round them,
+	and the INEXACT flag to indicate when an arithmetic operation
+	is executed exactly with no roundoff error, all part of the
+	standard (IEEE 754-1985). The ability to perform shift, add,
+	subtract and logical AND operations upon 32-bit words is needed
+	too, though not part of the standard.
+
+A.  sqrt(x) by Newton Iteration
+
+   (1)	Initial approximation
+
+	Let x0 and x1 be the leading and the trailing 32-bit words of
+	a floating point number x (in IEEE double format) respectively
+
+	    1    11		     52				  ...widths
+	   ------------------------------------------------------
+	x: |s|	  e     |	      f				|
+	   ------------------------------------------------------
+	      msb    lsb  msb				      lsb ...order
+
+
+	     ------------------------  	     ------------------------
+	x0:  |s|   e    |    f1     |	 x1: |          f2           |
+	     ------------------------  	     ------------------------
+
+	By performing shifts and subtracts on x0 and x1 (both regarded
+	as integers), we obtain an 8-bit approximation of sqrt(x) as
+	follows.
+
+		k  := (x0>>1) + 0x1ff80000;
+		y0 := k - T1[31&(k>>15)].	... y ~ sqrt(x) to 8 bits
+	Here k is a 32-bit integer and T1[] is an integer array containing
+	correction terms. Now magically the floating value of y (y's
+	leading 32-bit word is y0, the value of its trailing word is 0)
+	approximates sqrt(x) to almost 8-bit.
+
+	Value of T1:
+	static int T1[32]= {
+	0,	1024,	3062,	5746,	9193,	13348,	18162,	23592,
+	29598,	36145,	43202,	50740,	58733,	67158,	75992,	85215,
+	83599,	71378,	60428,	50647,	41945,	34246,	27478,	21581,
+	16499,	12183,	8588,	5674,	3403,	1742,	661,	130,};
+
+    (2)	Iterative refinement
+
+	Apply Heron's rule three times to y, we have y approximates
+	sqrt(x) to within 1 ulp (Unit in the Last Place):
+
+		y := (y+x/y)/2		... almost 17 sig. bits
+		y := (y+x/y)/2		... almost 35 sig. bits
+		y := y-(y-x/y)/2	... within 1 ulp
+
+
+	Remark 1.
+	    Another way to improve y to within 1 ulp is:
+
+		y := (y+x/y)		... almost 17 sig. bits to 2*sqrt(x)
+		y := y - 0x00100006	... almost 18 sig. bits to sqrt(x)
+
+				2
+			    (x-y )*y
+		y := y + 2* ----------	...within 1 ulp
+			       2
+			     3y  + x
+
+
+	This formula has one division fewer than the one above; however,
+	it requires more multiplications and additions. Also x must be
+	scaled in advance to avoid spurious overflow in evaluating the
+	expression 3y*y+x. Hence it is not recommended uless division
+	is slow. If division is very slow, then one should use the
+	reciproot algorithm given in section B.
+
+    (3) Final adjustment
+
+	By twiddling y's last bit it is possible to force y to be
+	correctly rounded according to the prevailing rounding mode
+	as follows. Let r and i be copies of the rounding mode and
+	inexact flag before entering the square root program. Also we
+	use the expression y+-ulp for the next representable floating
+	numbers (up and down) of y. Note that y+-ulp = either fixed
+	point y+-1, or multiply y by nextafter(1,+-inf) in chopped
+	mode.
+
+		I := FALSE;	... reset INEXACT flag I
+		R := RZ;	... set rounding mode to round-toward-zero
+		z := x/y;	... chopped quotient, possibly inexact
+		If(not I) then {	... if the quotient is exact
+		    if(z=y) {
+		        I := i;	 ... restore inexact flag
+		        R := r;  ... restore rounded mode
+		        return sqrt(x):=y.
+		    } else {
+			z := z - ulp;	... special rounding
+		    }
+		}
+		i := TRUE;		... sqrt(x) is inexact
+		If (r=RN) then z=z+ulp	... rounded-to-nearest
+		If (r=RP) then {	... round-toward-+inf
+		    y = y+ulp; z=z+ulp;
+		}
+		y := y+z;		... chopped sum
+		y0:=y0-0x00100000;	... y := y/2 is correctly rounded.
+	        I := i;	 		... restore inexact flag
+	        R := r;  		... restore rounded mode
+	        return sqrt(x):=y.
+
+    (4)	Special cases
+
+	Square root of +inf, +-0, or NaN is itself;
+	Square root of a negative number is NaN with invalid signal.
+
+
+B.  sqrt(x) by Reciproot Iteration
+
+   (1)	Initial approximation
+
+	Let x0 and x1 be the leading and the trailing 32-bit words of
+	a floating point number x (in IEEE double format) respectively
+	(see section A). By performing shifs and subtracts on x0 and y0,
+	we obtain a 7.8-bit approximation of 1/sqrt(x) as follows.
+
+	    k := 0x5fe80000 - (x0>>1);
+	    y0:= k - T2[63&(k>>14)].	... y ~ 1/sqrt(x) to 7.8 bits
+
+	Here k is a 32-bit integer and T2[] is an integer array
+	containing correction terms. Now magically the floating
+	value of y (y's leading 32-bit word is y0, the value of
+	its trailing word y1 is set to zero) approximates 1/sqrt(x)
+	to almost 7.8-bit.
+
+	Value of T2:
+	static int T2[64]= {
+	0x1500,	0x2ef8,	0x4d67,	0x6b02,	0x87be,	0xa395,	0xbe7a,	0xd866,
+	0xf14a,	0x1091b,0x11fcd,0x13552,0x14999,0x15c98,0x16e34,0x17e5f,
+	0x18d03,0x19a01,0x1a545,0x1ae8a,0x1b5c4,0x1bb01,0x1bfde,0x1c28d,
+	0x1c2de,0x1c0db,0x1ba73,0x1b11c,0x1a4b5,0x1953d,0x18266,0x16be0,
+	0x1683e,0x179d8,0x18a4d,0x19992,0x1a789,0x1b445,0x1bf61,0x1c989,
+	0x1d16d,0x1d77b,0x1dddf,0x1e2ad,0x1e5bf,0x1e6e8,0x1e654,0x1e3cd,
+	0x1df2a,0x1d635,0x1cb16,0x1be2c,0x1ae4e,0x19bde,0x1868e,0x16e2e,
+	0x1527f,0x1334a,0x11051,0xe951,	0xbe01,	0x8e0d,	0x5924,	0x1edd,};
+
+    (2)	Iterative refinement
+
+	Apply Reciproot iteration three times to y and multiply the
+	result by x to get an approximation z that matches sqrt(x)
+	to about 1 ulp. To be exact, we will have
+		-1ulp < sqrt(x)-z<1.0625ulp.
+
+	... set rounding mode to Round-to-nearest
+	   y := y*(1.5-0.5*x*y*y)	... almost 15 sig. bits to 1/sqrt(x)
+	   y := y*((1.5-2^-30)+0.5*x*y*y)... about 29 sig. bits to 1/sqrt(x)
+	... special arrangement for better accuracy
+	   z := x*y			... 29 bits to sqrt(x), with z*y<1
+	   z := z + 0.5*z*(1-z*y)	... about 1 ulp to sqrt(x)
+
+	Remark 2. The constant 1.5-2^-30 is chosen to bias the error so that
+	(a) the term z*y in the final iteration is always less than 1;
+	(b) the error in the final result is biased upward so that
+		-1 ulp < sqrt(x) - z < 1.0625 ulp
+	    instead of |sqrt(x)-z|<1.03125ulp.
+
+    (3)	Final adjustment
+
+	By twiddling y's last bit it is possible to force y to be
+	correctly rounded according to the prevailing rounding mode
+	as follows. Let r and i be copies of the rounding mode and
+	inexact flag before entering the square root program. Also we
+	use the expression y+-ulp for the next representable floating
+	numbers (up and down) of y. Note that y+-ulp = either fixed
+	point y+-1, or multiply y by nextafter(1,+-inf) in chopped
+	mode.
+
+	R := RZ;		... set rounding mode to round-toward-zero
+	switch(r) {
+	    case RN:		... round-to-nearest
+	       if(x<= z*(z-ulp)...chopped) z = z - ulp; else
+	       if(x<= z*(z+ulp)...chopped) z = z; else z = z+ulp;
+	       break;
+	    case RZ:case RM:	... round-to-zero or round-to--inf
+	       R:=RP;		... reset rounding mod to round-to-+inf
+	       if(x<z*z ... rounded up) z = z - ulp; else
+	       if(x>=(z+ulp)*(z+ulp) ...rounded up) z = z+ulp;
+	       break;
+	    case RP:		... round-to-+inf
+	       if(x>(z+ulp)*(z+ulp)...chopped) z = z+2*ulp; else
+	       if(x>z*z ...chopped) z = z+ulp;
+	       break;
+	}
+
+	Remark 3. The above comparisons can be done in fixed point. For
+	example, to compare x and w=z*z chopped, it suffices to compare
+	x1 and w1 (the trailing parts of x and w), regarding them as
+	two's complement integers.
+
+	...Is z an exact square root?
+	To determine whether z is an exact square root of x, let z1 be the
+	trailing part of z, and also let x0 and x1 be the leading and
+	trailing parts of x.
+
+	If ((z1&0x03ffffff)!=0)	... not exact if trailing 26 bits of z!=0
+	    I := 1;		... Raise Inexact flag: z is not exact
+	else {
+	    j := 1 - [(x0>>20)&1]	... j = logb(x) mod 2
+	    k := z1 >> 26;		... get z's 25-th and 26-th
+					    fraction bits
+	    I := i or (k&j) or ((k&(j+j+1))!=(x1&3));
+	}
+	R:= r		... restore rounded mode
+	return sqrt(x):=z.
+
+	If multiplication is cheaper then the foregoing red tape, the
+	Inexact flag can be evaluated by
+
+	    I := i;
+	    I := (z*z!=x) or I.
+
+	Note that z*z can overwrite I; this value must be sensed if it is
+	True.
+
+	Remark 4. If z*z = x exactly, then bit 25 to bit 0 of z1 must be
+	zero.
+
+		    --------------------
+		z1: |        f2        |
+		    --------------------
+		bit 31		   bit 0
+
+	Further more, bit 27 and 26 of z1, bit 0 and 1 of x1, and the odd
+	or even of logb(x) have the following relations:
+
+	-------------------------------------------------
+	bit 27,26 of z1		bit 1,0 of x1	logb(x)
+	-------------------------------------------------
+	00			00		odd and even
+	01			01		even
+	10			10		odd
+	10			00		even
+	11			01		even
+	-------------------------------------------------
+
+    (4)	Special cases (see (4) of Section A).
+
+ */
+
--- a/src/video/fbcon/SDL_fbelo.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/fbcon/SDL_fbelo.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -23,8 +23,6 @@
 #ifndef SDL_fbelo_h
 #define SDL_fbelo_h
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-
 #include "SDL_fbvideo.h"
 
 /* ELO */
--- /dev/null	Thu Jan 01 00:00:00 1970 +0000
+++ b/src/video/math_private.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -0,0 +1,172 @@
+/*
+ * ====================================================
+ * Copyright (C) 1993 by Sun Microsystems, Inc. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Developed at SunPro, a Sun Microsystems, Inc. business.
+ * Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
+ * software is freely granted, provided that this notice
+ * is preserved.
+ * ====================================================
+ */
+
+/*
+ * from: @(#)fdlibm.h 5.1 93/09/24
+ * $Id$
+ */
+
+#ifndef _MATH_PRIVATE_H_
+#define _MATH_PRIVATE_H_
+
+#include "SDL_endian.h"
+
+typedef Sint32 int32_t;
+typedef Uint32 u_int32_t;
+
+/* The original fdlibm code used statements like:
+	n0 = ((*(int*)&one)>>29)^1;		* index of high word *
+	ix0 = *(n0+(int*)&x);			* high word of x *
+	ix1 = *((1-n0)+(int*)&x);		* low word of x *
+   to dig two 32 bit words out of the 64 bit IEEE floating point
+   value.  That is non-ANSI, and, moreover, the gcc instruction
+   scheduler gets it wrong.  We instead use the following macros.
+   Unlike the original code, we determine the endianness at compile
+   time, not at run time; I don't see much benefit to selecting
+   endianness at run time.  */
+
+/* A union which permits us to convert between a double and two 32 bit
+   ints.  */
+
+/*
+ * Math on arm is special:
+ * For FPA, float words are always big-endian.
+ * For VFP, floats words follow the memory system mode.
+ */
+
+#if (SDL_BYTEORDER == SDL_BIG_ENDIAN) || \
+    (!defined(__VFP_FP__) && (defined(__arm__) || defined(__thumb__)))
+
+typedef union
+{
+  double value;
+  struct
+  {
+    u_int32_t msw;
+    u_int32_t lsw;
+  } parts;
+} ieee_double_shape_type;
+
+#else
+
+typedef union
+{
+  double value;
+  struct
+  {
+    u_int32_t lsw;
+    u_int32_t msw;
+  } parts;
+} ieee_double_shape_type;
+
+#endif
+
+/* Get two 32 bit ints from a double.  */
+
+#define EXTRACT_WORDS(ix0,ix1,d)				\
+do {								\
+  ieee_double_shape_type ew_u;					\
+  ew_u.value = (d);						\
+  (ix0) = ew_u.parts.msw;					\
+  (ix1) = ew_u.parts.lsw;					\
+} while (0)
+
+/* Get the more significant 32 bit int from a double.  */
+
+#define GET_HIGH_WORD(i,d)					\
+do {								\
+  ieee_double_shape_type gh_u;					\
+  gh_u.value = (d);						\
+  (i) = gh_u.parts.msw;						\
+} while (0)
+
+/* Get the less significant 32 bit int from a double.  */
+
+#define GET_LOW_WORD(i,d)					\
+do {								\
+  ieee_double_shape_type gl_u;					\
+  gl_u.value = (d);						\
+  (i) = gl_u.parts.lsw;						\
+} while (0)
+
+/* Set a double from two 32 bit ints.  */
+
+#define INSERT_WORDS(d,ix0,ix1)					\
+do {								\
+  ieee_double_shape_type iw_u;					\
+  iw_u.parts.msw = (ix0);					\
+  iw_u.parts.lsw = (ix1);					\
+  (d) = iw_u.value;						\
+} while (0)
+
+/* Set the more significant 32 bits of a double from an int.  */
+
+#define SET_HIGH_WORD(d,v)					\
+do {								\
+  ieee_double_shape_type sh_u;					\
+  sh_u.value = (d);						\
+  sh_u.parts.msw = (v);						\
+  (d) = sh_u.value;						\
+} while (0)
+
+/* Set the less significant 32 bits of a double from an int.  */
+
+#define SET_LOW_WORD(d,v)					\
+do {								\
+  ieee_double_shape_type sl_u;					\
+  sl_u.value = (d);						\
+  sl_u.parts.lsw = (v);						\
+  (d) = sl_u.value;						\
+} while (0)
+
+/* A union which permits us to convert between a float and a 32 bit
+   int.  */
+
+typedef union
+{
+  float value;
+  u_int32_t word;
+} ieee_float_shape_type;
+
+/* Get a 32 bit int from a float.  */
+
+#define GET_FLOAT_WORD(i,d)					\
+do {								\
+  ieee_float_shape_type gf_u;					\
+  gf_u.value = (d);						\
+  (i) = gf_u.word;						\
+} while (0)
+
+/* Set a float from a 32 bit int.  */
+
+#define SET_FLOAT_WORD(d,i)					\
+do {								\
+  ieee_float_shape_type sf_u;					\
+  sf_u.word = (i);						\
+  (d) = sf_u.value;						\
+} while (0)
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+static const double
+#else
+static double
+#endif
+zero    =  0.0,
+one	=  1.0,
+two	=  2.0,
+two53	=  9007199254740992.0,	/* 0x43400000, 0x00000000 */
+two54   =  1.80143985094819840000e+16, /* 0x43500000, 0x00000000 */
+twom54  =  5.55111512312578270212e-17, /* 0x3C900000, 0x00000000 */
+huge   = 1.0e+300,
+tiny   = 1.0e-300;
+
+#endif /* _MATH_PRIVATE_H_ */
--- a/src/video/mmx.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/mmx.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -237,8 +237,6 @@
 /*	Include the stuff for printing a trace to stderr...
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-
 #define	mmx_i2r(op, imm, reg) \
 	{ \
 		mmx_t mmx_trace; \
--- a/src/video/qtopia/SDL_QWin.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/qtopia/SDL_QWin.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,6 +22,7 @@
 
 #ifndef _SDL_QWin_h
 #define _SDL_QWin_h
+
 #include <stdio.h>
 
 #include <qimage.h>
--- a/src/video/wincommon/SDL_lowvideo.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/wincommon/SDL_lowvideo.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -23,7 +23,7 @@
 #ifndef _SDL_lowvideo_h
 #define _SDL_lowvideo_h
 
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
 
--- a/src/video/wincommon/SDL_sysevents.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/wincommon/SDL_sysevents.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,15 +20,15 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
-#include "SDL_getenv.h"
 #include "SDL_events.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_syswm.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
+#include "SDL_getenv.h"
 #include "SDL_sysevents.h"
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
@@ -798,7 +798,7 @@
 	int	cp = GetACP();
 
 	if (GetLocaleInfo(lcid, LOCALE_IDEFAULTANSICODEPAGE, buff, sizeof(buff))) {
-		cp = atoi(buff);
+		cp = strtol(buff, NULL, 0);
 	}
 	return cp;
 }
--- a/src/video/wincommon/SDL_sysmouse.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/wincommon/SDL_sysmouse.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,11 +20,12 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_mouse.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysmouse_c.h"
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 #include "SDL_cursor_c.h"
--- a/src/video/wincommon/SDL_syswm.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/wincommon/SDL_syswm.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,14 +20,14 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <malloc.h>
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 #include "SDL_version.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_syswm.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_syswm_c.h"
 #include "SDL_wingl_c.h"
 #include "SDL_pixels_c.h"
@@ -119,7 +119,7 @@
 	icon_plen = icon->h*icon_pitch;
 	icon_mlen = icon->h*mask_pitch;
 	icon_len = sizeof(*icon_win32)+icon_plen+icon_mlen;
-	icon_win32 = (struct Win32Icon *)alloca(icon_len);
+	icon_win32 = (struct Win32Icon *)SDL_stack_alloc(Uint8, icon_len);
 	if ( icon_win32 == NULL ) {
 		return;
 	}
@@ -137,6 +137,7 @@
 	icon_256 = SDL_CreateRGBSurface(SDL_SWSURFACE, icon->w, icon->h,
 					 icon_win32->biBitCount, 0, 0, 0, 0);
 	if ( icon_256 == NULL ) {
+		SDL_stack_free(icon_win32);
 		return;
 	}
 	pal_256 = icon_256->format->palette;
@@ -167,17 +168,19 @@
 	   be necessary, as Windows supports a variety of BMP formats, but
 	   it greatly simplifies our code.
 	*/ 
-        bounds.x = 0;
-        bounds.y = 0;
-        bounds.w = icon->w;
-        bounds.h = icon->h;
-        if ( SDL_LowerBlit(icon, &bounds, icon_256, &bounds) < 0 ) {
+    bounds.x = 0;
+    bounds.y = 0;
+    bounds.w = icon->w;
+    bounds.h = icon->h;
+    if ( SDL_LowerBlit(icon, &bounds, icon_256, &bounds) < 0 ) {
+	    SDL_stack_free(icon_win32);
 		SDL_FreeSurface(icon_256);
-                return;
+        return;
 	}
 
 	/* Copy pixels upside-down to icon BMP, masked with the icon mask */
 	if ( SDL_MUSTLOCK(icon_256) || (icon_256->pitch != icon_pitch) ) {
+		SDL_stack_free(icon_win32);
 		SDL_FreeSurface(icon_256);
 		SDL_SetError("Warning: Unexpected icon_256 characteristics");
 		return;
@@ -223,6 +226,7 @@
 	} else {
 		SetClassLong(SDL_Window, GCL_HICON, (LONG)screen_icn);
 	}
+	SDL_stack_free(icon_win32);
 #endif /* DISABLE_ICON_SUPPORT */
 }
 
--- a/src/video/wincommon/SDL_wingl.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/wincommon/SDL_wingl.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,15 +20,14 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 /* WGL implementation of SDL OpenGL support */
 
 #ifdef HAVE_OPENGL
 #include "SDL_opengl.h"
 #endif
 #include "SDL_error.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_lowvideo.h"
 #include "SDL_wingl_c.h"
 
--- a/src/video/windib/SDL_dibevents.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/windib/SDL_dibevents.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,13 +20,13 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 #include "SDL_events.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_syswm.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysevents.h"
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 #include "SDL_lowvideo.h"
--- a/src/video/windib/SDL_dibvideo.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/windib/SDL_dibvideo.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,11 +20,7 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <malloc.h>
-#include <windows.h>
-
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 #if defined(_WIN32_WCE)
 
@@ -41,6 +37,8 @@
 #include "SDL.h"
 #include "SDL_mutex.h"
 #include "SDL_syswm.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
 #include "SDL_sysevents.h"
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
@@ -539,7 +537,8 @@
 		settings.dmPelsWidth = width;
 		settings.dmPelsHeight = height;
 		settings.dmFields = DM_PELSWIDTH | DM_PELSHEIGHT | DM_BITSPERPEL;
-		if ( width <= SDL_desktop_mode.dmPelsWidth && height <= SDL_desktop_mode.dmPelsHeight ) {
+		if ( width <= (int)SDL_desktop_mode.dmPelsWidth &&
+		     height <= (int)SDL_desktop_mode.dmPelsHeight ) {
 			settings.dmDisplayFrequency = SDL_desktop_mode.dmDisplayFrequency;
 			settings.dmFields |= DM_DISPLAYFREQUENCY;
 		}
@@ -794,7 +793,7 @@
 	if ( screen_pal ) {
 		PALETTEENTRY *entries;
 
-		entries = (PALETTEENTRY *)alloca(ncolors*sizeof(PALETTEENTRY));
+		entries = SDL_stack_alloc(PALETTEENTRY, ncolors);
 		for ( i=0; i<ncolors; ++i ) {
 			entries[i].peRed   = colors[i].r;
 			entries[i].peGreen = colors[i].g;
@@ -804,11 +803,12 @@
 		SetPaletteEntries(screen_pal, firstcolor, ncolors, entries);
 		SelectPalette(hdc, screen_pal, FALSE);
 		RealizePalette(hdc);
+		SDL_stack_free(entries);
 	}
 
 #if !defined(_WIN32_WCE) || (_WIN32_WCE >= 400)
 	/* Copy palette colors into DIB palette */
-	pal = (RGBQUAD *)alloca(ncolors*sizeof(RGBQUAD));
+	pal = SDL_stack_alloc(RGBQUAD, ncolors);
 	for ( i=0; i<ncolors; ++i ) {
 		pal[i].rgbRed = colors[i].r;
 		pal[i].rgbGreen = colors[i].g;
@@ -823,6 +823,7 @@
 	BitBlt(hdc, 0, 0, this->screen->w, this->screen->h,
 	       mdc, 0, 0, SRCCOPY);
 	DeleteDC(mdc);
+	SDL_stack_free(pal);
 #endif
 	ReleaseDC(SDL_Window, hdc);
 	return(1);
--- a/src/video/windib/SDL_dibvideo.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/windib/SDL_dibvideo.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -23,7 +23,7 @@
 #ifndef _SDL_dibvideo_h
 #define _SDL_dibvideo_h
 
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 
 /* for PDA */
 typedef enum
--- a/src/video/windx5/SDL_dx5events.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/windx5/SDL_dx5events.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -24,11 +24,12 @@
 
 #include "directx.h"
 
-#include <stdio.h>
 #include "SDL_events.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_syswm.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysevents.h"
 #include "SDL_events_c.h"
 #include "SDL_lowvideo.h"
@@ -111,12 +112,13 @@
 			error = "Device not initialized";
 			break;
 		default:
-			sprintf(errbuf, "%s: Unknown DirectInput error: 0x%x",
+			snprintf(errbuf, SDL_arraysize(errbuf),
+			         "%s: Unknown DirectInput error: 0x%x",
 								function, code);
 			break;
 	}
 	if ( ! errbuf[0] ) {
-		sprintf(errbuf, "%s: %s", function, error);
+		snprintf(errbuf, SDL_arraysize(errbuf), "%s: %s", function, error);
 	}
 	SDL_SetError("%s", errbuf);
 	return;
@@ -610,7 +612,7 @@
 							timeout, QS_ALLEVENTS);
 	if ((event >= WAIT_OBJECT_0) && (event < (WAIT_OBJECT_0+SDL_DIndev))) {
 		DWORD numevents;
-		DIDEVICEOBJECTDATA evtbuf[INPUT_QSIZE];
+		static DIDEVICEOBJECTDATA evtbuf[INPUT_QSIZE];
 
 		event -= WAIT_OBJECT_0;
 		numevents = INPUT_QSIZE;
--- a/src/video/windx5/SDL_dx5video.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/windx5/SDL_dx5video.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -20,10 +20,7 @@
     slouken@libsdl.org
 */
 
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <malloc.h>
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 #include "directx.h"
 
 /* Not yet in the mingw32 cross-compile headers */
@@ -35,6 +32,8 @@
 #include "SDL_timer.h"
 #include "SDL_events.h"
 #include "SDL_syswm.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_sysvideo.h"
 #include "SDL_blit.h"
 #include "SDL_pixels_c.h"
@@ -810,12 +809,13 @@
 			error = "Interface not present";
 			break;
 		default:
-			sprintf(errbuf, "%s: Unknown DirectDraw error: 0x%x",
+			snprintf(errbuf, SDL_arraysize(errbuf),
+			         "%s: Unknown DirectDraw error: 0x%x",
 								function, code);
 			break;
 	}
 	if ( ! errbuf[0] ) {
-		sprintf(errbuf, "%s: %s", function, error);
+		snprintf(errbuf, SDL_arraysize(errbuf), "%s: %s", function, error);
 	}
 	SDL_SetError("%s", errbuf);
 	return;
@@ -1109,7 +1109,8 @@
 			settings.dmPelsWidth = width;
 			settings.dmPelsHeight = height;
 			settings.dmFields = DM_PELSWIDTH | DM_PELSHEIGHT | DM_BITSPERPEL;
-			if ( width <= SDL_desktop_mode.dmPelsWidth && height <= SDL_desktop_mode.dmPelsHeight ) {
+			if ( width <= (int)SDL_desktop_mode.dmPelsWidth &&
+			     height <= (int)SDL_desktop_mode.dmPelsHeight ) {
 				settings.dmDisplayFrequency = SDL_desktop_mode.dmDisplayFrequency;
 				settings.dmFields |= DM_DISPLAYFREQUENCY;
 			}
@@ -2170,7 +2171,7 @@
 	}
 #else
 	/* Allocate memory for the arrays we use */
-	pool = (int *)alloca(2*ncolors*sizeof(int));
+	pool = SDL_stack_alloc(int, 2*ncolors);
 	if ( pool == NULL ) {
 		/* No worries, just return */;
 		return;
@@ -2217,6 +2218,7 @@
 		SDL_colors[j].peGreen = colors[order[i]].g;
 		SDL_colors[j].peBlue = colors[order[i]].b;
 	}
+	SDL_stack_free(pool);
 #endif /* SIMPLE_COMPRESSION */
 }
 
@@ -2458,12 +2460,12 @@
 	if ( palette == NULL ) { /* Sometimes we don't have a palette */
 		return;
 	}
-	entries = (PALETTEENTRY *)alloca(palette->ncolors*sizeof(*entries));
+	entries = SDL_stack_alloc(PALETTEENTRY, palette->ncolors);
 	hdc = GetDC(window);
 	GetSystemPaletteEntries(hdc, 0, palette->ncolors, entries);
 	ReleaseDC(window, hdc);
 	if ( ! colorchange_expected ) {
-		saved = (SDL_Color *)alloca(palette->ncolors*sizeof(SDL_Color));
+		saved = SDL_stack_alloc(SDL_Color, palette->ncolors);
 		memcpy(saved, palette->colors, 
 					palette->ncolors*sizeof(SDL_Color));
 	}
@@ -2472,6 +2474,7 @@
 		palette->colors[i].g = entries[i].peGreen;
 		palette->colors[i].b = entries[i].peBlue;
 	}
+	SDL_stack_free(entries);
 	if ( ! colorchange_expected ) {
 		Uint8 mapping[256];
 
@@ -2481,6 +2484,7 @@
 					saved[i].r, saved[i].g, saved[i].b);
 		}
 		DX5_Recolor8Bit(this, SDL_VideoSurface, mapping);
+		SDL_stack_free(saved);
 	}
 	colorchange_expected = 0;
 
--- a/src/video/windx5/SDL_dx5yuv.c	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/windx5/SDL_dx5yuv.c	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -22,11 +22,10 @@
 
 /* This is the DirectDraw implementation of YUV video overlays */
 
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
 #include "SDL_error.h"
 #include "SDL_video.h"
+#include "SDL_stdlib.h"
+#include "SDL_string.h"
 #include "SDL_dx5yuv_c.h"
 #include "SDL_yuvfuncs.h"
 
--- a/src/video/windx5/directx.h	Sat Feb 04 22:01:44 2006 +0000
+++ b/src/video/windx5/directx.h	Mon Feb 06 08:28:51 2006 +0000
@@ -4,7 +4,7 @@
 
 /* Include all of the DirectX 5.0 headers and adds any necessary tweaks */
 
-#include <windows.h>
+#include "SDL_windows.h"
 #include <mmsystem.h>
 #ifndef WIN32
 #define WIN32